©2021 Trane RT-SVX34U-EN Introduction Read this manual thoroughly before operating or servicing this unit. Warnings, Cautions, and Notices Safety advisories appear throughout this manual as
2021-06-21 — Only qualified personnel should install and service the equipment. The installation, starting up, and servicing of heating, ventilating, ...
Trane Coils Repair Bardia Ave Manual
Installation, Operation, and Maintenance VoyagerTM Commercial Packaged Rooftop Air Conditioners with ReliaTelTM Controls and eStageTM 27.5 to 50 Tons - 60 Hz 22.9 to 41.7 Tons (81-148 kW) - 50 Hz "B" and later design sequence 60Hz/3 phase: TC*, TE*, YC*330B, 360B, 420B, 480B, 600B (60 Hz/3 phase) 50 Hz/3 phase: TC*, TE*, YC*275B, 305B, 350B, 400B, 500B SAFETY WARNING Only qualified personnel should install and service the equipment. The installation, starting up, and servicing of heating, ventilating, and air-conditioning equipment can be hazardous and requires specific knowledge and training. Improperly installed, adjusted or altered equipment by an unqualified person could result in death or serious injury. When working on the equipment, observe all precautions in the literature and on the tags, stickers, and labels that are attached to the equipment. June 2021 RT-SVX34U-EN Introduction Read this manual thoroughly before operating or servicing this unit. Warnings, Cautions, and Notices Safety advisories appear throughout this manual as required. Your personal safety and the proper operation of this machine depend upon the strict observance of these precautions. The three types of advisories are defined as follows: WARNING Indicates a potentially hazardous situation which, if not avoided, could result in death or serious injury. CAUTION Indicates a potentially hazardous situation which, if not avoided, could result in minor or moderate injury. It could also be used to alert against unsafe practices. NOTICE Indicates a situation that could result in equipment or property-damage only accidents. Important Environmental Concerns Scientific research has shown that certain man-made chemicals can affect the earth's naturally occurring stratospheric ozone layer when released to the atmosphere. In particular, several of the identified chemicals that may affect the ozone layer are refrigerants that contain Chlorine, Fluorine and Carbon (CFCs) and those containing Hydrogen, Chlorine, Fluorine and Carbon (HCFCs). Not all refrigerants containing these compounds have the same potential impact to the environment. Trane advocates the responsible handling of all refrigerants-including industry replacements for CFCs and HCFCs such as saturated or unsaturated HFCs and HCFCs. Important Responsible Refrigerant Practices Trane believes that responsible refrigerant practices are important to the environment, our customers, and the air conditioning industry. All technicians who handle refrigerants must be certified according to local rules. For the USA, the Federal Clean Air Act (Section 608) sets forth the requirements for handling, reclaiming, recovering and recycling of certain refrigerants and the equipment that is used in these service procedures. In addition, some states or municipalities may have additional requirements that must also be adhered to for responsible management of refrigerants. Know the applicable laws and follow them. WARNING Proper Field Wiring and Grounding Required! Failure to follow code could result in death or serious injury. All field wiring MUST be performed by qualified personnel. Improperly installed and grounded field wiring poses FIRE and ELECTROCUTION hazards. To avoid these hazards, you MUST follow requirements for field wiring installation and grounding as described in NEC and your local/ state/national electrical codes. WARNING Personal Protective Equipment (PPE) Required! Failure to wear proper PPE for the job being undertaken could result in death or serious injury. Technicians, in order to protect themselves from potential electrical, mechanical, and chemical hazards, MUST follow precautions in this manual and on the tags, stickers, and labels, as well as the instructions below: · Before installing/servicing this unit, technicians MUST put on all PPE required for the work being undertaken (Examples; cut resistant gloves/sleeves, butyl gloves, safety glasses, hard hat/bump cap, fall protection, electrical PPE and arc flash clothing). ALWAYS refer to appropriate Safety Data Sheets (SDS) and OSHA guidelines for proper PPE. · When working with or around hazardous chemicals, ALWAYS refer to the appropriate SDS and OSHA/GHS (Global Harmonized System of Classification and Labelling of Chemicals) guidelines for information on allowable personal exposure levels, proper respiratory protection and handling instructions. · If there is a risk of energized electrical contact, arc, or flash, technicians MUST put on all PPE in accordance with OSHA, NFPA 70E, or other country-specific requirements for arc flash protection, PRIOR to servicing the unit. NEVER PERFORM ANY SWITCHING, DISCONNECTING, OR VOLTAGE TESTING WITHOUT PROPER ELECTRICAL PPE AND ARC FLASH CLOTHING. ENSURE ELECTRICAL METERS AND EQUIPMENT ARE PROPERLY RATED FOR INTENDED VOLTAGE. ©2021 Trane RT-SVX34U-EN WARNING Follow EHS Policies! Failure to follow instructions below could result in death or serious injury. · All Trane personnel must follow the company's Environmental, Health and Safety (EHS) policies when performing work such as hot work, electrical, fall protection, lockout/ tagout, refrigerant handling, etc. Where local regulations are more stringent than these policies, those regulations supersede these policies. · Non-Trane personnel should always follow local regulations. Overview of Manual One copy of the appropriate service literature ships inside the control panel of each unit. The procedures discussed in this manual should only be performed by qualified, experienced HVAC technicians. Note: Do not release refrigerant to the atmosphere! If adding or removing refrigerant is required, the service technician must comply with all federal, state, and local laws. This booklet describes the proper installation, startup, operation, and maintenance procedures for TC_, TE_, and YC_22.9 to 50 Ton CV (Constant Volume), VAV (Variable Air Volume), and SZ VAV (Single Zone Variable Air Volume) applications. By carefully reviewing the information within this manual and following the instructions, the risk of improper operation and/or component damage will be minimized. Introduction It is important that periodic maintenance be performed to help assure trouble free operation. A maintenance schedule is provided at the end of this manual. Should equipment failure occur, contact a qualified service organization with qualified, experienced HVAC technicians to properly diagnose and repair this equipment. Copyright This document and the information in it are the property of Trane, and may not be used or reproduced in whole or in part without written permission. Trane reserves the right to revise this publication at any time, and to make changes to its content without obligation to notify any person of such revision or change. Trademarks All trademarks referenced in this document are the trademarks of their respective owners. Factory Training Factory training is available through Trane UniversityTM to help you learn more about the operation and maintenance of your equipment. To learn about available training opportunities contact Trane UniversityTM. Online: www.trane.com/traneuniversity Phone: 855-803-3563 Email: traneuniversity@trane.com Revision History Removed reference to suction service valves on the 40/ 50T standard efficiency (CV) and high efficiency units. RT-SVX34U-EN 3 Table of Contents Model Number Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 60 Hz Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 50 Hz Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 General Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12 About the Unit. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12 Unit Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12 Exterior Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12 Inspection for Concealed Damage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12 Repair. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12 Storage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12 Unit Dimensions and Weights . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13 Recommended Clearances . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13 Roof Curb and Ductwork . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13 Horizontal Ductwork. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13 Unit Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14 Unit Rigging and Placement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19 Pre-Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22 General Unit Requirements. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22 Downflow/Upflow Models . . . . . . . . . . . . 22 All Units. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22 Electrical Requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22 Field Installed Control Wiring . . . . . . . . . 22 Gas Heat Requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22 Installation General Requirements. . . . . . . . . 23 Condensate Drain Connection . . . . . . . . . . . . 23 Condensate Overflow Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23 O/A Sensor & Tubing Installation . . . . . . . . . 23 Units with StatitracTM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24 Installation Electrical . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26 Disconnect Switch External Handle (Factory Mounted Option) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26 Main Power Wiring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26 Through-the-Base Electrical (Optional Accessory) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28 Electrical Service Sizing Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28 Electrical Wire Sizing and Protection Device Equations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31 Calculation #1 - TC*, YC* - 27.5 to 50 Ton Units. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31 Calculation #2 - TE* - 27.5 to 50 Ton Units. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31 Disconnect Switch Sizing (DSS) . . . . . . . 32 Low Voltage Wiring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32 Control Power Transformer. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32 Field Installed AC Control Wiring. . . . . . . . . . 32 Field Installed DC Control Wiring. . . . . . . . . . 33 Remote Panels and Sensors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36 Constant Volume and Single Zone VAV Control Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36 Variable Air Volume (non-SZ VAV) Control Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36 VAV Controls Available from the Factory for Field Installation. . . . . . . . . . . 37 Constant Volume or VAV (Traditional or Single Zone) Controls Available from the Factory for Field Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37 Space Temperature Averaging . . . . . . . . 39 Installation Piping . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40 General Requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40 Connecting the Gas Supply Line to the Furnace Gas Train . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40 Startup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42 Unit Control Modules . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42 RTRM - ReliaTelTM Refrigeration Module . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42 ECA/RTEM - Economizer Actuator/ ReliaTel Economizer Module (Optional) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42 EBA - Exhaust Blade Actuator (Optional) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42 RTAM - ReliaTel Air Handler Module (Standard with Traditional VAV) . . . . . . . 42 ReliaTel Ventilation Module (RTVM). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43 ReliaTel Dehumidification Module (RTDM) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44 4 RT-SVX34U-EN Table of Contents Conventional Thermostat Connections (Available Only with CV) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44 TCI - Trane Communication Interface (Optional) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44 LCI - LonTalk® Communication Interface (Optional). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44 BCI - BACnet® Communication Interface (Optional). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44 WCI - Trane Air-Fi® Wireless Comm Interface (Optional). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44 TD5 Display - 5" Touchscreen Display. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44 System Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44 Economizer Operation with a Conventional Thermostat (CV Only). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44 Microelectronic Control Features. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45 Economizer Operation with CV Controls. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45 Modulating Power Exhaust . . . . . . . . . . . 46 Mechanical Cooling without an Economizer (CV and SZ VAV) . . . . . . . . . 46 Zone Temperature - Occupied Cooling (CV and SZVAV). . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47 Zone Temperature - Occupied Heating (CV and SZVAV). . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47 Supply Fan (CV and SZ VAV) . . . . . . . . . . 47 Supply Air Tempering (CV and SZ VAV) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47 Variable Air Volume Applications (SZ VAV). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48 Supply Fan Output Control. . . . . . . . . . . . 48 Minimum Supply Fan Output . . . . . . . . . 48 Supply Fan Mode Operation . . . . . . . . . . 49 Setpoint Arbitration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49 Units Configured with the Outside Air Measurement (Traq) Option . . . . . . . 50 Sequence for Setting Calibration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51 Ventilation Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53 Space Pressure Control. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55 Traq Overrides and Special Considerations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56 Supply Air Temperature Control Heating and Cooling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56 Variable Air Volume Applications (Traditional VAV). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 57 Supply Air Temperature Control Occupied Cooling and Heating . . . . . . . . 57 Supply Air Temperature Control with an Economizer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 57 VHR Relay Output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 57 Zone Temperature Control without a Night Setback Panel or ICS Unoccupied Cooling. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 57 Zone Temperature Control without a Night Setback Panel or ICS Unoccupied Heating. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 57 Morning Warm-up (MWU) Control. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 57 Daytime Warm-up (DWU) Control. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 57 Supply Duct Static Pressure Control. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58 Supply Air Temperature Reset . . . . . . . . 58 VAV Supply Air Tempering (Only Available with Modulating Gas Heat). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58 Constant Volume or Variable Air Volume Applications (Single Zone or Traditional) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58 Off Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58 Zone Temperature - Unoccupied Cooling (CV or SZ VAV Only) . . . . . . . . . . 59 Zone Temperature - Unoccupied Heating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 59 Mechanical Cooling with an Economizer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 59 Gas Heat Control. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 59 Electric Heat Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60 Clogged Filter Option. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60 Ventilation Override . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60 Emergency Stop . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60 Phase Monitor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60 Low Pressure Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60 Hot Gas Reheat Low Pressure Control. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61 High Pressure Cutout and Temperature Discharge Limit . . . . . . . . . 61 Power Exhaust Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61 Space Pressure Control Statitrac . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61 RT-SVX34U-EN 5 Table of Contents Power Exhaust Control (Tracking) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62 Lead/Lag Control. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62 Coil Frost Protection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62 Modulating Hot Gas Reheat Frost Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62 Drain Pan Condensate Overflow Switch (Optional) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 63 VFD Programming Parameters . . . . . . . . 63 Condenser Fan Sequencing Control. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 63 Preparing the Unit for Operation . . . . . . . . . . 66 Electrical Phasing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 66 Voltage Supply and Voltage Imbalance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67 Starting the Unit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67 Test Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67 Service Test Switch Location. . . . . . . . . . 68 Verifying Proper Fan Rotation . . . . . . . . . 74 Verifying Proper Air Flow (CFM) - CV or VFD's . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75 Exhaust Fan Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 83 Economizer Damper Adjustment. . . . . . . . . . 84 Economizer (O/A) Dampers . . . . . . . . . . . 84 Models with Ultra-Low Leak Economizers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 86 Manual Outside Air Damper . . . . . . . . . . 88 Starting the Compressor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 89 Starting 27.5 to 35 Ton Standard Efficiency Units . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 89 Starting 40 to 50 Ton Standard Efficiency VAV Units . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 90 Starting 27.5-50 Tons High Efficiency Units and 40-50 Tons Standard Efficiency Constant Volume Units. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 90 Line Weights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 90 Compressor Oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 91 Scroll Compressor Operational Noises . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 104 Compressor Crankcase Heaters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 105 Charging by Subcooling . . . . . . . . . . . . . 105 Measuring Subcooling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 105 Gas Heat Units . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 105 Electric Heat Units . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106 Final Unit Checkout . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106 For Constant Volume Units . . . . . . . . . . 106 For Variable Air Volume Units. . . . . . . . 106 For Single Zone Variable Air Volume Units. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 107 Sequence of Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108 Mechanical Cooling Sequence Of Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108 Units Without an Economizer . . . . . . . . 108 Economizer Operation Based on Dry Bulb . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108 Economizer Operation Based on Reference Enthalpy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109 Economizer Operation Based on Comparative Enthalpy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109 Economizers with Traq . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109 Modulating Hot Gas Reheat Sequence of Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 110 Sensible Cooling or Heating Control Overrides Hot Gas Reheat Control. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 110 Gas Heat Sequence Of Operation . . . . . . . . 110 Constant Volume (CV) Unit Fan Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111 Variable Air Volume (VAV) Unit Fan Operation (2 Stage and Modulating Gas Heat). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111 Variable Air Volume (VAV) Unit Fan Operation (Modulating Gas Heat Only). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111 Ignition Control Module . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111 High Temperature Limit Operation and Location. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111 Electric Heat Sequence Of Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111 Constant Volume (CV) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111 Variable Air Volume (VAV) . . . . . . . . . . . 112 Variable Air Volume Applications (Single Zone VAV) Sequence of Operation . . . . . . . 112 Occupied Cooling Operation . . . . . . . . . 112 Economizer Cooling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 112 Compressor Cooling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 112 Occupied Heating Operation . . . . . . . . . 113 Staged Heating Operation . . . . . . . . . . . 113 6 RT-SVX34U-EN Table of Contents Modulating Heat Operation with SZVAV Heating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113 Unoccupied Cooling and Heating Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113 Modulating Hot Gas Reheat Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114 Failure and Overriding Conditions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114 Low Pressure Control (LPC) Sequence of Operation (ReliaTel Control) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 115 High Pressure Control and Temperature Discharge Limit (ReliaTel Control). . . . . . . . 115 Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116 Fan Belt Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116 Monthly Maintenance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 118 Filters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 118 Condensate Overflow Switch . . . . . . . . 118 Cooling Season . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119 Heating Season . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119 Coil Cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120 Refrigerant Coils . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 121 Microchannel Condenser Coil Repair and Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 121 Final Process . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 121 Fall Restraint . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123 Refrigeration System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123 Refrigerant Evacuation and Charging . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123 Charge Storage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124 Compressor Oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124 Compressor Replacements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124 Electrical Phasing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124 Precision Suction Restrictor. . . . . . . . . . 124 VFD Programming Parameters (Supply) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125 Diagnostics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 129 System Status/Diagnostics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 129 System Status / Diagnostics Checkout Procedure (DC Voltmeter Required) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 129 Diagnostics (VAV only) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 131 Resetting Cooling and Ignition Lockouts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 131 Zone Temperature Sensor (ZSM) Service Indicator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 131 Economizer Actuator (ECA/RTEM) Test Procedures. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 134 Economizer Fault Detection and Diagnostics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 134 Verify Economizer Status by Economizer Actuator (ECA/ RTEM) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 134 ReliaTel Air Module (RTAM) Tests. . . . . . . . 135 Test 1: Testing the Variable Frequency Drive (VFD) Output. . . . . . . . 135 Test 2: Testing the Static Pressure Transducer (SPT) Input . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135 Test 3: Testing the VAV Setpoint Potentiometers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135 Test 4: Testing the VFD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135 ReliaTel Air Module (RTOM) Tests . . . . . . . 136 Test 1: Testing the Variable Frequency Drive (VFD) Output. . . . . . . . 136 Test 2: Testing the VFD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 136 Compressor--Blink Codes. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 136 Troubleshooting. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 137 TR-200 VFD Programming Parameters. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 142 Unit Wiring Diagram Numbers . . . . . . . . . . . 144 Warranty and Liability Clause . . . . . . . . . . . . 152 COMMERCIAL EQUIPMENT - 20 TONS AND LARGER AND RELATED ACCESSORIES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 152 RT-SVX34U-EN 7 Model Number Description 60 Hz Description Digit 1, 2 -- Unit Function Digit 10 -- Design Sequence TC = DX Cooling, No Heat TE = DX Cooling, Electric Heat YC = DX Cooling, Natural Gas Heat A = First Digit 11 -- Exhaust4 Digit 3 -- Unit Airflow Design D = Downflow Supply and Upflow Return H = Horizontal Supply and Horizontal Return F = Horizontal Supply and Upflow Return R = Downflow Supply and Horizontal Return Digit 4, 5, 6 -- Nominal Cooling Capacity 330 = 27.5 Tons 360 = 30 Tons 420 = 35 Tons 480 = 40 Tons 600 = 50 Tons Digit 7 -- Major Development Sequence B = R-410A Refrigerant Digit 8 -- Power Supply1 E = 208/60/3 F = 230/60/3 4 = 460/60/3 5 = 575/60/3 Digit 9 -- Heating Capacity2 0 = No Heat (TC Only) L = Low Heat (YC Only) H = High Heat (YC Only) J = Low Heat-Stainless Steel Gas Heat Exchanger (YC Only) K = High Heat-Stainless Steel Gas Heat Exchangers (YC Only) M = Low Heat-Stainless Steel Gas Heat Exchanger w/ Modulating Control (27.5-35 Tons YC only) P = High Heat-Stainless Steel Gas Heat Exchangers w/ Modulating Control (27.5-35 Tons YC Only) R = Low Heat-Stainless Steel Gas Heat Exchanger w/ Modulating Control (40-50 Tons YC Only) T = High Heat-Stainless Steel Gas Heat Exchangers w/ Modulating Control (40-50 Tons YC Only) Note: When second digit is "E" for Electric Heat, the following values apply in the ninth digit. A = 36 kW (27 kW for 208V) B = 54 kW (41 kW for 208V) C = 72 kW D = 90 kW E = 108 kW 0 = None 1 = Barometric Relief (Available w/ Economizer only) 2 = 100% Power Exhaust Fan (Available w/ Economizer Only) 3 = 50% Power Exhaust Fan (Available w/ Economizer Only) 4 = 100% Fresh Air Tracking Power Exhaust Fan (Available w/ Economizer Only) 5 = 50% Fresh Air Tracking Power Exhaust Fan (Available w/ Economizer Only) 6 = 100% Power Exhaust w/ StatitracTM 7 = 100% Power Exhaust Fan w/ Ultra Low Leak Exhaust Damper (Available w/ Economizer Only) 8 = 50% Power Exhaust Fan w/ Ultra Low Leak Exhaust Damper (Available w/ Economizer Only) 9 = 100% Power Exhaust w/ Ultra Low Leak Exhaust Damper w/ StatitracTM Digit 12 -- Filter A = 2" MERV 4, Std Eff, Throwaway Filters B = 2" MERV 8, High Eff, Throwaway Filters C = 4" MERV 8, High Eff, Throwaway Filters D = 4" MERV 14, High Eff, Throwaway Filters Digit 13 -- Supply Fan Motor, HP 1 = 7.5 HP 2 = 10 HP 3 = 15 HP 4 = 20 HP Digit 14 -- Supply Air Fan Drive Selections A = 550 RPM B = 600 RPM C = 650 RPM D = 700 RPM E = 750 RPM F = 790 RPM G = 800 RPM H = 500 RPM J = 525 RPM K = 575 RPM L = 625 RPM M = 675 RPM N = 725 RPM Digit 15 -- Outside Air Selection A = No Outside Air B = 0-25% Manual Damper C = 0-100% Economizer, Dry Bulb Control D = 0-100% Economizer, Reference Enthalpy Control E = 0-100% Economizer, Differential Enthalpy Control F = "C" Option and Low Leak Fresh Air Damper G = "D" Option and Low Leak Fresh Air Damper H = "E" Option and Low Leak Fresh Air Damper J = "C" Option and Ultra Low Leak Outside Air Damper K = "D" Option and Ultra Low Leak Outside Air Damper L = "E" Option and Ultra Low Leak Outside Air Damper 1 = Option "C" with Traq 2 = Option "D" with Traq 3 = Option "E" with Traq 4 = Option "F" with Traq 5 = Option "G" with Traq 6 = Option "H" with Traq 7 = Option "C" with Traq w/ Ultra Low Leak Outside Air Damper 8 = Option "D" with Traq w/ Ultra Low Leak Outside Air Damper 9 = Option "E" with Traq w/ Ultra Low Leak Outside Air Damper Digit 16 -- System Control 1 = Constant Volume w/ Zone Temperature Control 2 = Constant Volume w/ Discharge Air Control 4 = VAV Supply Air Temperature Control w/ Variable Frequency Drive w/o Bypass 5 = VAV Supply Air Temperature Control w/ Variable Frequency Drive and Bypass 6 = Single Zone VAV w/ VFD w/o Bypass 7 = Single Zone VAV w/ VFD w/ Bypass A = VAV Supply Air Temperature Control w/ VFD w/o Bypass w/ Motor Shaft Grounding Ring B = VAV Supply Air Temperature Control w/ VFD w/ Bypass w/ Motor Shaft Grounding Ring C = Single Zone VAV w/ VFD w/o Bypass w/ Motor Shaft Grounding Ring D = Single Zone VAV w/ VFD w/ Bypass w/ Motor Shaft Grounding Ring Note: Zone sensors are not included with option and must be ordered as a separate accessory. 8 RT-SVX34U-EN Model Number Description Miscellaneous Options Digit 27 Digit 17 0 = No Service Valves A = Service Valves Std efficiency units excluding 40/50T std efficiency CV: If Digit 17 = 0, no valves will be provided. If Digit 17= A, service valves will be provided in the suction and discharge lines. High efficiency units including 40/ 50T std efficiency CV: Digit 17 is not selectable. Discharge service valves are included. 0 = 5kA SCCR D = High Fault 65kA SCCR Disconnect5 E = High Fault 65kA SCCR Disconnect w/ Powered Convenience Outlet5 Digit 28 0 = Standard Drain Pan M = Stainless Steel Drain Pan 1 = Standard Drain Pan w/ Condensate Overflow Switch 2 = Stainless Steel Drain Pan w/ Condensate Overflow Switch Digit 18 B = Through the Base Electrical Provision Digit 19 C = Non-Fused Disconnect Switch w/ External Handle Digit 29 -- Efficiency/ Condenser Coil Options 0 = Standard Efficiency Unit J = Standard Efficiency Unit w/ Corrosion Protected Condenser Coil K = High Efficiency Unit (eStage) L = High Efficiency Unit (eStage) w/ Corrosion Protected Condenser Coil Digit 20 Digit 30, 31 -- Miscellaneous Options D = Factory-Powered 15A GFI Convenience Outlet and Non-Fused Disconnect Switch w/ External Handle Digit 21 E = Field-Powered 15A GFI Convenience Outlet Digit 22 F = Trane Communication Interface (TCI) Digit 23 P = Discharge Temperature Sensor R = Clogged Filter Switch Digit 32 -- Modulating Hot Gas Reheat Option T = Modulating Hot Gas Reheat Digit 33 -- Human Interface 5 = Touchscreen Human Interface, 5 inch Model Number Notes G = Ventilation Override Digit 24 H = Hinged Service Access Digit 25 H = Condenser Hail Guards J = Condenser Coil Guards Digit 26 K = LCI (LonTalk) B = BACnet Communications Interface (BCI) Notes: 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. All voltages are across the line starting only. Electric Heat KW ratings are based upon voltage ratings of 208/240/480/ 600 V. For a 240 V heater derated to 208 V, the resulting kW rating decreases from 36 kW to 27 kW, and from 54 kW to 41 kW. Voltage offerings are shown in following table (see Table 22, p. 56 for additional information). The service digit for each model number contains 33 digits; all 33 digits must be referenced. Ventilation override exhaust mode is not available for the exhaust fan with fresh air tracking power exhaust. VOM is available for the exhaust fan without fresh air tracking power exhaust. 575 VAC option is 25kA. Tons Elec. KW Heat- er 27/ 41/ Rated 36 54 72 Volt. 90 108 27.5 208 to 35 240 x x x x 480 x x x x 600 x x x 40 208 and 50 240 480 x x x x x x 600 x x x x RT-SVX34U-EN 9 Model Number Description 50 Hz Description Digit 1, 2 -- Unit Function Digit 11 -- Exhaust4 Digit 15 -- Outside Air Selection TC = DX Cooling, No Heat TE = DX Cooling, Electric Heat YC = DX Cooling, Natural Gas Heat Digit 3 -- Unit Airflow Design D = Downflow Supply and Upflow Return H = Horizontal Supply and Horizontal Return F = Horizontal Supply and Upflow Return R = Downflow Supply and Horizontal Return Digit 4, 5, 6 -- Nominal Cooling Capacity 275 = 22.9 Tons (82 kW) 305 = 25.4 Tons (89 kW) 350 = 29.2 Tons (105 kW) 400 = 33.3 Tons (120 kW) 500 = 41.7 Tons (148 kW) Digit 7 -- Major Development Sequence B = R-410A Refrigerant Digit 8 -- Power Supply1 C = 380/50/3 D = 415/50/3 Digit 9 -- Heating Capacity2 0 = No Heat (TC Only) L = Low Heat (YC Only) H = High Heat (YC Only) Note: When second digit is "E" for Electric Heat, the following values apply in the ninth digit. 380V / 415V A = 23 kW / 27 kW B = 34 kW / 40 kW C = 45 kW / 54 kW D = 56 kW / 67 kW E = 68 kW / 81 kW Digit 10 -- Design Sequence A = First 0 = None 1 = Barometric Relief (Available w/ Economizer only) 2 = 100% Power Exhaust Fan (Available w/ Economizer Only) 3 = 50% Power Exhaust Fan (Available w/ Economizer Only) 4 = 100% Fresh Air Tracking Power Exhaust Fan (Available w/ Economizer Only) 5 = 50% Fresh Air Tracking Power Exhaust Fan (Available w/ Economizer Only) 6 = 100% Power Exhaust w/ StatitracTM 7 = 100% Power Exhaust Fan w/ Ultra Low Leak Exhaust Damper (Available w/ Economizer Only) 8 = 50% Power Exhaust Fan w/ Ultra Low Leak Exhaust Damper (Available w/ Economizer Only) 9 = 100% Power Exhaust w/ Ultra Low Leak Exhaust Damper w/ StatitracTM Digit 12 -- Filter A = 2" (51mm) MERV 4, Std Eff, Throwaway Filters B = 2" MERV (51mm) 8, High Eff, Throwaway Filters C = 4" (102mm) MERV 8, High Eff, Throwaway Filters D = 4" (102mm) MERV 14, High Eff, Throwaway Filters Digit 13 -- Supply Fan Motor, HP 1 = 7.5 HP (5.6 kW) 2 = 10 HP (7.5 kW) 3 = 15 HP (10 kW) 4 = 20 HP (15 kW) Digit 14 -- Supply Air Fan Drive Selections A = 458 RPM B = 500 RPM C = 541 RPM D = 583 RPM E = 625 RPM F = 658 RPM G = 664 RPM H = 417 RPM J = 437 RPM K = 479 RPM L = 521 RPM M = 562 RPM N = 604 RPM A = No Outside Air B = 0-25% Manual Damper C = 0-100% Economizer, Dry Bulb Control D = 0-100% Economizer, Reference Enthalpy Control E = 0-100% Economizer, Differential Enthalpy Control F = "C" Option and Low Leak Fresh Air Damper G = "D" Option and Low Leak Fresh Air Damper H = "E" Option and Low Leak Fresh Air Damper J = "C" Option and Ultra Low Leak Outside Air Damper K = "D" Option and Ultra Low Leak Outside Air Damper L = "E" Option and Ultra Low Leak Outside Air Damper 1 = Option "C" with Traq 2 = Option "D" with Traq 3 = Option "E" with Traq 4 = Option "F" with Traq 5 = Option "G" with Traq 6 = Option "H" with Traq 7 = Option "C" with Traq w/ Ultra Low Leak Outside Air Damper 8 = Option "D" with Traq w/ Ultra Low Leak Outside Air Damper 9 = Option "E" with Traq w/ Ultra Low Leak Outside Air Damper Digit 16 -- System Control 1 = Constant Volume w/ Zone Temperature Control 2 = Constant Volume w/ Discharge Air Control 4 = VAV Supply Air Temperature Control w/ Variable Frequency Drive w/o Bypass 5 = VAV Supply Air Temperature Control w/ Variable Frequency Drive and Bypass 6 = Single Zone VAV w/ VFD w/o Bypass 7 = Single Zone VAV w/ VFD w/ Bypass A = VAV Supply Air Temperature Control w/ VFD w/o Bypass w/ Motor Shaft Grounding Ring B = VAV Supply Air Temperature Control w/ VFD w/ Bypass w/ Motor Shaft Grounding Ring C = Single Zone VAV w/ VFD w/o Bypass w/ Motor Shaft Grounding Ring D = Single Zone VAV w/ VFD w/ Bypass w/ Motor Shaft Grounding Ring Note: Zone sensors are not included with option and must be ordered as a separate accessory. 10 RT-SVX34U-EN Model Number Description Miscellaneous Options Digit 17 0 = No Service Valves A = Service Valves Std efficiency units excluding 400/500 std efficiency CV: If Digit 17 = 0, no valves will be provided. If Digit 17= A, service valves will be provided in the suction and discharge lines. High efficiency units including 400/500 std efficiency CV: Digit 17 is not selectable. Discharge service valves are included. Digit 18 B = Through the Base Electrical Provision Digit 19 C = Non-Fused Disconnect Switch w/ External Handle Digit 20 * = Unused Digit Digit 21 * = Unused Digit Digit 22 F = Trane Communication Interface (TCI) Digit 23 G = Ventilation Override Digit 24 Digit 29 -- Efficiency/ Condenser Coil Options 0 = Standard Efficiency Unit J = Standard Efficiency Unit with Corrosion Protected Condenser Coil K = High Efficiency Unit (eStage) L = High Efficiency Unit (eStage) with Corrosion Protected Condenser Coil Digit 30, 31 -- Miscellaneous Options P = Discharge Temperature Sensor R = Clogged Filter Switch Digit 32 -- Modulating Hot Gas Reheat Option T = Modulating Hot Gas Reheat Digit 33 -- Human Interface 5 = Touchscreen Human Interface, 5 inch Model Number Notes Notes: 1. 2. 3. 4. All voltages are across the line starting only. Electric Heat KW ratings are based upon voltage ratings of 380/415 V. Heaters A, B, C, D are used with 22.9-29.2 ton (82105 kW) units only and heaters B, C, D, E are used with 33.3-41.7 ton (120-148 kW) units only. The service digit for each model number contains 33 digits; all 33 digits must be referenced. Ventilation override exhaust mode is not available for the exhaust fan with fresh air tracking power exhaust. VOM is available for the exhaust fan without fresh air tracking power exhaust. H = Hinged Service Access Digit 25 H = Condenser Hail Guards J = Condenser Coil Guards Digit 26 K = LCI (LonTalk) B = BACnet Communications Interface (BCI) Digit 27 0 = 5kA SCCR D = High Fault 65kA SCCR Disconnect Digit 28 0 = Standard Drain Pan M = Stainless Steel Drain Pan 1 = Standard Drain Pan w/ Condensate Overflow Switch 2 = Stainless Steel Drain Pan w/ Condensate Overflow Switch RT-SVX34U-EN 11 General Information About the Unit Overall unit dimensional data is illustrated in "Unit Dimensions and Weights," p. 13. Each package rooftop unit ships fully assembled and charged with the proper refrigerant quantity from the factory. They are controlled by a microelectronic unit control processor. Several solid state modules are grouped to form the "Control System". The number of modules within any given control system will be dependent upon the options and accessories ordered with the unit. Acronyms are used extensively throughout this manual when referring to the "Control System". Basic unit components include: · Scroll compressors · One (1) Intertwined Evaporator Coil · One (1) Supply Fan · Three (3) to Four (4) Condenser Fans · Microchannel Condenser Coils · Filters (type is dependent on option selection) Unit Inspection To protect against loss due to damage incurred in transit, perform inspection immediately upon receipt of the unit. Exterior Inspection If the job site inspection reveals damage or material shortages, file a claim with the carrier immediately. Specify the type and extent of the damage on the bill of lading before signing. Notify the appropriate sales representative. Important: Do not proceed with installation of a damaged unit without sales representative's approval. · Visually inspect the complete exterior for signs of shipping damages to unit or packing material. · Verify that the nameplate data matches the sales order and bill of lading. · Verify that the unit is properly equipped and there are no material shortages. · Verify that the power supply complies with the unit nameplate specifications. Inspection for Concealed Damage Visually inspect the components for concealed damage as soon as possible after delivery and before it is stored. Do NOT walk on the sheet metal base pans. Bridging between the unit's main supports may consist of multiple 2 by 12 boards or sheet metal grating. 12 WARNING No Step Surface! Failure to follow instruction below could result in death or serious injury. Do not walk on the sheet metal drain pan. Walking on the drain pan could cause the supporting metal to collapse and result in the operator/technician falling. If concealed damage is discovered: · Notify the carrier's terminal of the damage immediately by phone and by mail. · Concealed damage must be reported within 15 days. · Request an immediate, joint inspection of the damage with the carrier and consignee. · Stop unpacking the unit. · Do not remove damaged material from receiving location. · Take photos of the damage, if possible. · The owner must provide reasonable evidence that the damage did not occur after delivery. Repair Notify the appropriate sales representative before arranging unit installation or repair. Important: Do not repair unit until the damage has been inspected by the carrier's representative. Storage Store unit in a level and dry location. Use adequate blocking under the base rail. If unit is not level and supported adequately, damage may occur when removing screws and opening doors. Take precautions to prevent condensate formation inside the unit electrical components and motors when: · The unit is stored before it is installed; or, · The unit is set on the roof curb and temporary auxiliary heat is provided in the building. Isolate all side panel service entrances and base pan openings (e.g., conduit holes, S/A and R/A openings, and flue openings) to minimize ambient air from entering the unit until it is ready for startup. Note: Do not use the unit heater as temporary heat without completing the startup procedures detailed under Startup information. The manufacturer will not assume responsibility for equipment damage resulting from accumulation of condensate on the unit electrical components. RT-SVX34U-EN Unit Dimensions and Weights Recommended Clearances Adequate clearance around and above each Voyager Commercial unit is required to ensure proper operation and to allow sufficient access for servicing. If the unit installation is higher than the typical curb elevation, a field constructed catwalk around the unit is recommended to provide safe, easy access for maintenance and servicing. Table 1, p. 19 lists the recommended clearances for single and multiple unit installation. These clearances are necessary to assure adequate serviceability, cataloged capacities, and peak operating efficiency. If the clearances available on the job site appear to be inadequate, review them with your Trane sales representative. Roof Curb and Ductwork The curbs for the 27.5 to 50 Tons commercial rooftop units enclose the entire unit base area. They are referred to as "full perimeter" type curbs. Step-by-step instructions for the curb assembly and installation with curb dimensions and curb configuration for "A", "B", and "C" cabinets ship with each Trane accessory roof curb kit. (See the latest edition of the curb installation guide) Follow the instructions carefully to assure proper fit when the unit is set into place. The S/A and R/A ductwork adjoining the roof curb must be fabricated and installed by the installing contractor before the unit is set into place. Trane curbs include flanges around the openings to accommodate duct attachment. Ductwork installation recommendations are included in the instruction booklet that ships with each Trane accessory roof curb kit. Note: For sound consideration, cut only the holes in the roof deck for the supply and return duct penetration. Do not remove the roof decking from the inside perimeter of the curb. If a Trane curb accessory kit is not used: · The ductwork can be attached directly to the S/A and R/A openings. Be sure to use a flexible duct connector at the unit. · For "built-up" curbs supplied by others, gaskets must be installed around the curb perimeter flange, Supply Air opening, and Return Air openings. · Insulation must be installed on the bottom of the condenser section of the unit. Horizontal Ductwork When attaching the ductwork to a horizontal supply or horizontal return unit, provide a water tight flexible connector at the unit to prevent noise transmission from the unit into the ductwork. Refer to figures beginning on page for the S/A and R/A opening dimensions. All outdoor ductwork between the unit and the structure should be weather proofed after installation is completed. If optional power exhaust is selected, an access door must be field-installed on the horizontal return ductwork to provide access to exhaust fan motors. RT-SVX34U-EN 13 Unit Dimensions and Weights Unit Dimensions Figure 1. 60 Hz 27.5-35, 50 Hz 23-29 Tons (TCD, TED, YCD low heat) Figure 2. Rear view showing duct openings for horizontal supply and return, 60 Hz 27.5-35, 50 Hz 23-29 Tons (TCH, TEH, YCH low heat) 3 1/4 (81) 1 1/4 (32) Notes: · · On horizontal units, the VFD is located between the supply and return ductwork, which makes access limited. For combination of horizontal and downflow openings (digit 3 = F or R) see Figure 1, p. 14 for appropriate downflow/upflow dimensions and Figure 2, p. 14 for appropriate horizontal dimensions. 14 RT-SVX34U-EN Unit Dimensions and Weights Figure 3. 60 Hz 27.5-35, 50 Hz 23-29 Tons (TC, TE, YC low heat) 90 3/8" 2295.5mm NOTES: 1. SEE DETAIL HOOD DRAWING FOR HORIZONTAL / DOWNFLOW UNITS FOR ADDITIONAL DIMENSION AND LOCATION. 180 5/16" 4579.9mm SEE NOTE 2 3.25 [82.55mm] TO TOP OF FAN GRILLE 42" 1066.8mm 1 1/4" [31.7mm] FEMALE PVC PIPE 5 3/8" 136.5mm 83 13/16" 2128.8mm 7 9/16" 192.1mm 3/4" [19.0mm] NPT GAS INLET 179 3/4" 4565.65mm 40 3/16" 1020.7mm CUSTOMER CONNECTION POINT 6 7/8" 174.6mm Note: Dimensions in ( ) are mm, 1"= 25.4 mm. Figure 4. 60 Hz 27.5-35, 50 Hz 23-29 Tons (YCD high heat) 70 7/16" 1789.1mm 90 1/16" 2287.5mm 196 4991 RT-SVX34U-EN 15 Unit Dimensions and Weights Figure 5. Duct openings, 60 Hz 27.5-35, 50 Hz 23-29 Tons (YCH high heat) 3 1/4 (81) 1 1/4 (32) Notes: · · On horizontal units, the VFD is located between the supply and return ductwork, which makes access limited. For combination of horizontal and downflow openings (digit 3 = F or R) see Figure 4, p. 15 for appropriate downflow/upflow dimensions and Figure 5, p. 16 for appropriate horizontal dimensions. Figure 6. 60 Hz 27.5-35, 50 Hz 23-29 Tons (YC high heat) 90 5/8" 2301.8mm 208 1/16" 5284.7mm NOTES: 1. SEE ROOFCURB DRAWING FOR DETAILS ON FIELD DUCT FITUP AND CONNECTIONS 2. SEE DETAIL HOOD DRAWING FOR HORIZONTAL / DOWNFLOW UNITS FOR ADDITIONAL DIMENSION AND LOCATION. SEE NOTE 2 3.25 [82.55mm] TO TOP OF FAN GRILLE 42" 1066.8mm 1 1/4" [31.7mm] PVC PIPE FEMALE 5 3/8" 136.5m 83 13/16" 2128.8mm 1" [25.4MM] NPT GAS INLET 7 9/16" 192.1m 207 1/2" 5270.5mm CUSTOMER CONNECTION POINT Note: Dimensions in ( ) are mm, 1"= 25.4 mm. 40 3/16" 1020.7mm 6 15/16" 174.6mm 90 1/16" 2287.5mm 70 7/16" 1789.1mm 16 RT-SVX34U-EN Unit Dimensions and Weights Figure 7. 60 Hz 40-50, 50 Hz 33-42 Tons (TCD, TCD, YCD low and high heat) Figure 8. Duct openings, 60 Hz 40-50, 50 Hz 33-42 Tons (TH, TH, YH low and high heat) 3 1/4 (81) 1 1/4 (32) Notes: · · On horizontal units, the VFD is located between the supply and return ductwork, which makes access limited. For combination of horizontal and downflow openings (digit 3 = F or R) see Figure 7, p. 17 for appropriate downflow/upflow dimensions and Figure 8, p. 17 for appropriate horizontal dimensions. RT-SVX34U-EN 17 Unit Dimensions and Weights Figure 9. 60 Hz 40-50, 50 Hz 33-42 Tons (TC, TE, YC low and high heat) 90 5/8" 2301.8mm SEE NOTE 2 232 3/4" 5911.8mm NOTES: 1. SEE ROOFCURB DRAWING FOR DETAILS ON FIELD DUCT FITUP AND CONNECTIONS 2. SEE DETAIL HOOD DRAWING FOR HORIZONTAL / DOWNFLOW UNITS FOR ADDITIONAL DIMENSION AND LOCATION. 3.25 [82.55mm] TO TOP OF FAN GRILLE 49 9/16" 1258.8mm 1 1/4" [31.7mm] PVC PIPE FEMALE 5 5/16" 136.5m 93 3/8" 2371.7mm 1" [25.4MM] NPT HIGH HEAT GAS INLET 3/4" [19MM] NPT LOW HEAT GAS INLET 7 9/16" 192.1m 232 3/8" 5902.3mm CUSTOMER CONNECTION POINT 46 15/16" 1192.2mm 4 3/4" 120.6mm 90 1/16" 2287.5mm 77" 1955.8mm Note: Dimensions in ( ) are mm, 1"= 25.4 mm. Figure 10. Side view showing fresh air and power exhaust hoods for downflow return (TC*, TE*, and YC* units) Figure 11. Side view showing power exhaust hoods for horizontal return (TC*, TE*, and YC* units) Fresh Air Hood Pow er Exhaust Hood End of Unit 2 7/16" (62) 32 1/8" (814) 37 3/4" (959) Pow er Exhaust Hoods End of Unit 32 1/8" (814) 2 7/16" (62) 18 RT-SVX34U-EN Figure 12. Location of "Ship With" items for TC*, TE*, and YC* units Unit Rigging and Placement Use spreader bars as shown in the diagram. Refer to the Installation manual or nameplate for unit weight. Refer to the Installation instructions located inside the control panel for further rigging information. Verify that the roof curb has the proper gaskets installed and is level and square to assure an adequate curb-to-unit seal. The units must be as level as possible in order to assure proper condensate flow out of the unit. The maximum side-to-side and end-to-end slope allowable in any application is listed in Table 2, p. 19. Figure 13. Unit rigging Unit Dimensions and Weights Table 1. Minimum operating clearances installation (horizontal, downflow, and mixed airflow configurations) Condenser Coil Economizer/ Orientation Service Side Exhaust End End/Side Access Single Unit (Clearance) Multiple Units (Distance between Units) 6 feet 12 feet 8 feet 16 feet 4 feet 8 feet Note: Condenser coil is located at the end and side of the unit. Table 2. Maximum slope Cabinet "A" (27.5 - 35 Ton Low Heat) End to End (inches) 3 1/2 Side to Side (inches) 1 5/8 "B" (27.5 - 35 Ton High Heat) "C" (All 40 and 50 Ton Units) 4 4 1/2 1 5/8 1 5/8 Note: Do not exceed these allowances. Correct the improper slope by building up the curb base. The material used to raise the base must be adequate to support both the curb and the unit weight. Table 3. Center of gravity Center-of-Gravity (inches) Unit Model YC Low Heat Dimension XYZ YC High Heat Dimension XYZ TC/TE Dimension XYZ ***330/ 275* 41 76 33 41 84 33 42 76 33 ***360/ 305* 43 77 33 43 85 33 44 77 33 ***420/ 350* 42 78 33 42 86 33 43 78 33 ***480/ 400* 42 111 35 42 111 35 42 111 35 ***600/ 500* 43 108 35 43 108 35 43 108 35 Notes: 1. 2. 3. Center-of-gravity dimensions are approximate, and are based on the unit equipped with: standard efficiency coils, standard efficiency motors, economizer, and throwaway filters. Z dimension is upward from the base of the unit. Example: Locating the center-of-gravity for a YC-360 MBH High Heat unit with 100% exhaust; X = 43 inches inward from the control panel side/ Y = 85 inches inward from the compressor end/ Z = 33 inches upward from the base RT-SVX34U-EN 19 Unit Dimensions and Weights Figure 14. Center of gravity Z (see note 2) Y X Table 4. Approximate units operating weights -- lbs./kg Unit Basic Unit Weights Model (60Hz/ YC Low 50Hz) Heat YC High Heat TC TE 330/275 3720 / 1687 4150 / 1882 3590 / 1628 3610 / 1637.5 360/305 3795 / 1721 4225 / 1916 3665 / 1662 3685 / 1671.5 420/350 3876 / 1758 4306 / 1953 3746 / 1699 3766 / 1708 480/400 4825 / 2189 4950 / 2245 4565 / 2071 4600 / 2086.5 600/500 5077 / 2303 5202 / 2360 4827 / 2189.5 4852 / 2201 Note: Weights shown represent approximate operating weights and have a ±10% accuracy. To calculate weight for a specific unit configuration, utilize TOPSSTM or contact the local Trane® sales representative. ACTUAL WEIGHTS ARE STAMPED ON THE UNIT NAMEPLATE. Table 5. Point loading average weight-- lbs./kg Unit Model (60Hz/ A B C D E F 50Hz) 330/275 852 / 386 695 / 315 754 / 342 740 / 335 602 / 273 504 / 228 360/305 878 / 681 / 750 / 713 / 577 / 622 / 398 309 340 323 262 282 420/350 841 / 381 842 / 382 669 / 303 735 / 333 582 / 264 634 / 287 480/400 835 / 869 / 950 / 748 / 769 / 776 / 378 394 431 339 349 352 600/500 882 / 400 931 / 422 954 / 433 740 / 336 844 / 382 847 / 384 Notes: 1. Point loading is identified with corner A being the corner with the compressors. As you move clockwise around the unit as viewed from the top, mid-point B, corner C, corner D, mid-point E and corner F. 2. Point load calculations provided are based on the unit weight for YC high heat gas models. 20 RT-SVX34U-EN Unit Dimensions and Weights Table 6. Approximate operating weights-- optional components -- lbs./kg Unit Model Baro. (60Hz/50Hz) Relief Power Ex- haust 0-25% Man Damper Econ. Var. Freq. Drives (VFD's) W/O With Bypass Serv. Valves Thruthe base Elec. NonFused Discon. Switch Factory GFI with Discon. Switch Roof Curb Lo Hi HGRH Coil **(D,F)330/275 110/50 165/74 50/23 260/117 85/39 115/52 18/8 6/3 30/14 85/38 310/141 330/150 107/49 **(H,R)330/275 145/65 200/90 50/23 285/128 85/39 115/52 18/8 6/3 30/14 85/38 310/141 330/150 107/49 **(D,F)360/305 110/50 165/74 50/23 260/117 85/39 115/52 18/8 6/3 30/14 85/38 310/141 330/150 107/49 **(H,R)360/305 145/65 200/90 50/23 285/128 85/39 115/52 18/8 6/3 30/14 85/38 310/141 330/150 107/49 **(D,F)420/350 110/50 165/74 50/23 260/117 85/39 115/52 18/8 6/3 30/14 85/38 310/141 330/150 107/49 **(H,R)420/350 145/65 200/90 50/23 285/128 85/39 115/52 18/8 6/3 30/14 85/38 310/141 330/150 107/49 **(D,F)480/400 110/50 165/74 50/23 290/131 115/52 150/68 18/8 6/3 30/14 85/38 365/169 365/169 112/51 **(H,R)480/400 145/65 200/90 50/23 300/135 115/52 150/68 18/8 6/3 30/14 85/38 365/169 365/169 112/51 **(D,F)600/500 110/50 165/74 50/23 290/131 115/52 150/68 18/8 6/3 30/14 85/38 365/169 365/169 112/51 **(H,R)600/500 145/65 200/90 ConUnit Model denser (60Hz/50Hz) Hail Guards Ultra Low Leak Econ **(D,F)330/275 105/48 112/51 50/23 Ultra Low Leak 50% Exhaust 34 / 15 300/135 115/52 Ultra Low Leak 100% Exhaust High Efficiency 74 / 34 326/148 150/68 18/8 6/3 30/14 85/38 365/169 365/169 112/51 **(H,R)330/275 105/48 78/35 34 / 15 77 / 35 326/148 **(D,F)360/305 105/48 112/51 34 / 15 74 / 34 255/116 **(H,R)360/305 105/48 78 /35 34 / 15 77 / 35 255/116 **(D,F)420/350 105/48 112/51 34 / 15 74 / 34 173/78 **(H,R)420/350 105/48 78/35 34 / 15 77 / 35 173/78 **(D,F)480/400 130/59 114/52 34 / 15 74 / 34 241/109 **(H,R)480/400 130/59 100/45 34 / 15 84 / 38 241/109 **(D,F)600/500 130/59 114/52 34 / 15 74 / 34 -25/-11 **(H,R)600/500 130/59 100/45 34 / 15 84 / 38 -25/-11 Note: Basic unit weight includes minimum horsepower supply fan motor. RT-SVX34U-EN 21 Pre-Installation The checklist listed below is a summary of the steps required to successfully install a Voyager Commercial rooftop unit. This checklist is intended to acquaint the installing personnel with what is required in the installation process. It does not replace the detailed instructions called out in the applicable sections of this manual. General Unit Requirements Downflow/Upflow Models · An optional roof curb, specifically designed for the Voyager commercial rooftop units is available from Trane. The roof curb kit must be field assembled and installed according to the latest edition of the curb installation guide. · Assemble and install the roof curb, including necessary gaskets. Make sure the curb is level. · Install and secure the ductwork to the curb. All Units · Check unit for shipping damage and material shortage. (Refer to "General Information," p. 12). · Rigging the unit. Refer to Figure 13, p. 19. · Placing the unit on curb; check for levelness. · Ensure that the unit-to-curb seal is tight and without buckles or cracks. · Install an appropriate drain line to the evaporator condensate drain connections, as required. Refer to Figure 15, p. 23. · Service Valve Option; See "Starting the Compressor," p. 89. · Return/Fresh-air damper adjustment. Refer to "Economizer (O/A) Dampers," p. 84. · Exhaust Fan Damper Stop Adjustment. Refer to Exhaust Damper Adjustment figures, beginning with Figure 54, p. 84. Electrical Requirements WARNING Proper Field Wiring and Grounding Required! Failure to follow code could result in death or serious injury. All field wiring MUST be performed by qualified personnel. Improperly installed and grounded field wiring poses FIRE and ELECTROCUTION hazards. To avoid these hazards, you MUST follow requirements for field wiring installation and grounding as described in NEC and your local/ state/national electrical codes. · Verify that the electrical power supply characteristics comply with the unit nameplate specifications. · Inspect all control panel components; tighten any loose connections. · Connect properly sized and protected power supply wiring to a field supplied/installed disconnect and unit power terminal block HTB1, or to the optional unit-mounted disconnect switch. · Properly ground the unit. Field Installed Control Wiring Refer to Figure 21, p. 34 and Figure 22, p. 35. Complete the field wiring connections for the constant volume and variable air volume controls as applicable. Refer to "Low Voltage Wiring," p. 32. Important: All field-installed wiring must comply with NEC and applicable local codes. Gas Heat Requirements Refer to "Installation Piping," p. 40. · Gas supply line properly sized and connected to the unit gas train. · All gas piping joints properly sealed. · Drip leg Installed in the gas piping near the unit. · Gas piping leak checked with a soap solution. If piping connections to the unit are complete, do not pressurize piping in excess of 0.50 psig or 14 inches w.c. to prevent component failure. · Main supply gas pressure adequate. · Flue Tubes clear of any obstructions. 22 RT-SVX34U-EN Installation General Requirements Condensate Drain Connection Each commercial rooftop unit is equipped with one (1) 1-1/4 inch Female NPT (threaded) drain connection. Refer to "Unit Dimensions and Weights," p. 13 for the location of the connector. A condensate trap must be installed due to the drain connection being on the "negative pressure" side of the fan. Install a P-Trap at the unit using the guidelines in Figure 15, p. 23. Pitch the drain line at least 1/2 inch for every 10 feet of horizontal run to assure proper condensate flow. Ensure that all condensate drain line installations comply with applicable building and waste disposal codes. Notes: · For units with optional Condensate Overflow Switch (COF), the switch will not work properly if unit is not level or slightly sloped toward switch. · To ensure proper condensate flow during operation the unit and the curb must be level. Figure 15. Condensate trap installation Condensate Overflow Switch This switch protects building from condensate overflow damage. It is factory-installed and tested. Figure 16. Condensate overflow switch location O/A Sensor & Tubing Installation An Outside Air Pressure Sensor is shipped with all units designed to operate on traditional variable air volume applications (non-SZ VAV) and units with StatitracTM. A duct pressure transducer and the outside air sensor is used to control the discharge duct static pressure to within a customer-specified controlband. Refer to the illustration in Figure 17, p. 24 and the following steps to install the sensor and the pneumatic tubing. 1. Remove the O/A pressure sensor kit located inside the fan section. The kit contains the following items; · an O/A static pressure sensor · a sensor mounting bracket · 50' of 3/16" O.D. pneumatic tubing · mounting hardware 2. Using two #10-32 x 1-3/4" screws provided, install the sensor's mounting bracket to the factory provided bracket (near the fan section). 3. Using the #10-32 x 1/2" screws provided, install the O/A static pressure sensor vertically to the sensor bracket. 4. Remove the dust cap from the tubing connector located below the sensor in the vertical support. 5. Attach one end of the 50' x 3/16" O.D. factory provided pneumatic tubing to the sensor's top port, and the other end of the tubing to the connector in the vertical support. Discard any excess tubing. RT-SVX34U-EN 23 Installation General Requirements Units with StatitracTM 1. Open the filter access door, and locate the Statitrac Transducer Assembly illustrated in Figure 18, p. 25. There are two tube connectors mounted on the left of the solenoid and transducers. Connect one end of the field provided 1/4" (length 50-100 ft.) or 3/8" (length greater than 100 ft.) O.D. pneumatic tubing Figure 17. Pressure tubing for the space pressurization control to the fitting indicated in the illustration. 2. Route the opposite end of the tubing to a suitable location inside the building. This location should be the largest open area that will not be affected by sudden static pressure changes. Atmospheric Pressure Sensing Kit Top Port Connection 2' X 3/16" OD tubing factory provided pneumatic tubing field installed) Tubing connector (in vertical support) Outside air pressure sensor Sensor mounting bracket Factory provided bracket Duct Pressure Transducer Tubing Schematic Duct static transducer Duct Pressure Control Component Layout Supply air duct static transducer Sensing tube to outside air reference Sensing tube to discharge static pressure sensing location Atmospheric reference tubing connects here 24 RT-SVX34U-EN Figure 18. Transducer assembly Installation General Requirements Airflow Transducer LO HI Sensing Tube to Traq HI Side Pressure Port C NO NC Sensing Tube to Traq LO Side Pressure Port Note: Statitrac and Traq transducer assembly shown. RT-SVX34U-EN 25 Installation Electrical WARNING Hazardous Voltage! Failure to disconnect power before servicing could result in death or serious injury. Disconnect all electric power, including remote disconnects before servicing. Follow proper lockout/tagout procedures to ensure the power can not be inadvertently energized. Verify that no power is present with a voltmeter. Disconnect Switch External Handle (Factory Mounted Option) Units ordered with the factory mounted disconnect switch come equipped with an externally mounted handle. This allows the operator to disconnect power from the unit without having to open the control panel door. The handle location and its three positions are shown below; · ON - Indicates that the disconnect switch is closed, allowing the main power supply to be applied at the unit. · OFF - Indicates that the disconnect switch is open, interrupting the main power supply at the unit. · OPEN COVER/RESET - Turning the handle to this position releases the handle from the disconnect switch, allowing the control panel door to be opened. Once the door has been opened, it can be closed with the handle in any one of the three positions outlined above, provided it matches the disconnect switch position. The handle can be locked in the "OFF" position. While holding the handle in the "OFF" position, push the spring loaded thumb key, attached to the handle, into the base slot. Place the lock shackle between the handle and the thumb key. This will prevent it from springing out of position. Figure 19. Disconnect switch Locking slot (OFF) Locking thumb key Control Panel Disconnect switch external handle Compressor Panel An overall layout of the field required power wiring is illustrated in . To insure that the unit supply power wiring is properly sized and installed, follow the guidelines outlined below. Note: All field installed wiring must conform to NEC guidelines as well as State and Local codes. Verify that the power supply available is compatible with the unit's name plate ratings for all components. The available power supply must be within 10% of the rated voltage stamped on the nameplate. Use only copper conductors to connect the 3-phase power supply to the unit. Main Power Wiring WARNING Proper Field Wiring and Grounding Required! Failure to follow code could result in death or serious injury. All field wiring MUST be performed by qualified personnel. Improperly installed and grounded field wiring poses FIRE and ELECTROCUTION hazards. To avoid these hazards, you MUST follow requirements for field wiring installation and grounding as described in NEC and your local/ state/national electrical codes. NOTICE Use Copper Conductors Only! Failure to use copper conductors could result in equipment damage as the equipment was not designed or qualified to accept other types of conductors. 26 RT-SVX34U-EN · Table 7, p. 28 to Table 14, p. 31 list the electrical service sizing data. The electrical service must be protected from over current and short circuit conditions in accordance with NEC requirements. Protection devices must be sized according to the electrical data on the nameplate. Refer to "Electrical Wire Sizing and Protection Device Equations," p. 31 for determining: The appropriate electrical service wire size based on "Minimum Circuit Ampacity" (MCA), The "Maximum Over current Protection" (MOP) device. The "Recommended Dual Element fuse size" (RDE). · If the unit is not equipped with an optional factory installed Nonfused disconnect switch, a field supplied disconnect switch must be installed at or near the unit in accordance with the National Figure 20. Typical field power wiring Installation Electrical Electrical Code (NEC latest edition). Refer to DSS calculations "Electrical Wire Sizing and Protection Device Equations," p. 31 for determining correct size. Location for the electrical service entrance is shown in the unit dimensional drawings beginning with Figure 1, p. 14. Complete the unit's power wiring connections onto either the main terminal block HTB1, or the factory mounted nonfused disconnect switch inside the unit control panel. Note: When the factory installed through-the-base option is not used, the installing contractor is required to seal any holes made in the base of the unit to prevent water from leaking into the building. · Provide proper grounding for the unit in accordance with local and national codes. RT-SVX34U-EN 27 Installation Electrical Through-the-Base Electrical (Optional Accessory) Liquid-tight conduit couplings are secured to the base of the unit for both power and control wiring. Liquidtight conduit must be field installed between the couplings and the unit control box to prevent water leaks into the building. Note: If the unit is set on the roof curb and temporary auxiliary heat is provided in the building, it is recommended that the electrical and control wiring conduit opening in the control box be temporarily sealed to provide a vapor barrier. Electrical Service Sizing Data Table 7. 27.5-35 ton electrical service sizing data -- 60Hz Model Elec. Specs Allowable Comp. Std Eff Voltage Range No/Ton RLA (Ea.) LRA (Ea.) Comp. High Eff, eStage No/ RLA LRA Ton (Ea.) (Ea.) Supply HP FLA Fan Motors Condenser Exhaust FLA 50% 100% FLA No HP (Ea.) No. HP (Ea.) 208/60/ 3 187-229 1/12, 1/ 13 44.0/ 50.5 304/ 315 1/6, 2/9 28.0, 37.1 203, 267 7.5, 10 22.8, 29.5 3 1.1 7 1 2 1.0 4.1 TC/TE/ 230/60/ 3 207-253 1/12, 1/ 13 44.0/ 50.5 304/ 315 1/6, 2/9 28.0, 203, 267 7.5, 19.5, 37.1 10 25.2 3 1.1 7 1 YC*330 460/60/ 3 414-506 1/12, 1/ 13 21.0/ 23.0 147/ 1/6, 158 2/9 14.1, 16.8 98, 142 7.5, 10 9.8, 12.6 3 1.1 3.5 1 2 1.0 4.1 2 1.0 1.8 575/60/ 3 517-633 1/12, 1/ 13 17.5/ 19.0 122/ 1/6, 136 2/9 12.2, 14.7 84, 103 7.5, 10 7.8, 10.1 3 1.1 2.8 1 208/60/ 3 187-229 0.1538 50.5 315/ 1/6, 315 2/10 28.0, 40.9 203, 267 7.5, 10, 15 22.8, 29.5, 42.4 3 1.1 7 1 TC/TE/ 230/60/ 3 207-253 0.1538 50.5 315/ 1/6, 315 2/10 28.0, 40.9 203, 267 7.5, 10, 15 19.5, 25.2, 36.0 3 1.1 7 1 YC*360 460/60/ 3 414-506 0.1538 23 158/ 1/6, 158 2/10 14.1, 18.6 98, 142 7.5, 10, 15 9.8, 12.6, 18.0 3 1.1 3.5 1 575/60/ 3 517-633 0.1538 19 136/ 1/6, 136 2/10 12.2, 15.4 84, 103 7.5, 10, 15 7.8, 10.1, 15.0 3 1.1 2.8 1 208/60/ 3 187-229 1/13, 1/ 15 50.5/ 56.0 315/ 1/6, 351 2/11 28.0, 44.9 203, 304 7.5, 10, 15 22.8, 29.5, 42.4 3 1.1 7 1 TC/TE/ 230/60/ 3 207-253 1/13, 1/ 15 50.5/ 56.0 315/ 1/6, 351 2/11 28.0, 44.9 203, 304 7.5, 10, 15 19.5, 25.2, 36.0 3 1.1 7 1 YC*420 460/60/ 3 414-506 1/13, 1/ 15 23.0/ 27.5 158/ 1/6, 197 2/11 14.1, 19.2 98, 147 7.5, 10, 15 9.8, 12.6, 18.0 3 1.1 3.5 1 575/60/ 3 517-633 1/13, 1/ 15 19.0/ 23.0 136/ 1/6, 146 2/11 12.2, 16.6 84, 122 7.5, 10, 15 7.8, 10.1, 15.0 3 1.1 2.8 1 Notes: 1. All customer wiring and devices must be installed in accordance with local and national electrical codes. 2. 100% Power Exhaust is with or without StatitracTM. 2 1.0 1.4 2 1.0 4.1 2 1.0 4.1 2 1.0 1.8 2 1.0 1.4 2 1.0 4.1 2 1.0 4.1 2 1.0 1.8 2 1.0 1.4 28 RT-SVX34U-EN Installation Electrical Table 8. 40-50 ton electrical service sizing data -- 60Hz Elec. Model Specs Allowable Voltage Range Comp. Std Eff VAV Only Comp. Std Eff CV & High Eff eStage Supply No/ Ton RLA (Ea.) LRA (Ea.) No/ Ton RLA LRA (Ea.) (Ea.) HP FLA Fan Motors Condenser Exhaust FLA 50% 100% FLA No HP (Ea.) No. HP (Ea.) 208/60/3 187-229 1/13, 1/20 50.5/ 83.9 315/ 1/8, 31.1, 203, 10, 29.5, 485 2/13 50.5 315 15 42.4 4 1.1 7 1 2 1.5 5.4 230/60/3 TC/TE/ 207-253 1/13, 1/20 50.5/ 83.9 315/ 1/8, 31.1, 203, 10, 25.2, 485 2/13 50.5 315 15 36.0 4 1.1 7 1 YC*480 460/60/3 414-506 1/13, 1/20 23.0/ 34.0 158/ 1/8, 14.1, 98, 215 2/13 23.0 158 10, 12.6, 15 18.0 4 1.1 3.5 1 2 1.5 5.4 2 1.5 2.7 575/60/3 517-633 1/13, 1/20 19.0/ 27.3 136/ 1/8, 11.5, 84, 175 2/13 19.0 136 10, 10.1, 15 15.0 4 1.1 2.8 1 208/60/3 187-229 2/13, 1/15 50.5/ 56.0 315/ 351 1/10, 40.9, 2/15 58.5 267, 351 10, 15, 20 29.5, 42.4, 56.1 4 1.1 7 1 230/60/3 TC/TE/ 2/13, 207-253 1/15 50.5/ 56.0 315/ 351 1/10, 40.9, 2/15 58.5 267, 351 10, 15, 20 25.2, 36.0, 49.4 4 1.1 7 1 YC*600 460/60/3 414-506 2/13, 1/15 23.0/ 27.5 158/ 197 1/10, 18.6, 2/15 27.5 142, 197 10, 15, 20 12.6, 18.0, 24.7 4 1.1 3.5 1 575/60/3 517-633 2/13, 1/15 19.0/ 23.0 136/ 146 1/10, 15.4, 2/15 23.0 103, 135 10, 15, 20 10.1, 15.0, 19.5 4 1.1 2.8 1 Notes: 1. All customer wiring and devices must be installed in accordance with local and national electrical codes. 2. 100% Power Exhaust is with or without StatitracTM. 2 1.5 2.2 2 1.5 5.4 2 1.5 5.4 2 1.5 2.7 2 1.5 2.2 Table 9. Electrical service sizing data -- electric heat module (electric heat only) -- 60 Hz Models: TE(D,H,F,R) 330--600 Electric Heat FLA Nominal Unit Size (Tons) Nominal Unit Voltage 36 KW Heater (FLA) 54 72 90 208 74.9 112.4 NA NA 108 NA 27.5-35 230 86.6 129.9 NA NA NA 460 43.3 65 86.6 108.3 NA 575 NA 52 69.3 86.6 NA 208 NA 112.4 NA NA NA 40-50 230 NA 129.9 NA NA NA 460 NA 65 86.6 108.3 129.9 575 NA 52 69.3 86.6 103.9 Note: All FLA in this table are based on heater operating at 208, 240, 480, and 600 volts. Table 10. Electrical service sizing data -- crankcase heaters (heating mode only) -- 60Hz Nominal Unit Size (Tons) 27.5 - 35 40, 50 FLA Add Unit Voltage 200 1 230 1 460 1 575 1 2 2 1 1 RT-SVX34U-EN 29 Installation Electrical Table 11. Electrical service sizing data -- 275350 units 50Hz Model Elec. Specs Comp. Std Eff Comp. High Eff, eStage Supply No/ Ton RLA LRA (Ea.) (Ea.) No/ Ton RLA LRA HP (Ea.) (Ea.) (kW) FLA Fan Motors Condenser Exhaust HP FLA 50% 100% HP FLA No (kW) (Ea.) No. (kW) (Ea.) 7.5 12.1/ TC/TE/ YC*275 380/415/ 50/3 1/10, 21.0/ 1/11 23.0 147/ 158 1/6, 2/ 9 14.1, 16.8 98, 142 (5.6), 10 11.5, 15.2/ 0.75 3 (0.56) 4.4 1 (6.8) 14.6 7.5 12.1/ TC/TE/ YC*305 380-415/ 50/3 0.1818 23 158 1/6, 2/ 10 14.1, 18.6 98, 142 (5.6), 10 11.5, 15.2/ 0.75 3 (0.56) 4.4 1 (6.8) 14.6 7.5 12.1/ (5.6), 11.5, TC/TE/ YC*350 380-415/ 50/3 1/11, 23.0/ 1/12 27.5 158/ 197 1/6, 2/ 11 14.1, 19.2 98, 147 10 (6.8), 15.2/ 14.6, 0.75 3 (0.56) 4.4 1 15 22.0/ Notes: (10.5) 23.0 1. All customer wiring and devices must be installed in accordance with local and national electrical codes. 2. Allowable voltage range for the 380V unit is 342-418V, allowable voltage range for the 415V unit is 373-456. 3. 100% Power Exhaust is with or without StatitracTM. 4. All condenser fan motors are single phase. 0.75 2 (0.56) 1.7 0.75 2 (0.56) 1.7 0.75 2 (0.56) 1.7 Table 12. Electrical service sizing data -- 400500 50Hz Model Elec. Specs Comp. Std Eff VAV Comp. Std Eff CV & Only High Eff eStage Supply No/ Ton RLA LRA (Ea.) (Ea.) No/ Ton RLA LRA HP (Ea.) (Ea.) (kW) FLA Fan Motors Condenser Exhaust HP FLA 50% 100% HP FLA No (kW) (Ea.) No. (kW) (Ea.) 10 15.2/ TC/TE/ YC*400 380-415/ 50/3 1/11, 23.0/ 1/17 34.0 158/ 215 1/8, 2/ 13 14.1, 23.0 98, 158 (6.8), 15 14.6, 22.0/ 0.75 4 (0.56) 4.4 1 (10.5) 23.0 10 15.2/ (6.8), 14.6, TC/TE/ YC*500 380-415/ 2/11, 23.0/ 158/ 1/10, 18.6, 142, 15 22.0/ 50/3 1/12 27.5 197 2/15 27.5 155 (10.5), 23.0, 0.75 4 (0.56) 4.4 1 20 28.0/ Notes: (12.8) 28.0 1. All customer wiring and devices must be installed in accordance with local and national electrical codes. 2. Allowable voltage range for the 380V unit is 342-418V, allowable voltage range for the 415V unit is 373-456. 3. 100% Power Exhaust is with or without StatitracTM. 4. All condenser fan motors are single phase. 2 1.0 (0.75) 2.5 1.0 2 (0.75) 2.5 30 RT-SVX34U-EN Table 13. Electrical service sizing data electric heat module (electric heat units only)--50Hz Models: TE(D,H,F,R) 275 through 500 Electric Heat FLA Nominal Unit Size (Tons) Nominal Unit Voltage KW Heater (380/415V) 23/ 34/ 45/ 56/ 68/ 27 40 54 67 81 23-29 380 34.5 51.1 68.9 85.5 415 37.6 55.6 380 51.1 68.9 85.5 103.4 33, 42 415 55.6 75.1 93.2 112.7 Note: All FLA in this table are based on heater operating at 380 or 415 volts as shown above. Table 14. Electrical service sizing data -- crankcase heaters (heating mode only) -- 50Hz Nominal Unit Size (Tons) 23 - 29 33 - 42 FLA Add Unit Voltage 380 415 1 1 1 1 Electrical Wire Sizing and Protection Device Equations To correctly size the main power wiring based on MCA (Minimum Circuit Ampacity), use the appropriate equation listed below. Read the definitions that follow and then use Calculation #1 for determining MCA (Minimum Circuit Ampacity), MOP (Maximum Over current Protection), and RDE (Recommended Dual Element fuse size) for TC (Cooling Only) units and YC (Cooling with Gas Heat) units. Use Calculation #2 for TE (Cooling with Electric Heat) units. Load Definitions: · LOAD 1 = CURRENT OF THE LARGEST MOTOR (Compressor or Fan Motor) · LOAD 2 = SUM OF THE CURRENTS OF ALL REMAINING MOTORS · LOAD 3 = FLA (Full Load Amps) OF THE ELECTRIC HEATER · LOAD 4 = ANY OTHER LOAD RATED AT 1 AMP OR MORE · CRANKCASE HEATERS FOR HEATING MODE ONLY: 208/230 VOLT · 27.5 - 35 Ton Units, Add 1 Amp · 40 - 50 Ton Units, Add 2 Amps 460/575 VOLT RT-SVX34U-EN Installation Electrical · 27.5 - 35 Tons Units, Add 1 Amp · 40 - 50 Ton Units, Add 1 Amp Calculation #1 - TC*, YC* - 27.5 to 50 Ton Units · MCA = (1.25 x Load 1) + Load 2 + Load 4 · MOP = (2.25 x Load 1) + Load 2 + Load 4 (See Note 1) Note: Select an over current protection device equal to the MOP value. If the calculated MOP value does not equal a standard size protection device listed in NEC 240-6, select the next lower over current protection device. If the calculated MOP value is less than the MCA value, select the lowest over current protection device which is equal to or larger than the MCA, providing the selected over current device does not exceed 800 amps. · RDE = (1.5 x Load 1) + Load 2 + Load 4 (See Note 2) Note: Select a Dual Element Fuse equal to the RDE value. If the calculated RDE value does not equal a standard dual element fuse size listed in NEC 240-6, select the next higher fuse size. If the calculated RDE value is greater than the MOP value, select a Dual Element fuse equal to the calculated MOP (Maximum Over current Protection) value. Calculation #2 - TE* - 27.5 to 50 Ton Units Note: The following applies to single source power units (all voltages). To calculate the correct MCA (Minimum Circuit Ampacity), MOP (Maximum Over current Protection), and RDE (Recommended Dual Element fuse size), two (2) sets of calculations must be performed: · Calculate the MCA, MOP and/or RDE values using the above equation as if the unit is operating in the cooling mode. · Calculate the MCA, MOP and/or RDE values as if the unit is operating in the heating mode, as follows: Note: When determining loads, the compressors and condenser fan motors do not operate during the heating cycle. Units with Less than 50 KW Heaters MCA = 1.25 x (Load 1 + Load 2 + Load 4) + (1.25 x Load 3) Units with 50 KW or Larger Heaters · MCA = 1.25 x (Load 1 + Load 2 + Load 4) + Load 3 Note: The MCA value stamped on the nameplate is the largest of the two calculated values. · MOP = (2.25 x Load 1) + Load 2 + Load 3 + Load 4 31 Installation Electrical Note: The MOP value stamped on the nameplate is the largest of the two calculated values. · RDE = (1.5 x Load 1) + Load 2 + Load 3 + Load 4 Note: Select an over current protection device equal to the MOP value. If the calculated MOP value does not equal a standard size protection device listed in NEC 240-6, select the next lower over current protection device. If the calculated MOP value is less than the MCA value, select the lowest over current protection device which is equal to or larger than the MCA, providing the selected over current device does not exceed 800 amps. Note: Select a Dual Element Fuse equal to the RDE value. If the calculated RDE value does not equal a standard dual element fuse size listed in NEC 240-6, select the next higher fuse size. If the calculated RDE value is greater than the MOP value, select a Dual Element fuse equal to the calculated MOP (Maximum Over current Protection) value. Disconnect Switch Sizing (DSS) · Calculation A -- YC*, TC*, and TE* units: DSS = 1.15 X (LOAD1 + LOAD2 + LOAD4) Note: For TE* units, use calculations A and B. · Calculation B -- TE* units: DSS = 1.15 X (LOAD3 + Supply Fan FLA + Exhaust Fan FLA). Note: Use the larger value of calculations A or B to size the electrical disconnect switch. Low Voltage Wiring An overall layout of the various control options available for a Constant Volume application is illustrated in Figure 21, p. 34. Figure 22, p. 35 illustrates the various control options for a Variable Air Volume application. The required number of conductors for each control device are listed in the illustration. A typical field connection diagram for the sensors and other options are shown in the following section "Remote Panels and Sensors". These diagrams are representative of standard applications and are provided for general reference only. Always refer to the wiring diagram that shipped with the unit for specific electrical schematic and connection information. Note: All field wiring must conform to NEC guidelines as well as state and local codes. 32 Control Power Transformer WARNING Hazardous Voltage! Failure to disconnect power before servicing could result in death or serious injury. Disconnect all electric power, including remote disconnects before servicing. Follow proper lockout/tagout procedures to ensure the power can not be inadvertently energized. Verify that no power is present with a voltmeter. The 24 volt control power transformers are equipped with internal circuit breakers. They are to be used only with the accessories called out in this manual. If a circuit breaker trips, be sure to turn off all power to the unit before attempting to reset it. On units equipped with the VFD option, an additional control power transformer is used. The secondary is protected with fuses. Should the fuse blow, be sure to turn off all power to the unit before attempting to replace it. Field Installed AC Control Wiring WARNING Hazardous Voltage! Failure to disconnect power before servicing could result in death or serious injury. Disconnect all electric power, including remote disconnects before servicing. Follow proper lockout/tagout procedures to ensure the power can not be inadvertently energized. Verify that no power is present with a voltmeter. WARNING Proper Field Wiring and Grounding Required! Failure to follow code could result in death or serious injury. All field wiring MUST be performed by qualified personnel. Improperly installed and grounded field wiring poses FIRE and ELECTROCUTION hazards. To avoid these hazards, you MUST follow requirements for field wiring installation and grounding as described in NEC and your local/ state/national electrical codes. NOTICE Use Copper Conductors Only! Failure to use copper conductors could result in equipment damage as the equipment was not designed or qualified to accept other types of conductors. RT-SVX34U-EN NOTICE Component Failure! Resistance in excess of 3 ohms per conductor could result in component failure due to insufficient AC voltage supply. Do not exceed three (3) ohms per conductor for the length of the run. Before installing any connecting wiring, refer to Table 15, p. 33 for conductor sizing guidelines and; · Use copper conductors unless otherwise specified. · Ensure that the AC control voltage wiring between the controls and the unit's termination point does not exceed three (3) ohms/conductor for the length of the run. · Refer to dimensional information beginning with Figure 1, p. 14 for the electrical access locations provided on the unit. · Do not run the AC low voltage wiring in the same conduit with the high voltage power supply wiring. Be sure to check all loads and conductors for grounds, shorts, and miswiring. After correcting any discrepancies, reset the circuit breakers by pressing the black button located on the left side of the transformer. Table 15. AC conductors size Distance from unit to control 000-460 feet 461-732 feet 733-1000 feet Recommended wire size 18 gauge 16 gauge 14 gauge Field Installed DC Control Wiring WARNING Hazardous Voltage! Failure to disconnect power before servicing could result in death or serious injury. Disconnect all electric power, including remote disconnects before servicing. Follow proper lockout/tagout procedures to ensure the power can not be inadvertently energized. Verify that no power is present with a voltmeter. RT-SVX34U-EN Installation Electrical WARNING Proper Field Wiring and Grounding Required! Failure to follow code could result in death or serious injury. All field wiring MUST be performed by qualified personnel. Improperly installed and grounded field wiring poses FIRE and ELECTROCUTION hazards. To avoid these hazards, you MUST follow requirements for field wiring installation and grounding as described in NEC and your local/ state/national electrical codes. NOTICE Use Copper Conductors Only! Failure to use copper conductors could result in equipment damage as the equipment was not designed or qualified to accept other types of conductors. Before installing the connecting wiring between the components utilizing a DC analog output/input signal and the unit, refer to Table 16, p. 33 for conductor sizing guidelines and; · Use standard copper conductor thermostat wire unless otherwise specified. · Ensure that the wiring between the controls and the unit's termination point does not exceed two and a half (2-1/2) ohms/conductor for the length of the run. Note: Resistance in excess of 21/2 ohms per conductor can cause deviations in the accuracy of the controls. · Refer to dimensional drawings beginning with Figure 1, p. 14 for the electrical access locations provided on the unit. · Do not run the electrical wires transporting DC signals in or around conduit housing high voltage wires. Table 16. DC conductors Distance from unit to control Recommended wire size 000-150 feet 22 gauge 151-240 feet 20 gauge 241-385 feet 18 gauge 386-610 feet 16 gauge 611-970 feet 14 gauge Units equipped with the Trane Communication Interface (TCI) option, which utilizes a serial communication link; 33 Installation Electrical · Must be 18 AWG shielded twisted pair cable Belden 8760 or equivalent). · Must not exceed 5,000 feet maximum for each link. · Must not pass between buildings. Figure 21. Typical field wiring requirements for CV and SZ VAV control options RTRM J7 Thermostat Inputs N/A for SZ VAV LTB6 LTB 3 LTB1 LTB5 LTB4 Space Humidity Sensor Space Humidistat 34 RT-SVX34U-EN Figure 22. Typical field wiring requirements for traditional VAV control options Installation Electrical LTB6 LTB 3 LTB1 LTB5 LTB4 *VAV Mode input: RTRM J6-2 to RTRM J6-4 If the unit does not have a Mode (Off, Auto) input from another source, the following default applies: Short from J6-2 to J6-4 = AUTO mode, Open from J6-2 to J6-4 = OFF mode. Customer Changeover for VAV Htg (MOD GAS ONLY) Space Humidity Sensor Space Humidistat RT-SVX34U-EN 35 Installation Electrical Figure 23. RTRM zone sensor/thermostat connections CONVENTIONAL THERMOSTAT INPUTS CONVENTIONAL THERMOSTAT (CV ONLY) PROGRAMMABLE ZSM INPUTS CV/SZ VAV/VAV Zone Panel (BAYSENS108*) This electronic sensor features four system switch settings (Heat, Cool, Auto, and Off) and two fan settings (On and Auto). It is a manual or auto changeover control with dual setpoint capability. It can be used with a remote zone temperature sensor BAYSENS077*. Figure 25. Zone panel (BAYSENS108*) MECHANICAL ZSM INPUTS Remote Panels and Sensors Constant Volume and Single Zone VAV Control Options The RTRM must have a zone sensor or conventional thermostat (CV only) to operate the rooftop unit. If using a zone sensor, mode capability depends upon the type of sensor and/or remote panel selected to interface with the RTRM. The possibilities are: Fan selection ON or AUTO, System selection HEAT, COOL, AUTO, and OFF. Refer to Figure 23, p. 36 for conventional thermostat connections on Constant Volume units. The following controls are available from the factory for field installation on Constant Volume or Single Zone VAV units. Zone Panel (BAYSENS106*) This electronic sensor features three system switch settings (Heat, Cool, and Off) and two fan settings (On and Auto). It is a manual changeover control with single setpoint capability. Figure 24. Zone panel (BAYSENS106*) Remote Panel W/O NSB (BAYSENS110*) This electronic sensor features four system switch settings (Heat, Cool, Auto, and Off) and two fan settings (On and Auto) with four system status LED's. It is a manual or auto changeover control with dual setpoint capability. It can be used with a remote zone temperature sensor BAYSENS077*. Figure 26. Remote panel W/O NSB (BAYSENS110*) Variable Air Volume (non-SZ VAV) Control Options The RTRM must have a mode input in order to operate the rooftop unit. The normal mode selection used with a remote panel with or without night setback, or ICS is AUTO and OFF. Table 17, p. 37 lists the operating sequence should a CV/SZ VAV zone sensor be applied to a traditional VAV system having selectable modes; i. e. Fan selection ON or AUTO. System selection HEAT, COOL, AUTO, and OFF. 36 RT-SVX34U-EN Default Mode Input for Discharge Air Control For unit stand-alone operation without a remote panel or an ICS connected, jumper between terminals J6-2 and J6-4 on RTRM. VHR Relay Output For stand alone VAV unit operation, the VHR output should be wired to drive VAV boxes to maximum position during all heating modes and unoccupied periods. The VHR contacts are shown in the deenergized position and will switch (energize) during the above mentioned operating modes. Figure 27. VHR relay output Installation Electrical the unit wiring diagrams, engineering bulletins, and/or any specific instructions for connections. Remote Panel W/O NSB (BAYSENS021*) This electronic sensor features two system switch settings (Auto and Off), four system status LED's with single setpoint capability. It can be used with a remote zone temperature sensor BAYSENS077*. Figure 28. Remote panel W/O NSB (BAYSENS021*) 1 CUT RESISTOR R69 LOCATED ON RTAM NEAR SUPPL Y A IR C O O LIN G SETPOINT POTENTIOMETER WHEN OPTIONAL REMOTE PANEL IS USED. 2 CUT WIRE JUMPER ADJACENT T O THE TERMINAL 1 ON ZONE SENSOR WHEN OPTIONAL REMOTE SENSOR IS USED. * Note: Heat mode/unoccupied mode relay output to VAV Table 17. Variable air volume mode operation System Mode Heat DWU Active DWU Off Fan "Auto" DWU(a) Off(b) Fan "On" DWU(a) VAV Heating (b) Cool VAV Cooling (c) VAV Cooling Auto DWU Active DWU Off DWU or Cooling(c)(a)(b) (d) DWU or Cooling(c)(a)(b) (d) VAV Cooling (c) VAV Cooling or Heating(c) Off Off (b) Off (b) (a) If Daytime Warmup is Activated, the supply fan will run continuously. (b) The fan will be Off any time the system selection switch is "Off". (c) If Cooling is selected the supply fan will run continuously. If VAV Heating is activated the supply fan will run continuously. (d) Auto changeover between Cooling and Daytime Warmup depends upon the DWU initiate setpoint. VAV Controls Available from the Factory for Field Installation Remote Zone Sensor (BAYSENS016*) This bullet type temperature sensor can be used for; outside air (ambient) sensing, return air temperature sensing, supply air temperature sensing, remote temperature sensing (uncovered), and for VAV zone reset. Wiring procedures vary according to the particular application and equipment involved. Refer to RT-SVX34U-EN Constant Volume or VAV (Traditional or Single Zone) Controls Available from the Factory for Field Installation Remote Zone Sensor (BAYSENS073*) This electronic sensor features remote zone sensing and timed override with override cancellation. It is used with a Trane Integrated ComfortTM building management system. Figure 29. Remote zone sensor (BAYSENS073*) Remote Zone Sensor (BAYSENS074*) This electronic sensor features single setpoint capability and timed override with override cancellation. It is used with a Trane Integrated ComfortTM building management system. 37 Installation Electrical Figure 30. Remote zone sensor (BAYSENS074*) Figure 31. Remote sensor with night setback BAYSENS119 RTRM Remote Zone Sensor (BAYSENS077*) This electronic sensor can be used with BAYSENS106*, 108*, 110*, 119*, or 021* Remote Panels. When this sensor is wired to a BAYSENS119* Remote Panel, wiring must be 18 AWG Shielded Twisted Pair (Belden 8760 or equivalent). Refer to the specific Remote Panel for wiring details. Remote Panel with NSB (BAYSENS119*) This 7 day programmable sensor features four periods for Occupied/Unoccupied programming per day. Either one or all four periods can be programmed. If the power is interrupted, the program is retained in permanent memory. If power is off longer than 2 hours, only the clock and day may have to be reset. The front panel allows selection of Occupied/ Unoccupied periods with two temperature inputs (Cooling Supply Air Temperature and Heating Warmup temperature) per occupied period. The occupied supply air cooling setpoint ranges between 40º and 80º F. The warm-up setpoint ranges between 50º and 90º F with a 2 degrees deadband. The unoccupied cooling setpoint ranges between 45º and 98ºF. The unoccupied heating setpoint ranges between 43º and 96ºF. Note: In modulating gas heat units, the supply air heating setpoint is the active setpoint with a BAYSENS119* and must be set for the heater to function properly. The modulating furnace will not react to the Discharge Heating Setpoint on the NSB. The liquid crystal display (LCD) displays zone temperature, temperature setpoints, week day, time, and operational mode symbols. The options menu is used to enable or disable these applicable functions: Morning warm-up, economizer minimum position override during unoccupied status, heat installed, remote zone temperature sensor, 12/24 hour time display, and daytime warm-up. See Table 18, p. 39 for the Temp vs Resistance coefficient if an optional remote sensor is used. During an occupied period, an auxiliary relay rated for 1.25 amps @ 30 volts AC with one set of single pole double throw contacts is activated. Twisted/Shielded Run Shield to terminal 11 High Temperature Sensor (BAYFRST003*) Provides high limit "shutdown" of the unit. The sensor is used to detect high temperatures due to fire in the air conditioning or ventilation ducts. The sensor is designed to mount directly to the sheet metal duct. Each kit contains two sensors. The return air duct sensor (X1310004001) is set to open at 135ºF. The supply air duct sensor (X1310004002) is set to open at 240ºF. The control can be reset after the temperature has been lowered approximately 25ºF below the cutout setpoint. Figure 32. High temperature sensor (BAYFRST003*) Control Box Supply duct high limit control Remove factory supplied jumper Return duct high limit control Remote Minimum Position Potentiometer (BAYSTAT023*) This device can be used with units with an economizer. It allows the operator to remotely set the position of the economizer dampers from 0% to 50% of fresh air entering the space. 38 RT-SVX34U-EN Figure 33. Remote minimum position potentiometer (BAYSTAT023) Space Temperature Averaging Space temperature averaging is accomplished by wiring a number of remote sensors in a series/parallel circuit. The fewest number of sensors required to accomplish space temperature averaging is four. Example #1 illustrates two series circuits with two sensors in each circuit wired in parallel. Any number squared, is the number of remote sensors required. Example #2 illustrates three sensors squared in a series/parallel circuit. NSB panel remote sensors must use twisted/ shielded cable. Figure 34. Space temperature averaging Example #1 Remote Sensor #1 Remote Sensor #2 Remote Sensor #3 Remote Sensor #4 Example #2 Remote Sensor #1 Remote Sensor #2 Remote Sensor #3 To RTRM J6-1 and J6-2 or to ZSM terminals 1 and 2 or NSB panel terminals S1 and S2. Shield to terminal 11. Remote Sensor #4 Remote Sensor #5 Remote Sensor #6 Remote Sensor #7 Remote Sensor #8 Remote Sensor #9 Installation Electrical Table 18. Temperature vs. resistance (temperature vs. resistance coefficient is negative) Degrees F° -20° -15° -10° -5° 0° 5° 10° 15° 20° 25° 30° 35° 40° 45° 50° 55° 60° 65° 70° 75° 80° 85° 90° 95° 100° Nominal Resistance 170.1 K - Ohms 143.5 K - Ohms 121.4 K - Ohms 103.0 K - Ohms 87.56 K - Ohms 74.65 K - Ohms 63.80 K - Ohms 54.66 K - Ohms 46.94 K - Ohms 40.40 K - Ohms 34.85 K - Ohms 30.18 K - Ohms 26.22 K - Ohms 22.85 K - Ohms 19.96 K - Ohms 17.47 K - Ohms 15.33 K - Ohms 13.49 K - Ohms 11.89 K - Ohms 10.50 K - Ohms 9.297 K - Ohms 8.247 K - Ohms 7.330 K - Ohms 6.528 K - Ohms 5.824 K - Ohms RT-SVX34U-EN 39 Installation Piping General Requirements WARNING Hazardous Gases and Flammable Vapors! Failure to observe the following instructions could result in exposure to hazardous gases, fuel substances, or substances from incomplete combustion, which could result in death or serious injury. The state of California has determined that these substances may cause cancer, birth defects, or other reproductive harm. Improper installation, adjustment, alteration, service or use of this product could cause flammable mixtures or lead to excessive carbon monoxide. To avoid hazardous gases and flammable vapors follow proper installation and setup of this product and all warnings as provided in this manual. All internal gas piping for YC* rooftop units are factory installed and leak tested. Once the unit is set into place, a gas supply line must be field installed and connected to the gas train located inside the gas heat compartment. Access holes are provided on the unit as shown in Figure 12, p. 19 to accommodate side panel entry. Following the guidelines listed below will enhance both the installation and operation of the furnace. Note: In the absence of local codes, the installation must conform with the American National Standard Z223.1a of the National Fuel Gas Code, (latest edition). 1. To assure sufficient gas pressure at the unit, use to determine the appropriate gas pipe size for the heating capacity listed on the unit's nameplate. If a gas line already exists, verify that it is sized large enough () to handle the additional furnace capacity. 2. Take all branch piping from any main gas line from the top at 90 degrees or side at 45 degrees to prevent moisture from being drawn in with the gas. 3. Ensure that all piping connections are adequately coated with joint sealant and properly tightened. Use a piping compound that is resistant to liquid petroleum gases. 4. Provide a drip leg near the unit. 40 NOTICE Gas Valve Damage! Failure to follow instructions below could result in gas valve damage from incorrect gas pressures, irregular pulsating flame patterns, burner rumble, and potential flame outages. Use a pressure regulator to properly regulate gas pressure. DO NOT oversize the regulator. 5. Install a pressure regulator at the unit that is adequate to maintain 6" w.c. for natural gas and 11" w.c. for LP gas while the unit is operating in the "High Heat" mode. A minimum inlet gas pressure of 2.5" w.c. for natural gas and 8" w.c. for LP gas is required while operating in the "High Heat" mode. Note: Gas pressure in excess of 14" w.c. or 0.5 psig will damage the gas train. WARNING Explosion Hazard! Failure to follow safe leak test procedures below could result in death or serious injury or equipment or property-only-damage. Never use an open flame to detect gas leaks. Use a leak test solution for leak testing. 6. Leak test the gas supply line using a soap-andwater solution or equivalent before connecting it to the gas train. 7. Pressure test the supply line before connecting it to the unit to prevent possible gas valve damage and the unsafe operating conditions that will result. Note: Do not rely on gas train shutoff valves to isolate the unit while conducting gas pressure/leak test. These valves are not designed to withstand pressures in excess of 14" w.c. or 0.5 psig. Connecting the Gas Supply Line to the Furnace Gas Train Follow the steps below to complete the installation between the supply gas line and the furnace. Refer to Figure 35, p. 41 for the Gas Train configuration. 1. Connect the supply gas piping using a "groundjoint" type union to the furnace gas train and check for leaks. 2. Provide adequate support for the field installed gas piping to avoid stressing the gas train and controls. 3. Adjust the inlet supply gas pressure to the recommended 6" for natural gas or 11" w.c. for LP gas. RT-SVX34U-EN Installation Piping Table 19. Specific gravity multiplier Specific Gravity Multiplier 0.5 0.55 1.1 1.04 Table 19. Specific gravity multiplier (continued) Specific Gravity Multiplier 0.6 0.65 1 0.96 Table 20. Sizing natural gas pipe mains and branches Gas Supply Pipe Run (ft) 1-1/4" Pipe 1-1/2" Pipe Gas Input (Cubic Feet/Hour)(a) 2" Pipe 2-1/2" Pipe 3"Pipe 4"Pipe 10 1050 1600 3050 4800 8500 17500 20 730 1100 2100 3300 5900 12000 30 590 890 1650 2700 4700 9700 40 500 760 1450 2300 4100 8300 50 440 670 1270 2000 3600 7400 60 400 610 1150 1850 3250 6800 70 370 560 1050 1700 3000 6200 80 350 530 990 1600 2800 5800 90 320 490 930 1500 2600 5400 100 305 460 870 1400 2500 5100 125 275 410 780 1250 2200 4500 150 250 380 710 1130 2000 4100 175 225 350 650 1050 1850 3800 200 210 320 610 980 1700 3500 Notes: 1. 2. 3. If more than one unit is served by the same main gas supply, consider the total gas input (cubic feet/hr.) and the total length when determining the appropriate gas pipe size. Obtain the Specific Gravity and BTU/Cu.Ft. from the gas company. The following example demonstrates the considerations necessary when determining the actual pipe size. Example: A 40' pipe run is needed to connect a unit with a 500 MBH furnace to a natural gas supply having a rating of 1,000 BTU/Cu.Ft. and a specific gravity of 0.60. Cu.Ft/Hour = [(Furnace MBH Input) / (Gas BTU/Cu.Ft.)] X Multiplier. Cu.Ft/Hour = 500. This table indicates that a 1-1/4" pipe is required. (a) Table is based on a specific gravity of 0.60. Use previous table or the specific gravity of the local gas supply. Figure 35. Gas train configuration for low heat units (high heat units utilize two gas trains.) RT-SVX34U-EN 41 Startup Unit Control Modules RTRM - ReliaTelTM Refrigeration Module The RTRM is the main information receiving module. It interprets the information received from all other unit modules, sensors, remote panels, customer binary contacts and responds by activating the various unit components to satisfy the applicable request for economizing, cooling, heating, exhaust, ventilation. The RTRM configuration is set through the wire harness to function within one of six system applications: · Constant Volume Supply Air with No Heat. · Constant Volume Supply Air with Gas or Electric Heat. · Variable Supply Air Volume with No Heat. · Variable Supply Air Volume with Gas or Electric Heat. · Single Zone Variable Supply Air Volume with No Heat. · Single Zone Variable Supply Air Volume with Gas or Electric Heat. ECA/RTEM - Economizer Actuator/ ReliaTel Economizer Module (Optional) The ECA/RTEM monitors the mixed air temperature, return air temperature, minimum position setpoint (local or remote), ambient dry bulb/enthalpy sensor or comparative humidity (return air humidity against ambient humidity) sensors, if selected, to control the dampers to an accuracy of +/- 5% of the stroke. The actuator is spring returned (FA closed, RA opened) any time power is lost to the unit. Refer to "Mechanical Cooling with an Economizer ," p. 59 for the proper potentiometer settings for dry bulb/Enthalpy control. Note: The ECA/RTEM control module is mounted on the actuator. Units with the ultra-low-leak economizer option have their ECA control module mounted to a panel adjacent to the RA damper. EBA - Exhaust Blade Actuator (Optional) If the unit is ordered with tracking power exhaust, the EBA will track the economizer damper position as long as the active exhaust fan setpoint has been exceeded set via RTOM, through BAS, or calculated (SZ VAV only). The actuator limits the maximum travel of the exhaust barometric damper. The exhaust blade actuator is spring returned and is closed any time power is lost to the unit. 42 RTAM - ReliaTel Air Handler Module (Standard with Traditional VAV) The RTAM receives information from the supply duct static pressure transducer. Attached to the module are the supply air heating potentiometer, supply air cooling setpoint potentiometer, supply pressure setpoint potentiometer, static pressure deadband potentiometer, morning warm-up setpoint potentiometer, reset setpoint potentiometer, and 5 DIP switches. See following figure. Figure 36. RTAM module DIP Switches: · Switch 1 is "ON" for VFD's. · Switch 2 is "OFF" for VAV. · Switch 3 and 4 operation are explained under "supply air temperature reset". · Switch 5 is "OFF" for DWU Disabled and "ON" for DWU Enabled. The RTAM module provides a 0 to 10 Vdc output to control the Variable Frequency Drive. DIP switches located on the RTAM configures the unit to use the output for a VFD. Customer changeover input from Low Voltage Terminal Board (LTB5) activates VAV heating. The Supply Air Heating setpoint must be set to the desired discharge air temperature for heating. This VAV heating mode is available only with modulating gas heat units. In this mode the gas heaters modulate RT-SVX34U-EN and the supply air pressure control remains active to satisfy the zone settings. For constant volume (CV) units with modulating gas heat using a conventional thermostat or for Single Zone VAV units with modulating gas heat, the Discharge Air SP on the RTOM must be set to desired discharge air temperature in order for the unit to function properly. For VAV units with modulating gas heat, the Supply Air Heating Setpoint on the RTAM is used to control the heat setpoint in the changeover heating mode. Figure 37. RTOM module J8 1- J4 R42 R40 1- R136 TP2 TP3 DA HEAT EXH FAN DA COOL/FAN SPD J9 J10 J11 1 1 1 1- J12 1- J3 R130 R41 TP4 SA REHEAT TP5 DEHUMID TB2 TB1 R46 1- J6 J2 -1 J1 -1 J5 -1 J7 1 = Discharge Air Heat Setpoint** 2 = Exhaust Fan Enable Setpoint 3 = Supply Air Reheat Setpoint 4 = Dehumidi cation (%) Setpoint 5 = Discharge Air Cool Setpoint LL*** **Discharge Air Heat Setpoint is required for Single Zone VAV units with modulating heat or traditional Constant Volume units with modulating heat and a conventional thermostat control. ***Discharge Air Cool Setpoint is required for Single Zone VAV operation. RT-SVX34U-EN Startup ReliaTel Ventilation Module (RTVM) Figure 38. RTVM module SPC PRESS DB R42 SPC PRESS R40 J4 1- R136 TP2 TP3 DA COOL/FAN SPD J9 J11 1 1 1J12 1J3 R130 R41 TP4 SA REHEAT TP5 DEHUMID TB2 TB1 R46 J2 -1 J1 -1 J5 1 = Space Pressure Deadband (iwc) 2 = Space Pressure Setpoint (iwc) 3* = R130 = Design minimum OA ow Setpoint 4* = R41 =DCV Minimum OA ow Setpoint 3** = R130 (SA REHEAT SP) = Design Minimum Position at Minimum Fan Speed Command 4** = R41 (DEHUMID) = DCV Minimum Position at Minimum Fan Speed Command 5** = R136 (DA COOL/FAN SPD) = Design Minimum Position at 50% Fan Speed Command * Setpoints for units with TRAQ ** Setpoints only required for Single Zone VAV units with Demand Controlled Ventilation installed. The RTVM (Ventilation Module) provides a 2 to 10 Vdc signal to control the Exhaust Blade Actuator in order to relieve positive building pressure. The signal output will be modulated based on the measured values from the Space Pressure Transducer. The Space Pressure Calibration Solenoid will ensure that the RTVM reads a differential pressure between the building pressure and atmospheric pressure. The Space Pressure Setpoint and Space Pressure Deadband are set by adjusting potentiometers located on the RTVM. Also, units configured for Single Zone VAV control with Demand Controlled ventilation will require an RTVM for the additional, required Outside Air damper minimum position setpoint potentiometers. Units configured with the Fresh Air Measurement (Traq) option will require a RTVM for required sensors and setpoints to perform Traq airflow control. The Airflow Sensor input, Minimum Outside Air CFM Setpoints (Design and DCV), and Outside Airflow Adjustment Setpoint are all provided by the RTVM. The RTVM takes the airflow sensor voltage, converts it to airflow (CFM) and calculates a Traq outside air minimum OA damper position to maintain the desired 43 Startup adjustable CFM setpoint value. The airflow can be adjusted for altitude differences with the Outside Airflow Adjustment Setpoint. ReliaTel Dehumidification Module (RTDM) Figure 39. RTDM module The RTDM provides a pulsed signal output to control the Cooling and Reheat Modulating Valves. The RTDM will also monitor the Entering Evaporator Temperature as well as protect against a low refrigerant pressure in the reheat circuit. Conventional Thermostat Connections (Available Only with CV) This feature allows conventional thermostats to be used in conjunction with the RTRM on Constant Volume Applications only. It utilizes the conventional wiring scheme of R, Y1, Y2, W1, W2/X, and G. Refer to Figure 23, p. 36 for conventional thermostat connections. Applicable thermostats to be used with the conventional thermostat inputs are: Table 21. Thermostats Vendor Part # Trane Part # Honeywell T7300 Honeywell T874D1082 BAYSTAT011 Enerstat MS-1N BAYSTAT003 TCI - Trane Communication Interface (Optional) This module is used when the application calls for an ICS building management type control system. It allows the control and monitoring of the system through a Trane Tracer® panel. The module can be ordered from the factory or ordered as a kit to be field installed. Follow the installation instructions that ship with each kit when field installation is necessary. LCI - LonTalk® Communication Interface (Optional) This module is used when the application calls for a LonTalk building management type control system. It 44 allows the control and monitoring of the system through a Trane Tracer Summit panel or 3rd party LonTalk system. The module can be ordered from the factory or ordered as a kit to be field installed. Follow the installation instructions that ship with each kit when field installation is necessary. BCI - BACnet® Communication Interface (Optional) This module is used when the application calls for a BACnet building management type control system. It allows the control and monitoring of the system through a Trane Tracer SC panel or 3rd party BACnet system. The module can be ordered from the factory or ordered as a kit to be field installed. Follow the installations instructions that ship with each kit when field installation is necessary. WCI - Trane Air-Fi® Wireless Comm Interface (Optional) The Trane® Air-Fi Wireless Comm Interface (WCI) is the perfect alternative to Trane's BACnet® wired communication links (for example, Comm links between a Tracer® SC and a Tracer UC400). Minimizing communication wire used between terminal products, zone sensors, and system controllers has substantial benefits. Installation time and associated risks are reduced. Projects are completed with fewer disruptions. Future re-configurations, expansions, and upgrades are easier and more cost effective. TD5 Display - 5" Touchscreen Display The Tracer TD5 display is an optional display module that operates in conjunction with the ReliaTel Controller and allows you to view data and make operational changes. More information on the Tracer TD5 Display can be found in Installation, Operation, and Maintenance Manual, RT-SVX49*-EN. System Operation Economizer Operation with a Conventional Thermostat (CV Only) If the ambient conditions are suitable for economizer operation, the economizer is activated as the 1st step of cooling from Y1. The dampers are controlled to provide a supply air temperature of 50° F +/- 5° F. If the economizer is disabled due to ambient conditions, the 1st stage of mechanical cooling is activated. While economizing, if an additional stage of cooling is activated from Y2, the 1st stage of mechanical cooling is activated. If the economizer is disabled due to ambient conditions, the 2nd stage of mechanical cooling is activated. The supply fan is activated from the G terminal and will cycle with a call for heat or cooling if in the "Auto" RT-SVX34U-EN mode. It will run continuously in the "On" mode regardless of any other system demand. On gas heat units, first and second stages are activated by the W1 and W2 terminals on the CTI. On electric heat units, only two stages of heat are available. If the W2 terminal is activated without activating the W1 terminal, the RTRM will bring on both stages of electric heat. The conventional thermostat connections can also be utilized as a generic building automation system interface for constant volume ICS applications. Due to the limited heating and cooling steps when using a conventional thermostat, compressor staging will vary on units with three compressors. Note: If a conventional thermostat is used with a unit that has modulating gas heat, the unit will control to the Discharge Air SP potentiometer on the RTOM when heating with a W1 call only. The unit will go to high fire with W1 + W2. Microelectronic Control Features Anti Short Cycle Timer (ASCT) Compressor operation is programmed for 3 minutes of minimum "ON" time, and 3 minutes of minimum "OFF" time. Enhances compressor reliability, and ensures proper oil return. Note: Compressor cycle rate minimization, extends compressor life expectancy, minimizes damaging compressor inrush current, and guards against short cycling. Delay Between Stages Timer When combined with a standard Zone Sensor Module, the Reliatel Refrigeration Module (RTRM) provides a 10 second minimum "ON" delay for compressor staging. Built-in Fan Delay Relay (Constant Volume and Single Zone VAV Units) When the fan mode switch on the Zone Sensor Module is set in the auto position, the RTRM provides individual supply fan timing sequences for each system in heating and cooling. The RTRM provides different timing sequences for Gas Heat units and Cooling only units. Low Ambient Cooling Low ambient cooling to 0°F with FrostatTM. Built-in Electric Heat Staging Provides a 10 second "ON" delay between resistance heat stages. Economizer Preferred Cooling Allows fully integrated economizer operation with mechanical cooling if actually needed. On Constant Volume and Single Zone VAV applications, a 3 minute delay allows the RTRM to RT-SVX34U-EN Startup evaluate the rate of change in the zone. If the zone temperature is dropping faster than acceptable parameters, the compressor(s) will not be required to operate. Free Night Setback Allows the unit to enter an unoccupied mode by simply shorting across terminals RTRM J6-11 and J6-12. The short can be achieved by a set of dry contacts or a time clock. Once this short has been made the unit will close the economizer dampers, go from continuous fan to auto fan operation. ON CV or SZ VAV units with mechanical ZSM: · If the unit has a valid cooling and heating setpoint, the setup/setback is a minimum of 7°F. · If the unit does not have both setpoints, the setup/ setback is 0°. · If the unit has neither setpoint, the unoccupied cooling/heating setpoints will be 74°F/71°F. · If the unit is configured as a Constant Volume unit and a conventional thermostat is used, this input is ignored and the unit will respond to thermostat requests as during normal occupied mode. · VAV unit w/o ICS or NSB energizes heating if the space temperature drops to 10°F below the MWU setpoint but not less than 50°F. · This option can not be used with programmable ZSM or with an ICSTM system. Low Pressure Cutouts Low pressure cutouts on all compressors have been added to insure compressor reliability in low refrigerant flow situations. The compressor(s) will lockout after four consecutive low pressure control trips during the compressor minimum 3 minute "on" time. The lockout will have to be manual reset as explained in this document. Economizer Operation with CV Controls The control point for the economizer is designed to control at least 1.5°F below the cooling setpoint or 1.5° F above the heating setpoint, whichever produces the highest economizer control setpoint. Example: Heating Setpoint = 68°F Cooling Setpoint = 70°F The control temperature for the economizer will be 1.5° F above the heating setpoint due to it producing the least amount of offset. Heating Setpoint = 55°F Cooling Setpoint = 75°F Because of the spread between the heating and cooling setpoints, the control will choose to control the economizer at an offset temperature of 1.5°F below the 45 Startup cooling setpoint. This will be the highest resulting control setpoint temperature while maintaining the least amount of offset. The percentage that the economizer dampers open is based on two factors: · The zone temperature minus the economizer setpoint, and, · The zone temperature minus the outdoor air temperature. Note: The following table lists the percentages the dampers will open based on these conditions. Table 22. Percent of damper travel Zone Temp - Econ Setpoint °F Zone - 0.0- 0.5- ODT 0.5 1.0 1.02.0 2.03.0 3.05.0 >5.0 0 - 7°F 0% 3% 9% 30% 90% 100% 7 - 14° F 0% 2% 6% 20% 60% 100% > 14°F 0% 1% 3% 10% 30% 100% While economizing, if the supply air temperature falls below 50°F, the damper will not be allowed to open any further until the supply air temperature rises above 50° F. If the supply air temperature falls below 45°F, the dampers will be driven to minimum position and held there until the supply air temperature rises above 50°F. The mechanical cooling is disabled while in an economizing state until two conditions are met: · The economizer dampers have been fully open for three minutes, and; · The calculated rate of change in the zone temperature is less than 12°F per hour. If the economizer is disabled due to unsuitable conditions, the economizer is at the selected minimum position when the supply fan is "On", and is closed when the supply fan is "Off". The mechanical cooling will cycle as though the unit had no economizer. Modulating Power Exhaust If the unit is equipped with the modulating power exhaust option, the power exhaust actuator will follow the position of the economizer actuator. Mechanical Cooling without an Economizer (CV and SZ VAV) Mechanical cooling is used to maintain the zone temperature. The RTRM is designed to limit the compressor cycle rates to within 10 cycles per hour based on the minimum compressor "on" and "off" times. It stages the mechanical cooling to control the zone temperature to within +/- 2°F of the sensor setpoint at the sensed location. Table 23, p. 46 lists the compressor staging sequence for standard efficiency units. For high efficiency units there are three separate staging sequences which determine the staging of 3 compressors within each sequence. Each call for cool will operate within a given sequence and the next call for cool will operate in the next sequence. Lead/Lag operation is taken into consideration with these 3 staging sequences and will be active when Lead/Lag is configured. Table 24, p. 47 lists the compressor staging sequence for high efficiency units. Table 23. Compressor staging with lead/lag disabled - std efficiency units (excluding 4050T CV units) Unit Model 27.5 - 35 "ON" "OFF" Step Step Step Step Step Step 1 2 3 3 2 1 CPR 1 CPR (a) 1, 2 N/A N/A CPR 1, 2 CPR 1 CPR 1 CPR 2 CPR CPR CPR 2 CPR 1 40 (b) (c) 1, 2 1, 2 (c) (b) CPR 1 CPR CPR CPR CPR CPR 1 50 (b) 2,3(d) 1, 2, 1, 2, 2, 3(d) (b) 3 3 (a) Single circuit, dual manifolded compressors (b) Number one refrigeration circuit, Standalone compressor, is "On". (c) First stage is off. Number two refrigeration circuit, standalone compressor, is "On" (d) First Stage is "Off", Number two refrigeration circuit, manifolded compressor pair operating simultaneously, is "On". 46 RT-SVX34U-EN Table 24. Compressor staging sequence - high efficiency units and std eff. 4050T CV units) Sequence 1 Sequence 2 Sta- CPR CPR CPR ge 1 2 3 1 ON OFF OFF 2 OFF ON OFF 3 ON ON OFF 4 OFF ON ON 5 ON ON ON Sta- CPR CPR CPR ge 1 2 3 1 Start at Stage 2 2 OFF ON OFF 3 ON ON OFF 4 OFF ON ON 5 ON ON ON Sequence 3 Sta- CPR CP- CP- ge 1 R2 R3 1 Start at Stage 2 2 OFF OFF ON 3 ON OFF ON 4 OFF ON ON 5 ON ON ON Figure 40. Compressors 27.5, 30, 35 Tons Std Eff. 40 Tons Std Eff. VAV Only 50 Tons Std Eff. VAV Only 27.5-50 Tons High Eff. & 40-50 Tons Std Eff. CV Zone Temperature - Occupied Cooling (CV and SZVAV) When the unit is in the cooling mode and the zone temperature raises above the cooling setpoint control band, the economizer and the compressor stages will be cycled as required by the zone sensor, remote panel, or Tracer®. For SZ VAV control, the fan capacity will also be controlled in order to meet the zone cooling demand. Zone Temperature - Occupied Heating (CV and SZVAV) When the unit is in the heating mode and the zone temperature falls below the heating setpoint control band, the necessary stages of heat will cycle to raise the temperature to within the setpoint control band. RT-SVX34U-EN Startup For SZ VAV, the fan capacity will also be controlled in order to meet the zone heating demand. Supply Fan (CV and SZ VAV) When the Fan Selection Switch is in the "AUTO" position and a call for cooling is initiated, the supply fan will delay starting for approximately one second on traditional CV units. For SZ VAV units, the supply fan will be controlled ON based on the zone cooling demand. Once ON, the unit will begin staging cooling capacity (economizer and/or compressors) in order to meet the discharge air requirements. Once the zone has been satisfied, the supply fan will be controlled OFF. When the Fan Selection Switch is in the "ON" position, the supply fan will run continuously. If airflow through the unit is not proven by the differential pressure switch (factory setpoint 0.15"w.c.) within 40 seconds nominally, the RTRM will shut off all mechanical operations, lock the system out, send a diagnostic to ICS, and the SERVICE LED output will pulse. The system will remain locked out until a reset is initiated either manually or through ICS or a mode transition from OFF to a non-OFF mode. Supply Air Tempering (CV and SZ VAV) CV Units with Staged Heat This function allows the supply air temperature to be maintained within a low limit parameter during minimum ventilation periods. For CV units configured with a Staged Heat design (Electric or Gas) and Supply Air Tempering operation enabled, if the following items are true, the unit will enter Supply Air Tempering mode: · The supply fan is ON. · The unit is in Occupied mode. · Zone Temp. is less than the active Cooling setpoint. · The unit is in Heat mode but is not actively heating OR · The unit is in AUTO-COOL mode but not actively cooling and cooling capacity has been OFF for 5 minutes. Once the above conditions are met, if the supply air temperature drops to 10°F BELOW the Occupied Heating Zone Temperature Setpoint, the SA Tempering function will bring ON one stage of gas or electric heat. Once SA Tempering is active, heating will be turned OFF if the Supply Air Temperature rises to 10°F ABOVE the Active Occupied Zone Heating Setpoint, or the Zone Temperature rises to the Active Zone Cooling Setpoint. Also, if the Zone Heat Control function is calling for 1 or more stages of Heat, Tempering will be discontinued and the unit will stage additional heating to meet the current demand. When an economizer is installed, air tempering is allowed with ICSTM when the fan system switch is in the "ON" position with no call for heating. The same 47 Startup conditions must be met as described above for entering and leaving Tempering operation. CV Units with Modulating Heat On units with Modulating Gas Heat, Supply Air Tempering is inherent to the Modulating Heat design and does not require any additional configuration/ enabling. Modulating Heat Tempering is accomplished by allowing the unit to return to heating if the Zone is marginally satisfied and the Supply Air temperature begins to fall. The following conditions must be true to enable the unit to perform "Tempering": · The supply fan is ON. · The unit is in Occupied mode. · Zone Temp. is less than the active Cooling setpoint. · The unit is in Heat mode but is not actively heating OR · The unit is in AUTO-COOL mode but not actively cooling and cooling capacity has been OFF for 5 minutes. Once the above conditions are met, and the supply air temperature drops below the ZHSP - 10°F, the unit will transition back into active heating operation and will begin to control the modulating heat output to maintain the supply air temperature. Once the unit has entered into Tempering mode, the unit will leave active heating either by normal heat termination as determined by the heating control algorithm or when the Zone Temperature reaches the active ZCSP. SZ VAV Units with Staged Heat For SZ VAV units configured with a Staged Heating type, the Supply Air Tempering function will operate as on a CV unit with Staged Heat. SZ VAV Units with Modulating Heat For units configured with a Modulating Heat type, "Tempering" is an extension of normal Heating control which allows a transition from inactive "Auto-Cool" mode to Heating based on supply air temperature if the Zone Temperature is in control. The following conditions must be true to allow the unit to enter Supply Air Tempering: · Supply Fan is ON. · The unit is in Occupied mode. · The unit is operating in Auto-Cool Mode. · Cooling has been inactive for 5 minutes. When the above conditions are true, Tempering will be allowed when the Supply Air Temperature falls below the user selectable Minimum Supply Air Cooling Setpoint (minus deadband) as long as the Zone Temperature is < ZCSP - 1°F. Once the unit transitions into "Tempering" the unit will transition to normal heating control and will control the supply air 48 temperature between the minimum and maximum supply air setpoints. If the Zone Temperature rises above the ZCSP during "Tempering" the unit will de-energize Heating and "Tempering" will be disabled until conditions allow for it again. Normal Auto-Changeover requirements will be in control to allow the unit to transition into Active Cool mode. Variable Air Volume Applications (SZ VAV) Supply Fan Output Control Units configured for Single Zone VAV will include a VFD controlled supply fan motor which will be controlled via the 0-10Vdc Indoor Fan Speed output located on the RTOM and the RTRM Supply Fan output. With the RTRM Supply Fan output energized and the RTOM Indoor Fan Speed output at 0Vdc the fan speed output is 33% (20Hz) for cooling mode and 58% (35Hz) for heating modes from the VFD motor and at 10Vdc the fan speed output is 100% (60Hz). The control will scale the 0-10Vdc output from the RTOM linearly to control to 38%-100% controllable range based on the space heating or cooling demand. Minimum Supply Fan Output Refer to the table below for details on minimum supply fan output signals associated with each unit function. Note that each value represents the actual Fan Output %. Table 25. Fan output - standard efficiency Function Ventilation Only Minimum Fan Output % 58% Economizer Cooling 58% Cool 1 (C1 Energized) 58% Cool 2 (C1 or C2) 67% Cool 3 (C1 + C2 Energized) 67% SZVAV Modulating Heat 58% CV Staged Heat 100% SZVAV Modulating Heat Tempering 58% CV Staged Heat Tempering 100% Modulating Reheat 80% Table 26. Fan output - high efficiency Function Ventilation Only Economizer Cooling Minimum Fan Output % 45% 45% RT-SVX34U-EN Table 26. Fan output - high efficiency (continued) Function Cool 1 Cool 2 Cool 3 Cool 4 Cool 5 SZVAV Modulating Heat CV Staged Heat SZVAV Modulating Heat Tempering Minimum Fan Output % 45% 58% 67% 75% 75% 58% 100% 58% CV Staged Heat Tempering Modulating Reheat 100% 80% Supply Fan Mode Operation Units configured for Single Zone VAV control will utilize Supply Fan Mode selection as is currently implemented into ReliaTel controls for normal Zone Control and will be selectable between AUTO and ON via a connected Zone Sensor module or through BAS/ Network controllers. Supply Fan Mode "Auto" Operation For active Cooling, Heating, and Hot Gas Reheat operation the Supply Fan will be commanded ON and will ramp up to the appropriate minimum speed once the unit determines that there is a request for capacity control. Once the active request is cleared and all capacity is de-energized normal supply fan off delays as implemented on constant volume units will be in effect. During the Supply Fan Off-Delay, the supply fan will remain energized for the predetermined time at the previous unit function's minimum speed. All other cases which would bring the Supply Fan ON will function as on non-Single Zone VAV units. Supply Fan Mode "ON" Operation For active unit control with the Supply Fan Mode set to ON, the unit will energize the Supply Fan and hold the Fan Speed output at minimum speed until there is a request for the fan speed to increase. This will hold true for all cases except during Unoccupied periods in which the Supply Fan Mode is forced to AUTO and will operate the Supply Fan as described above for all Cooling, Heating, and Hot Gas Reheat requests. Setpoint Arbitration Single Zone VAV units will require traditional Zone Heating (if heat installed) and Cooling setpoints that are used for constant volume units in addition to two new setpoints: Discharge Air Cool (DA Cool - Fan SPD) and Discharge Air Heat (DA Heat) Setpoint limits. The zone Heating and Cooling setpoints will be selectable RT-SVX34U-EN Startup via the existing RTRM customer connections for a zone sensor panel and the DA Heat and Cool setpoints will be customer selectable via two onboard potentiometers on the RTOM with ranges 50-150°F and 40-90°F respectively. Table 27, p. 49 and Table 28, p. 49 can be used as a reference when setting the DA Heat (R42) and DA Cool Fan SPD (R136) setpoints on the RTOM. Note: The recommended settings for these setpoints is 100°F for the DA Heat Setpoint and 50°F for the DA Cool - Fan SPD Setpoint. Table 27. DA cool - fan SPD setpoint °F VDC 40 <0.1 41 0.2 42 0.3 43 0.45 44 0.55 45 0.7 46 0.8 47 0.95 48 1.05 49 1.15 50 1.25 51 1.3 52 1.35 53 1.45 54 1.55 55 1.65 56 1.7 57 1.75 58 1.83 59 1.9 60 1.95 61 2 62 2.05 63 2.1 64 2.13 65 2.17 66 2.21 67 2.27 68 2.3 69 2.35 70 >2.40 Note: The potentiometer voltage readings can be verified via the provided test points located next to each potentiometer. Use a DC voltmeter to the Vdc reading between those points and common. Table 28. DA heat setpoint Voltage (Vdc) Setpoint (ºF) 0 50 0.09 51 0.13 52 0.16 53 0.2 54 0.24 55 0.28 56 49 Startup Table 28. DA heat setpoint (continued) Voltage (Vdc) Setpoint (ºF) 0.31 57 0.35 58 0.42 60 0.46 61 0.5 62 0.53 63 0.57 64 0.61 65 0.65 66 0.68 67 0.72 68 0.76 69 0.79 70 0.83 71 0.87 72 0.9 73 0.94 74 0.98 75 1 76 1.03 77 1.06 78 1.08 79 1.11 80 1.13 81 1.16 82 1.18 83 1.21 84 1.23 85 1.26 86 1.28 87 1.31 88 1.33 89 1.36 90 1.38 91 1.41 92 1.43 93 1.46 94 1.48 95 1.51 96 1.53 97 1.56 98 1.58 99 1.61 100 1.63 101 1.66 102 1.69 103 1.71 104 1.72 105 1.74 106 1.76 107 1.78 108 1.79 109 1.81 110 1.83 111 1.84 112 1.86 113 1.88 114 1.89 115 1.91 116 1.93 117 1.95 118 1.96 119 1.98 120 50 Table 28. DA heat setpoint (continued) Voltage (Vdc) Setpoint (ºF) 2 121 2.01 122 2.03 123 2.05 124 2.06 125 2.08 126 2.09 127 2.11 128 2.12 129 2.13 130 2.13 131 2.14 132 2.16 133 2.17 134 2.19 135 2.2 136 2.21 137 2.23 138 2.24 139 2.25 140 2.26 141 2.28 142 2.29 143 2.3 144 2.32 145 2.33 146 2.34 147 2.36 148 2.37 149 2.4 150 Note: The above potentiometer voltage readings can be verified via the provided test points located next to each potentiometer. Use a DC voltmeter to the Vdc reading between those points and common. Units Configured with the Outside Air Measurement (Traq) Option To make a minor correction to the Traq airflow (CFM) reading that is calculated internally by the ReliaTel system, an adjustment pot is available on the RTVM. This pot can be used to correct for static "local" factors such as altitude. Variable factors such as drift, temperature, humidity, and other changing atmospheric conditions are corrected as part of the conversion calculation. The adjustment will typically be made in Service Test mode in a step where the OA damper is being commanded to the Traq OA Minimum Position Request with all required Traq control inputs valid (i.e. sensors, setpoints, RTVM board). The OA flow adjustment setpoint potentiometer (R136) on the RTVM will be used to adjust the value up to a factor of +/- 20% (0.80 to 1.20) Full counter-clockwise will be 20% and full clockwise will be + 20%. The potentiometer will be set to the middle position (between full CCW and full CW) in a "Deadband" area representing no adjustment 0% (factor of 1.00) by default. The adjustment will be RT-SVX34U-EN applied linearly across the sensing range of the airflow sensor which may produce inaccuracies at airflow levels not close to the value at which the calibration adjustment was made. Sequence for Setting Calibration · If unit is configured with DCV, disconnect CO2 sensor prior to powering unit. After calibration remove power from unit and reconnect CO2 sensor. · Adjust the Design Minimum OA Flow Setpoint potentiometer (R130/R41) on the RTVM to your desired flow rate for minimum ventilation (See Table 29, p. 51). · Initiate service test and step to the minimum ventilation step. This will set the unit into a constant ID fan speed and OA damper request to minimum position. Minimum position will be from the Traq calculation to maintain the OA flow at the setpoint. · Allow the damper position to settle to the desired flow rate set by the setpoint. · Measure the OA flow rate via an air balancing instrument. · Adjust the OA flow adjustment setpoint potentiometer (R136) clockwise or counterclockwise to "dial in" the flow to match the instrument in (See Table 30, p. 52). Table 29. Design minimum OA flow setpoint Design Min OA Flow Setpoint (R130) DCV Min OA Flow Setpoint (R41) Voltage Reading Airflow CFM 1000 1100 1200 1300 1400 1500 1600 1700 1800 1900 2000 2100 2200 2300 2400 2500 2600 2700 2800 2900 3000 3100 3200 3300 3400 3500 3600 3700 Airflow CFM 1000 1100 1200 1300 1400 1500 1600 1700 1800 1900 2000 2100 2200 2300 2400 2500 2600 2700 2800 2900 3000 3100 3200 3300 3400 3500 3600 3700 Voltage Vdc 0.2 0.22 0.24 0.26 0.28 0.3 0.32 0.34 0.36 0.38 0.4 0.42 0.44 0.46 0.48 0.5 0.52 0.54 0.56 0.58 0.6 0.62 0.64 0.66 0.68 0.7 0.72 0.74 RT-SVX34U-EN Startup Table 29. Design minimum OA flow setpoint (continued) Design Min OA Flow Setpoint (R130) DCV Min OA Flow Setpoint (R41) Voltage Reading Airflow CFM 3800 3900 4000 4100 4200 4300 4400 4500 4600 4700 4800 4900 5000 5100 5200 5300 5400 5500 5600 5700 5800 5900 6000 6100 6200 6300 6400 6500 6600 6700 6800 6900 7000 7100 7200 7300 7400 7500 7600 7700 7800 7900 8000 8100 8200 8300 8400 8500 8600 8700 8800 8900 9000 9100 9200 9300 9400 9500 9600 Airflow CFM 3800 3900 4000 4100 4200 4300 4400 4500 4600 4700 4800 4900 5000 5100 5200 5300 5400 5500 5600 5700 5800 5900 6000 6100 6200 6300 6400 6500 6600 6700 6800 6900 7000 7100 7200 7300 7400 7500 7600 7700 7800 7900 8000 8100 8200 8300 8400 8500 8600 8700 8800 8900 9000 9100 9200 9300 9400 9500 9600 Voltage Vdc 0.76 0.78 0.8 0.82 0.84 0.86 0.88 0.9 0.92 0.94 0.96 0.98 1 1.01 1.02 1.03 1.04 1.05 1.06 1.07 1.08 1.09 1.1 1.11 1.12 1.13 1.15 1.17 1.18 1.19 1.2 1.22 1.23 1.24 1.25 1.26 1.27 1.28 1.29 1.3 1.31 1.32 1.34 1.36 1.38 1.39 1.4 1.41 1.42 1.43 1.44 1.45 1.46 1.47 1.48 1.5 1.52 1.53 1.54 51 Startup Table 29. Design minimum OA flow setpoint (continued) Design Min OA Flow Setpoint (R130) DCV Min OA Flow Setpoint (R41) Voltage Reading Airflow CFM 9700 9800 9900 10000 10100 10200 10300 10400 10500 10600 10700 10800 10900 11000 11100 11200 11300 11400 11500 11600 11700 11800 11900 12000 12100 12200 12300 12400 12500 12600 12700 12800 12900 13000 13100 13200 13300 13400 13500 13600 13700 13800 13900 14000 14100 14200 14300 14400 14500 14600 14700 14800 14900 15000 15100 15200 15300 15400 15500 Airflow CFM 9700 9800 9900 10000 10100 10200 10300 10400 10500 10600 10700 10800 10900 11000 11100 11200 11300 11400 11500 11600 11700 11800 11900 12000 12100 12200 12300 12400 12500 12600 12700 12800 12900 13000 13100 13200 13300 13400 13500 13600 13700 13800 13900 14000 14100 14200 14300 14400 14500 14600 14700 14800 14900 15000 15100 15200 15300 15400 15500 Voltage Vdc 1.55 1.57 1.58 1.59 1.6 1.61 1.63 1.65 1.67 1.68 1.69 1.7 1.71 1.72 1.73 1.74 1.74 1.75 1.76 1.77 1.78 1.79 1.8 1.81 1.82 1.83 1.84 1.85 1.86 1.87 1.88 1.89 1.89 1.89 1.9 1.91 1.92 1.93 1.94 1.95 1.96 1.97 1.98 1.99 2 2.01 2.02 2.03 2.04 2.05 2.06 2.07 2.08 2.09 2.1 2.11 2.12 2.13 2.14 52 Table 29. Design minimum OA flow setpoint (continued) Design Min OA Flow Setpoint (R130) DCV Min OA Flow Setpoint (R41) Voltage Reading Airflow CFM 15600 15700 15800 15900 16000 16100 16200 16300 16400 16500 16600 16700 16800 16900 17000 17100 17200 17300 17400 17500 17600 17700 17800 17900 18000 18100 18200 18300 18400 18500 18600 18700 18800 18900 19000 Airflow CFM 15600 15700 15800 15900 16000 16100 16200 16300 16400 16500 16600 16700 16800 16900 17000 17100 17200 17300 17400 17500 17600 17700 17800 17900 18000 18100 18200 18300 18400 18500 18600 18700 18800 18900 19000 Voltage Vdc 2.15 2.16 2.17 2.18 2.19 2.2 2.21 2.22 2.23 2.24 2.25 2.26 2.27 2.28 2.29 2.3 2.31 2.32 2.33 2.34 2.35 2.36 2.37 2.38 2.39 2.4 2.41 2.42 2.43 2.44 2.45 2.46 2.47 2.48 2.49 Table 30. OA flow adjustment setpoint OA Flow Adjustment (R136) Multiplier/ Adjustment 0.8 0.81 0.82 0.83 0.84 0.85 0.86 0.87 0.88 0.89 0.9 0.91 0.92 0.93 0.94 0.95 Voltage Reading Vdc 0 0.05 0.14 0.22 0.3 0.35 0.43 0.51 0.57 0.64 0.72 0.78 0.88 0.94 1 1.06 RT-SVX34U-EN Table 30. OA flow adjustment setpoint (continued) OA Flow Adjustment (R136) Multiplier/ Adjustment 0.96 0.97 0.98 0.99 1 1.01 1.02 1.03 1.04 1.05 1.06 1.07 1.08 1.09 1.1 1.11 1.12 1.13 1.14 1.15 1.16 1.17 1.18 1.19 1.2 Voltage Reading Vdc 1.1 1.18 1.22 1.25 1.3 - 1.84 1.86 1.89 1.92 1.96 2 2.03 2.06 2.1 2.12 2.14 2.16 2.18 2.2 2.24 2.26 2.28 2.3 2.34 2.36 2.4 Ventilation Control Units configured for Single Zone VAV control require special handling of the OA Damper Minimum Position control in order to compensate for the non-linearity of airflow associated with the variable supply fan speed and damper combinations. Demand Controlled Ventilation Units configured for SZVAV and Demand Controlled Ventilation (CO2 sensor value available) require a new control scheme comprised of 2 existing schemes that have been traditionally mutually exclusive; DCV and OA CFM Compensation. Units configured with DCV will invoke the new Demand Controlled Ventilation scheme which allows variable Bldg. Design and DCV Minimum Positions and OA Damper Position Target setpoints based on the supply fan speed and space CO2 requirements. This new scheme will require the setting of 5 OA Damper position setpoints; 3 more than on non-SZ VAV. These new setpoints are located on the RTVM module: · Design Min Position @ Minimum Fan Speed Command (RTVM R130) · Design Min Position @ Middle Fan Speed Command (RTVM R136) RT-SVX34U-EN Startup · Design Min Position @ Full Fan Speed Command (RTEM Design Min Position) · DCV Min Position @ Minimum Fan Speed Command (RTVM R41) · DCV Min position @ Full Fan Speed Command (RTEM DCV Min Position) As the supply fan speed command varies between minimum and maximum, the Building Design and DCV Minimum Position Targets will be calculated linearly between the user selected setpoints based on the instantaneous supply fan speed. The Bldg. Design and DCV Minimum Position Targets will be used to calculate the Active OA Damper Minimum Position Target, as on traditional units, based on the Space CO2 relative to the active Design and DCV CO2 setpoints. Refer to Figure 41, p. 54 for additional details on the design. The Design Minimum and DCV Minimum OA Damper Position setpoints at Minimum Fan Speed Command and the Design Minimum OA Damper Position setpoint at Middle Fan Speed Command will have a range of 0100% while the Design Minimum and DCV Minimum OA Damper Position setpoints at Full fan speed will have a range of 0-50%. Note that as on non-Single Zone VAV units, a 10% offset will be enforced between the Design and DCV Minimum Positions throughout the fan speed range. By default, the Design Minimum Position schedule (red line below) will be a linear line through all user selectable Design Minimum Position setpoints. The user will have the ability to set the Design Minimum Position at Middle fan speed command to a point that would be lower than the calculated linear line between the Design Minimum Position setpoints at 0% and 100% fan speed command in order to compensate for the non-linear outside airflow through the fan and damper modulation range. However, if the Design Minimum Position at Middle fan speed command is set to a point that would be higher than the calculated linear line between the Design Minimum Position setpoints at Minimum and Full fan speed command, the minimum position will be limited to the point that would make the Design Minimum Position schedule linear. Provisions have been made in Service Test Mode to allow for proper damper minimum position setup: · To set the Design and DCV Minimum Position setpoints at Minimum Fan Speed, set the unit to operate at Step 1 (Fan ON) or Step 2 (Economizer Open) and make the proper adjustments. · To set the Design Minimum Position setpoint at Middle Fan Speed, set the unit to operate at Step 3 (Cool 1) and make the proper adjustment. · To set the Design and DCV Minimum Position setpoints at Full Fan Speed, set the unit to operate at Step 4 (Cool 2) and make the proper adjustments. 53 Startup Figure 41. SZVAV DCV with OA CFM compensation Design @ Minimum Fan Speed (RTVM R130) OAD Posion Setpoints Design @ Middle Fan Speed (RTVM R136) Design @ Full Fan Speed DCV @ Minimum Fan Speed (RTEM Design Min.) (RTVM R41) DCV @ Full Fan Speed OAD Target Setpoint Corresponds to Design CO2 (DCV UL) Setpoint Increasing CO2 Corresponds to DCV CO2 (DCV LL) Setpoint Minimum Fan Speed Middle Fan Speed Full Fan Speed Units with Traq Sensor The outside air enters the unit through the Traq Sensor assembly and is measured by velocity pressure flow rings. The velocity pressure flow rings are connected to a pressure transducer/solenoid assembly.The solenoid is used for calibration purposes to compensate for temperature swings that could affect the transducer. The ReliaTel Ventilation Module (RTVM) utilizes the velocity pressure input, the outdoor air temperature input, and the minimum outside air CFM setpoint to modify the volume (CFM) of outside air entering the unit as the measured airflow deviates from setpoint. For units with Traq, when the optional CO2 sensor is installed and Demand Controlled Ventilation is enabled the Minimum Outside Air CFM Setpoint will be adjusted linearly between two airflow setpoints, the Design Minimum Outside Air (OA) CFM Setpoint (R130) and the DCV Minimum Outside Air CFM (OA) Setpoint (R41). The resulting calculated setpoint is the Minimum OA CFM Target which is the setpoint used for active airflow control. The Minimum OA CFM Target Setpoint will vary proportionally between the DCV Minimum OA Flow CFM Setpoint and the Design Minimum OA CFM Setpoint as CO2 varies between the CO2 Lower Limit Setpoint and the CO2 Upper Limit Setpoint as shown in the following figure. The CO2 setpoints are set on the RTEM as with normal DCV control without Traq option. 54 Figure 42. Minimum outside air CFM setpoint Outside Air Damper Minimum Positions without DCV For units not configured with DCV (no CO2 sensor value available), additional minimum position setpoints to increase outdoor airflow accuracy will be supported. The operation will be similar to OA CFM Compensation on Traditional VAV units with the addition of a Design Minimum Position setpoint at Middle Fan Speed Command. The following setpoint potentiometers will be used on the RTEM: · Design Min at Minimum Fan Speed Command (RTEM DCV Min) · Design Min at Middle Fan Speed Command (RTEM DCV Setpoint LL) · Design Min at Full Fan Speed Command (RTEM Design Min) The controller will calculate the active OA Damper Minimum position linearly between the user-selected setpoints based on the supply fan speed command. The range for the Design Min setpoints at Minimum and Middle Fan Speed Command will be 0-100% while the range for the Design Min at Full Fan Speed Command setpoint will be 0-50%. By default, the Design Minimum Position schedule (red line below) will be a linear line through all user selectable Design Minimum Position setpoints. As with Demand Controlled Ventilation, if the Design Minimum Position at Middle fan speed command is set to a point that would be higher than the calculated linear line between the Design Minimum Position setpoints at Minimum and Maximum fan speed command, the minimum position will be limited to the point that would make the Design Minimum Position schedule linear. Provisions have been made in Service Test Mode to allow for proper damper minimum position setup: · To set the Design Minimum Position setpoint at Minimum Fan Speed, set the unit to operate at Step RT-SVX34U-EN 1 (Fan ON) or Step 2 (Economizer Open) and make the proper adjustment. · To set the Design Minimum Position setpoint at Middle Fan Speed, set the unit to operate at Step 3 (Cool 1) and make the proper adjustment. · To set the Design Minimum Position setpoint at Full Fan Speed, set the unit to operate at Step 4 (Cool 2) and make the proper adjustment. Figure 43. SZVAV OA damper min position w/ OA CFM compensation Design @ Minimum Fan Speed (RTEM DCV Min) OAD Position Setpoints Design @ Middle Fan Speed (RTEM DCV Setpoint LL) Design @ Maximum Fan Speed (RTEM Design Min) Minimum Fan Speed Middle Fan Speed Maximum Fan Speed Space Pressure Control For units configured with an exhaust fan, with or without Statitrac, the control described previously for economizer minimum position handling requires additional changes to the existing Space Pressure Control scheme. The overall scheme will remain very similar to non-Single Zone VAV units with Space Pressure Control with the exception of a dynamic Exhaust Enable Setpoint. For Single Zone VAV the user will select an Exhaust Enable Setpoint during the Maximum Fan Speed Command. Once selected, the difference between the Exhaust Enable Setpoint and Design OA Damper Minimum Position at Maximum Fan Speed Command will be calculated. The difference calculated will be used as an offset to be added to the Active Building Design OA Minimum Position Target to calculate the dynamic Exhaust Enable Target to be used throughout the Supply Fan Speed/OA Damper Position range. The Exhaust Enable Target could be above or below the Active Bldg Design OA Min Position Target Setpoint based on the Active Exhaust Enable Setpoint being set above or below the Bldg Design Min Position at Full Fan Speed Command. Note: An Exhaust Enable Setpoint of 0% will result in the same effect on Exhaust Fan control as on non-Single Zone VAV applications with and without Statitrac. RT-SVX34U-EN Startup Figure 44. Space pressure control graph OAD Position Setpoints Exhaust Enable Target Exhaust Enable @ Maximum Fan Speed Exhaust Enable @ Maximum Fan Speed Design @ Maximum Fan Speed Exhaust Enable O set Minimum Fan Speed Middle Fan Speed Maximum Fan Speed Fan Speed Algorithm Command Table 31. RTVM space pressure setpoint Voltage (Vdc) 0.04 0.118 0.196 0.274 0.352 0.43 0.508 0.586 0.664 0.742 0.82 0.898 0.976 1.02 1.08 1.129 1.178 1.227 1.276 1.325 1.374 1.423 1.472 1.521 1.57 1.619 1.668 1.72 1.759 1.798 1.82 1.8565 1.893 1.9295 1.966 2.0025 2.039 2.0755 2.112 2.1485 2.15 2.17 2.19 2.22 Setpoint (IWC) -0.2 -0.19 -0.18 -0.17 -0.16 -0.15 -0.14 -0.13 -0.12 -0.11 -0.1 -0.09 -0.08 -0.07 -0.06 -0.05 -0.04 -0.03 -0.02 -0.01 0 0.01 0.02 0.03 0.04 0.05 0.06 0.07 0.08 0.09 0.1 0.11 0.12 0.13 0.14 0.15 0.16 0.17 0.18 0.19 0.2 0.21 0.22 0.23 55 Startup Table 31. RTVM space pressure setpoint (continued) Voltage (Vdc) 2.25 2.275 2.3 2.325 2.35 2.375 2.42 Setpoint (IWC) 0.24 0.25 0.26 0.27 0.28 0.29 0.3 Table 32. RTVM space pressure setpoint deadband Voltage (Vdc) 0.2 0.35 0.53 0.71 0.91 1.1 1.235 1.37 1.505 1.65 1.75 1.85 1.95 2.05 2.13 2.21 2.28 2.35 2.42 Setpoint (IWC) 0.02 0.03 0.04 0.05 0.06 0.07 0.08 0.09 0.1 0.11 0.12 0.13 0.14 0.15 0.16 0.17 0.18 0.19 0.2 Traq Overrides and Special Considerations Traq functionality is not used in unoccupied mode since fresh air control is an occupied ventilation function. Damper position will be set to 0% minimum in Unoccupied as with other types of unit configuration. If the Remote Minimum Position pot on the RTEM is shorted (as with NOVAR controls) the Traq minimum damper position will be overridden to 0% as with other unit configurations. Traq functions and sensor value are only valid during active Supply Fan operation therefore a value of "0 CFM" will be substituted for any low level (bleed through) sensor value that may be sensed on the OA Flow Sensor during "Fan OFF" periods. OA Damper Minimum Position is only valid during active fan operation in all configurations. The Design Min OA Flow Setpoint will be limited to a lower limit of 1,000 CFM and an upper limit of 20,000 CFM. Setting of values outside of this range, except for "0 CFM", will result in the setting being clamped within the range. A value of "0" CFM will be allowed and will result in initialization of the Traq OA Damper Min Position calculation, and an active value of "0%" will be sent as the Active Traq setpoint. This allows the user to 56 set the damper closed by setting the flow setpoint to 0 CFM. If Demand Controlled Ventilation is configured then the lower limit of the Design Min OA Flow Setpoint will be 1,500 CFM to allow a gap to the DCV Min OA Flow Setpoint of 500 CFM making its lower limit 1,000 CFM. When the Design Min OA Flow Setpoint is greater than 1,500 CFM a minimum of 500 CFM offset will be enforced between the DCV Min OA Flow Setpoint and the Design Min OA Flow Setpoint. If configured for Traq operation and OA CFM Compensation, the unit will perform Traq control since it will be the most accurate method of control. This situation might occur if a unit is upgraded to Traq control, but the OA CFM Compensation config jumper on the RTEM is left on. It will be assumed by the presence of a valid OA CFM Flow Sensor and the RTVM version that supports Traq is accompanied by all the necessary unit equipment upgrades. Supply Air Temperature Control Heating and Cooling For Cooling, Heating (Modulating Heat Only), and Hot Gas Reheat operation the unit will control the active capacity outputs to meet a varying, calculated Discharge Air Setpoint that is calculated based on zone conditions in order to maintain the Zone Temperature to the active Zone Setpoint. Note that this setpoint will be clamped between the user selected DA Heat and DA Cool - Fan Speed setpoints that are set on the RTOM for compressor and economizer control. In general, as the zone temperature rises above the ZCSP, the Active Discharge Air Setpoint will be calculated down and as the zone temperature falls below the ZHSP Tset will be calculated upward. This calculated setpoint is a direct indication of space demand and is also used to determine the proper supply fan speed to meet the space requirements. During active capacity control, the unit will utilize a +/- 3.5°F deadband around the active Discharge Air Setpoint to determine when to request additional heating or cooling capacity similarly to traditional VAV control, as described below. If the unit is maintaining the discharge air temperature within the +/- 3.5°F deadband around the calculated discharge air setpoint requirements, no additional capacity will be requested. The calculated setpoint will also be used for active economizer control, but the economizer will utilize a tighter control deadband (+/- 1.5°F) than that is used for compressor output control. Also, as on Traditional VAV units, mechanical cooling will be inhibited if economizing is enabled until the economizer has been full open for 3 minutes. RT-SVX34U-EN Variable Air Volume Applications (Traditional VAV) Supply Air Temperature Control Occupied Cooling and Heating The RTRM is designed to maintain a selectable supply air temperature of 40°F to 90°F with a +/- 3.5°F deadband. In cooling, if supply air temperature is more than 3.5 degrees warmer than the selected temperature, a stage of cooling will be turned "On" (if available). Then if the supply air temperature is more than 3.5 degrees cooler than the selected temperature, a stage of cooling will be turned "Off". At very low airflows the unit may cycle stages "On" and "Off" to maintain an average discharge air temperature outside the 7 degree deadband. If the unit has modulating heat, the unit can be made to do discharge heating with VAV control. This is done by placing a contact closure across the "Changeover Input" on the RTAM. During this mode, the unit will heat to the Supply Air Heating Setpoint +/- 3.5°F. During low load or low airflow conditions the actual temperature swing of the discharge air will likely be greater. The RTRM utilizes a proportional and integral control scheme with the integration occurring when the supply air temperature is outside the deadband. As long as the supply air temperature is within the setpoint deadband, the system is considered to be satisfied and no staging up or down will occur. Supply Air Temperature Control with an Economizer The economizer is utilized to control the supply air cooling at +1.5°F around the supply air temperature setpoint range of 40°F and 90°F providing the outside air conditions are suitable. While economizing, the mechanical cooling is disabled until the economizer dampers have been fully open for three minutes. If the economizer is disabled due to unsuitable conditions, the mechanical cooling will cycle as though the unit had no economizer. VHR Relay Output During unoccupied mode, daytime warm-up (DWU) and morning warm-up (MWU) the VFD will open to 100%. All VAV boxes must be opened through an ICS program or by the VHR wired to the VAV boxes. The RTRM will delay 100% fan operation approximately 6.5 minutes when switching from occupied cooling mode to a heating mode. RT-SVX34U-EN Startup Zone Temperature Control without a Night Setback Panel or ICS - Unoccupied Cooling When a field supplied occupied/unoccupied switching device is connected between RTRM J6-11 and RTRM J6-12, both the economizer and the mechanical cooling will be disabled. Zone Temperature Control without a Night Setback Panel or ICS - Unoccupied Heating When a field supplied occupied/unoccupied switching device is connected between RTRM J6-11 and J6-12 and DWU is enabled, the zone temperature will be controlled at 10°F below the Morning Warm-up setpoint, but not less than 50°F, by cycling one or two stages of either gas or electric heat, whichever is applicable. Morning Warm-up (MWU) Control Morning Warm-up is activated if the zone temperature is at least 1.5°F below the MWU setpoint whenever the system switches from Unoccupied to Occupied status. The MWU setpoint may be set from the unit mounted potentiometer or a remotely mounted potentiometer. The setpoint ranges are from 50°F to 90°F. When the zone temperature meets or exceeds the MWU setpoint, the unit will switch to the "Cooling" mode. The economizer will be held closed during the morning warm-up cycle. Daytime Warm-up (DWU) Control Daytime Warm-up is applicable during occupied status and when the zone temperature is below the initiation temperature. It can be activated or deactivated through ICS or a night setback zone sensor. If ICS or a night setback zone sensor is not utilized, DWU can be activated by setting the DWU enable DIP switch (RTAM) to ON and supplying a valid morning warm-up setpoint. The unit is shipped with a Morning Warm-up setpoint configured and the Daytime Warm-up function is activated (switch on). Opening the DWU enable switch will disable this function. If the system control is local, the DWU initiation setpoint is 3°F below the Morning Warm-up setpoint. The termination setpoint is equal to the Morning Warm-up setpoint. If the system control is remote (Tracer®), the DWU setpoint is equal to the Tracer Occupied heating setpoint. The initiation and termination setpoints are selectable setpoints designated by Tracer. When the zone temperature meets or exceeds the termination setpoint while the unit is in an Occupied, "Auto" Mode or switched to the "Cooling" Mode, the unit will revert to the cooling operation. 57 Volts Startup If an Occupied "Heating" Mode is selected, the unit will only function within the DWU perimeters until the system is switched from the "Heat" Mode or enters an Unoccupied status. Note: When a LCI is installed on a VAV unit, the MWU setpoint located on the RTAM board is ignored. The MWU and DWU setpoints come from the higher priority LCI-R DAC. Supply Duct Static Pressure Control The supply duct static pressure is measured by a transducer with a 0.25 to 2.125 Vdc proportional output which corresponds to an adjustable supply duct static pressure of 0.3" w.c. to 2.5" w.c. respectively with a deadband adjustment range from 0.2" w.c. to 1.0" w.c. The setpoint is adjustable on the RTAM Static Pressure Setpoint potentiometer or through ICS. Example: Supply Duct Static setpoint = 2.0" w.c. (RTAM) Deadband = 0.2" w.c. (RTAM) Duct Static Control Range = 1.9" w.c. to 2.1" w.c. Figure 45. Output vs. input Transducer Voltage Output vs Pressure Input 4.5 4.0 3.5 3.0 2.5 2.0 1.5 1.0 0.5 0.0 -0.5 0.0 0.5 1.0 1.5 2.0 2.5 3.0 3.5 4.0 4.5 5.0 5.5 Pressure (inches w.c.) Supply Air Temperature Reset The supply air temperature can be reset by using one of four DIP switch configurations on the RTAM or through ICS when a valid supply air reset setpoint with a supply air reset amount is given. A selectable reset amount of 0° F to 20°F via RTAM potentiometer or ICS is permissible for each type of reset. The amount of change applied to the supply air temperature setpoint depends on how far the return air, zone, or outdoor air temperature falls below the reset temperature setpoint. If the return air, zone, or outdoor air temperature is equal to or greater than the reset temperature setpoint, the amount of change is zero. If the return air, or zone temperature falls 3°F below the reset temperature setpoint, the amount of reset applied to the supply air temperature will equal the maximum amount of reset selected. 58 If the outdoor air temperature falls 20°F below the reset temperature setpoint, the amount of reset applied to the supply air temperature will equal the maximum amount of reset selected. The four DIP switch configurations are as follows: · None - When RTAM DIP Switch #3 and #4 are in the "Off" position, no reset will be allowed. · Reset based on Return Air Temperature - When RTAM DIP Switch #3 is "Off" and Switch #4 is "On", a selectable supply air reset setpoint of 50°F to 90°F via a unit mounted potentiometer or Tracer® is permissible. · Reset based on Zone Temperature - When RTAM DIP Switch #3 is "On" and Switch #4 is "Off", a selectable supply air reset setpoint of 50°F to 90°F via RTAM potentiometer or Tracer is permissible. · Reset based on Outdoor Air Temperature - When DIP Switch #3 and #4 are "On", a selectable supply air reset setpoint of 0°F to 100°F via RTAM potentiometer or Tracer is permissible. VAV Supply Air Tempering (Only Available with Modulating Gas Heat) The gas heater will be modulated to prevent the Discharge Air Temperature from falling below the Discharge Temperature Deadband. Upon satisfying the Supply Air Tempering requirements, a 5 minute SA Tempering Delay timer will start whenever the modulating gas heat combustion blower is commanded to 0 and must time out before the unit will be allowed to re-enter "Cool" mode. This timer will be reset to 5 minutes whenever there is an active call for "Supply Air Tempering". Tempering will be discontinued whenever; · The 5 minutes "Supply Air Tempering Delay" timer has timed-out and; · There is an active cooling request for VAV Occupied Cooling. Constant Volume or Variable Air Volume Applications (Single Zone or Traditional) Off Mode This mode is set at the zone sensor or by ICS. During this status, no heating, ventilation, or mechanical cooling is being performed. When switching the "System" selector to the "Off" mode from any other mode, any diagnostic data and diagnostic indication signal will be retained as long as the system remains in the "Off" status. Switching the "System" selector from the "Off" mode back to any other mode of operation will reset all diagnostics. RT-SVX34U-EN Zone Temperature - Unoccupied Cooling (CV or SZ VAV Only) While a building is in an unoccupied period as designated by a remote panel with night setback, ICS or RTRM J6-11 and J6-12, the necessary cooling capacity will be controlled to maintain the zone temperature to within the unoccupied setpoint deadband. If an economizer is enabled, it will modulate in an attempt to maintain the zone temperature to within the setpoint deadband. Note: On SZ VAV units, the Supply Air Fan Speed will be controlled as during normal occupied conditions in order to meet the requirements of the zone. Unoccupied mode does not require full airflow on a SZ VAV unit during Cooling operation. Zone Temperature - Unoccupied Heating While a building is in an unoccupied period as designated by a remote panel with night setback or ICS, the necessary heating capacity will be controlled to maintain the zone temperature to within the unoccupied setpoint deadband. For traditional VAV systems, the VFD will operate at 100% during this mode. It will be necessary to drive VAV boxes to their maximum position through ICS programming or the factory provided VHR relay. For SZ VAV systems, the Supply Air Fan VFD will remain in control as during normal occupied periods and will be controlled in order to meet the space requirements. The minimum fan speed will be based on the configured unit heating type. For Modulating Heat units, Full Airflow is not required for SZ VAV applications during Unoccupied periods. For all Staged Heating types, the Supply Fan will be controlled at maximum fan speed during active heating operation as during Occupied periods. Mechanical Cooling with an Economizer The economizer is utilized to control the zone temperature when the outside air conditions are suitable. The method used to determine economizer effectiveness, depending on the available data, is described below in descending order of complexity. The most sophisticated method available is always used. Table 33. Economizer effectiveness Method used to determine economizer effectiveness Required Comparative Enthalpy OAT, OAH, RAT, RAH Reference Enthalpy OAT, OAH Reference Dry Bulb OAT Unable to determine effectiveness OAT data is invalid or unavailable RT-SVX34U-EN Startup Two of the three methods for determining the suitability of the outside air can be selected utilizing the potentiometer on the Economizer Actuator, as described below: · Ambient Temperature - controlling the economizing cycle by sensing the outside air dry bulb temperature. Table 34, p. 59 lists the selectable dry bulb values by potentiometer setting. · Reference Enthalpy - controlling the economizer cycle by sensing the outdoor air humidity. Table 34, p. 59 lists the selectable enthalpy values by potentiometer setting. If the outside air enthalpy value is less than the selected value, the economizer is allowed to operate. · Comparative Enthalpy - By utilizing a humidity sensor and a temperature sensor in both the return air stream and the outdoor air stream, the economizer will be able to establish which conditions are best suited for maintaining the zone temperature, i.e., indoor conditions or outdoor conditions. Table 34. Economizer configuration Potentiometer Setting Point A Dry bulb changeover Point 73°F Reference Enthalpy 27 BTU/lb. B 70°F 25 BTU/lb. C(a) 67°F 23 BTU/lb. D 63°F 22 BTU/lb. E 55ºF 19 BTU/lb. (a) Factory setting Gas Heat Control The ignition sequence and timing are provided by a separate heat control module. The RTRM only provides the heating outputs to initiate 1st and 2nd stages and control the combustion blower relays. Both stages of the furnace, when initiated after each cycle, will start and operate for one minute then cycle back if only one stage is required. Units with modulating heat capabilities will light on high fire for one minute and then modulate to the appropriate heating rate for the building load present. When the fan selection switch is in the "AUTO" mode and the unit is configured as a Constant Volume with staged or modulating gas heat, or SZVAV with staged gas heat, the fan will be delayed from coming on for approximately 30 seconds after a call for heat has been initiated. The fan will remain on for approximately 90 seconds after the heating setpoint has been satisfied. If the unit is configured for SZ VAV with modulating heat, the fan will be energized with the call for heating in order to begin circulating airflow through the unit for discharge air temperature control. Once the call for 59 Startup heating is removed, the fan will remain on for approximately 90 seconds. Electric Heat Control The RTRM provides two heating outputs for 1st and 2nd stages that will be controlled with at least a 10 seconds delay between each stage. When the fan selection switch is in the "AUTO" mode and the unit is configured for Constant Volume, the fan will start approximately 1 second before the 1st heater stage is activated. The fan and heater will cycle off after the heating setpoint has been satisfied. If the unit is configured for SZ VAV control, the Supply Fan will energize approximately 5 seconds prior to energizing the electric heat outputs. Once the Zone Heating requirements have been satisfied, the fan and heat outputs will be controlled off. Clogged Filter Option The unit mounted clogged filter switch monitors the pressure differential across the return air filters. It is mounted in the filter section and is connected to the RTOM. The switch is adjustable and can be set for a particular application. The clogged filter switch is normally open and will automatically close when the pressure differential across the filters falls below the clogged filter setpoint. The RTOM will generate a SERVICE diagnostic that will be sent to the zone sensor or remote panel when the clogged filter switch has been closed for at least 2 minutes during supply fan operation. The system will continue to operate regardless of the status of the clogged filter switch. Ventilation Override Note: Applying 24 volts to one of the three Ventilation Override Inputs manually activates ventilation override. One input is provided to request the Pressurize Mode, the second input the Purge Mode, and the third input the Exhaust Mode. When the Pressurize Mode is selected, activating Ventilation Override will cause the supply fan to run, the economizer to open to 100%, the exhaust fan to turn (remain) off, or the VFD to run at full speed (SZ VAV and Traditional VAV), and the VAV boxes to fully open. When Purge is selected, activating Ventilation Override will cause the supply fan to run, the economizer to open to 100%, the exhaust fan to run, or the VFD to run at full speed (SZ VAV or Traditional VAV), and the VAV boxes to fully open. When Exhaust is selected, activating Ventilation Override will cause the supply fan to turn off, the economizer to close to 0%, the exhaust fan to run (exhaust damper at 100% if configured for Statitrac), or the VFD to stop, and the VAV boxes to operate normally. 60 If more than one mode is requested at the same time, the Pressurize request will have priority followed by Purge. When any Ventilation Override Mode is active, all heating and cooling is turned off. For the case where the unit is required to turn off, the Emergency Stop input is used. The ICS can also initiate any ventilation override mode. Table 35, p. 60 lists the sequence of events within the system for each ventilation mode. Refer to the unit wiring diagram for contact switching and wiring. Note: Fresh air tracking will not work with VOM. Table 35. Ventilation override sequence Affected Function Mode and Priority Pressurize Purge Exhaust(a) 1 2 3 Heat/Cool off off off VFD full speed full speed full speed Supply Fan on on off Exhaust Fan off on(b) on Economizer open open closed VAV Boxes forced open forced open normal operation (a) Exhaust mode 3 is not available with the tracking power exhaust option. (b) For units configured with the Statitrac option, the Exhaust Damper will open during Ventilation Override modes that request the exhaust fan to operate. Emergency Stop When this binary input is opened, all outputs are immediately turned off and the system will not be allowed to restart until the binary input is closed for approximately 5 seconds minimum. The shut down is communicated to Tracer® if applicable and the Heat and Cool LED outputs (RTRM J6-7 and J6-8) will blink at a nominal rate of 1 blink per second. Phase Monitor The Phase Monitor is a 3 phase line monitor module that protects against phase loss, phase reversal and phase unbalance. It is intended to protect compressors from reverse rotation. It has an operating input voltage range of 190-600 VAC, and LED indicators for ON and FAULT. There are no field adjustments and the module will automatically reset from a fault condition. Low Pressure Control This input incorporates the low pressure cutout of each refrigeration circuit and can be activated by opening a field supplied contact. If this circuit is open before a compressor(s) is started, neither compressor in that circuit will be allowed to operate. RT-SVX34U-EN Anytime this circuit is opened for 5 continuous seconds, the compressor(s) in that circuit are turned off immediately. The compressor(s) will not be allowed to restart for a minimum of 3 minutes. If four consecutive open conditions occur during the first three minutes of operation, the compressor(s) in that circuit will be locked out, a diagnostic communicated to Tracer, and a manual reset will be required to restart the compressor(s). The hot gas reheat option has one reheat low pressure cutout (RLP). The RLP is located on the reheat circuit. Hot Gas Reheat Low Pressure Control The RLP has been added to insure proper refrigerant management during active modulating hot gas reheat operation. The RLP will be ignored for the first 10 minutes of compressor run time during active hot gas reheat operation. Anytime this circuit is opened for 5 continuous seconds, the compressor(s) in that circuit are turned off immediately. The compressor(s) will not be allowed to restart for a minimum of 3 minutes. If four consecutive open conditions occur during active hot gas reheat, the compressor(s) in that circuit will be locked out. High Pressure Cutout and Temperature Discharge Limit The high pressure controls and temperature discharge limit are wired in series between the compressor outputs on the RTRM and the compressor contactors. On 27.5, 30, and 35 Ton units, if the high pressure safety switch or temperature discharge limit opens, the RTRM senses a lack of current while calling for cooling and locks both compressors out with an auto reset. On 40 and 50 Ton units, if the high pressure safety or temperature discharge limit opens, the compressor(s) on the affected circuit is locked out. If the compressor output circuit is opened four consecutive times during compressor operation, the RTRM will generate a manual reset lockout. Power Exhaust Control The power exhaust fan is started whenever the position of the economizer dampers meets or exceed the power exhaust setpoint when the supply fan is on. The setpoint potentiometer is on the RTOM and is factory set at 25% for traditional constant volume and variable air volume units. For SZ VAV units the default power exhaust enable setpoint will be 25% as on non-SZ VAV units. However, for SZ VAV the Exhaust Enable Setpoint will need to be adjusted for the proper setpoint during the maximum Fan Speed Command for the unit. Once selected, the difference between the Exhaust Enable Setpoint and Design OA Damper Minimum Position at Full Fan Speed Command will be calculated. The difference RT-SVX34U-EN Startup calculated will be used as an offset to be added to the Active Building Design OA Minimum Position target to calculate the Dynamic Exhaust Enable Target to be used throughout the Supply Fan Speed/OA Damper Position range: Exhaust Enable Target = Active Bldg Design OA Min Position Target + (Active Exhaust Enable Setpoint Active Bldg Design OA Min Position @ Full Fan Speed Command) The Exhaust Enable Target could be above or below the Active Bldg Design OA Min Position Target Setpoint based on the Active Exhaust Enable Setpoint being set above or below the Bldg Design Min Position at Full Fan Speed Command. Note that an Exhaust Enable Setpoint of 0% will result in the same effect on Exhaust Fan control as on non-Single Zone VAV applications with and without Statitrac; Exhaust Fan ON. See Figure 46, p. 61 for how the exhaust enable setpoint is modified throughout the OA damper operating range. Figure 46. SZ VAV exhaust OAD Posion Setpoints Exhaust Enable Target Exhaust Enable @ Full Fan Speed Design @ Full Fan Speed Exhaust Enable Offset Minimum Fan Speed Middle Fan Speed Maximum Fan Speed Space Pressure Control - Statitrac A pressure transducer is used to measure and report direct space (building) static pressure. The user-defined control parameters used in this control scheme are Space Pressure Setpoint and Space Pressure Deadband. As the Economizer opens, the building pressure rises and enables the Exhaust Fan. The Exhaust dampers will be modulated to maintain Space Pressure within the Space Pressure Deadband. Note: The Exhaust Enable setpoint will need to be selected as on units with standard power exhaust control. 61 Startup Figure 47. Transducer voltage output vs. pressure input for building pressure Power Exhaust Control (Tracking) The power exhaust dampers proportionally track or follow the fresh air (economizer) damper position. The offset between the fresh air and the exhaust damper(s) is adjustable, see figures beginning with Figure 54, p. 84. Refer to Power Exhaust Fan Performance" tables beginning with Table 53, p. 83. Lead/Lag Control Lead/Lag is a selectable input located on the RTRM. On 2 & 3 stage standard efficiency units, the RTRM is configured from the factory with the Lead/Lag control disabled. To activate the Lead/Lag function, simply remove the jumper connection J3-8 at the RTRM Lead/ Lag input. When it is activated, each time the designated lead compressor(s) is shut off due to the load being satisfied, the lead compressor or refrigeration circuit switches. On the 5 stage high efficiency units, the RTRM is configured from the factory with the Lead/Lag control enabled. With it active, each time the designated lead compressor is shut off due to the load being satisfied, the controls will switch to the next staging sequence. When the RTRM is powered up, i.e. after a power failure, the control will default to the number one compressor. Table 36. Capacity steps with lead/lag enabled - std Efficiency Unit Size TC*330 TC*360 TC*420 TC*480 VAV only LEAD LAG LEAD LAG LEAD LAG LEAD LAG Step 1 48% 52% 50% 50% 47% 53% 40% 60% Step 2 100% 100% 100% 100% 100% 100% 60% 100% Step 3 100% 62 Table 36. Capacity steps with lead/lag enabled - std Efficiency (continued) Unit Size TC*600 VAV only LEAD LAG Step 1 32% 68% Step 2 68% 100% Step 3 100% Table 37. Capacity staging sequence - high Efficiency and 4050 tons std eff CV Steps Unit Size Sequence 1 2 3 4 5 1 25 37 63 75 100 TC*330 2 3 37 63 75 100 37 63 75 100 1 24 38 62 76 100 TC*360 2 38 62 76 100 TC*420 3 38 62 76 100 1 22 39 61 78 100 2 39 61 78 100 3 39 61 78 100 1 23 39 61 77 100 TC*480 2 3 39 61 77 100 39 61 77 100 1 25 38 62 75 100 TC*600 2 3 38 62 75 100 38 62 75 100 Coil Frost Protection The FrostatTM control monitors the suction line temperature to prevent the evaporator from freezing due to low operating temperatures whenever there is a demand for cooling. When a closed circuit has occurred for 5 seconds minimum, the RTRM turns off all of the cooling outputs. The Supply Fan will be held "On" until the Frostat has been open for 5 continuous seconds or for 60 seconds after the last compressor was shut "Off", whichever is the longest. The compressor shutdown is communicated to Tracer, if applicable. There is no local diagnostic for this condition. Modulating Hot Gas Reheat Frost Protection Two control schemes will be active on units configured for Modulating Hot Gas Reheat. The first employs the use of the Frostat function. The second scheme takes precedence over Frostat. Operation will be as described below. The second scheme is in control during active hot gas reheat or cooling and includes the use of an Entering RT-SVX34U-EN Startup Evaporator Temperature sensor (EET). If the EET drops below 35°F for 10 continuous minutes compressors will stage off. For dual circuit units one circuit will be staged off initially, and then if the EET remains below 35ºF for an additional 10 minutes, the second circuit will be staged off. For single circuit units one compressor will be staged off initially, and then if the EET remains below 35ºF for an additional 10 minutes, the second circuit will be staged off. When the unit is operating in hot gas reheat mode, only the reheat circuit will be re-enabled if the EET rises above 45ºF. The cooling circuit will not be re-enabled during hot gas reheat until the unit leaves the current hot gas reheat cycle or a dehumidification purge is initiated. If the unit is operating in Cooling, the first circuit that deenergized will be re-enabled when the EET rises above 45ºF. The second compressor will be allowed to reenergize at 10 minutes after the EET rises above 45ºF or if a purge cycle is initiated. Drain Pan Condensate Overflow Switch (Optional) This input incorporates the Condensate Overflow Switch (COF) mounted on the drain pan and the ReliaTel Options Module (RTOM). When the condensate level reaches the trip point for 6 continuous seconds, the RTOM will shut down all unit function until the overflow condition has cleared. The unit will return to normal operation after 6 continuous seconds with the COF in a non-tripped condition. If the condensate level causes the unit to shutdown more than 2 times in a 3 day period, the unit will be lockedout of operation. A manual reset of the diagnostic system through the Zone Sensor or Building Automation System (BAS) will be required. Cycling unit power will also clear the fault. VFD Programming Parameters See System Troubleshooting section. Condenser Fan Sequencing Control The condenser fans are cycled according to the outdoor air temperature and the number of cooling steps that are operating. Table 38, p. 63 and Table 39, p. 65 list the temperatures at which the A and B Condenser Fan Outputs on the RTRM switches the fans "Off". The fans are switched back "ON" when the outdoor temperature rises approximately 5° F above the "Off" temperature. Figure 48, p. 63 shows the condenser fans as viewed from the top of the unit facing the control panel. Whenever a condenser fan is cycled back "On", the condenser fan Outputs A and B and the compressor steps are de-energized for approximately seven seconds to prevent problems with fan windmill. Figure 48. Condenser fan location Lead fan continuous operation Control box Table 38. Condenser fan/compressor sequence - std efficiency Unit Size (Ton) Compressor Staging Sequence Step 1 Step2 Step 3 Condenser Fan Output Output A Output B CPR1(a) 27.5 - 30 NA CPR1, 2 Fan #2 Fan #2 Fan #3 Fan #3 CPR1(a) 35 NA CPR1, 2 Fan #2 Fan #2 Fan #3 Fan #3 CPR1(b) Fan #2 Fan #3, 4 40 VAV only CPR2(c) Fan #2 Fan #3, 4 CPR1, 2 Fan #2 Fan #3, 4 O/A Temp. (°F) Fans "Off" 70 90 -10 60 65 85 -20 55 50 70 20 60 -30 50 RT-SVX34U-EN 63 Startup Table 38. Condenser fan/compressor sequence - std efficiency (continued) Unit Size (Ton) Compressor Staging Sequence Step 1 Step2 Step 3 CPR1(b) Condenser Fan Output Output A Output B Fan #2 Fan #3, 4 O/A Temp. (°F) Fans "Off" 20 60 50 VAV only CPR2, 3(d) Fan #2 -10 Fan #3, 4 55 Fan #2 -30 CPR1, 2, 3 Fan #3, 4 50 Notes: 1. 2. 3. The compressor(s) listed under each step are the operating compressors. On 27.5 to 35 Ton units with Lead/Lag, CPR1 will alternate but the fan sequence will remain the same. On 40 & 50 Ton units with Lead/Lag, the compressor (s) in step 2 & 3 will alternate and the fan sequence listed for that step will be in operation. Conventional thermostat sequence: Y1=CPR1, Y2=CPR2 (40 CPR 2 & 50 CPR 2,3), Y1 + Y2 = CPR1,2 (40 CPR 1,2 & 50 CPR 1,2,3) During active hot gas reheat all compressors will be staged "On". For units equipped with four condenser fans (40 and 50 Ton), the condenser fan output states will be controlled based on the O/A temperature. If O/A is above 85°F, all condenser fan outputs will be energized. If O/A falls below 80°F, Output B will de-energize and will not reenergize again until the O/A rises above 85°F. For units configured with three condenser fans (27.5 to 35 Ton), a maximum of two condenser fans will energize. Output A will energize above 85°F and de-energize when the O/A falls below 80°F; Output B will remain de-energized during active hot gas reheat. If O/A falls below 80°F, Output A will de-energize and will not re-energize again until O/A rises above 85°F. (a) Single circuit, manifolded compressors pair. (b) First Stage, Number one refrigeration circuit, Standalone compressor is "On". (c) First Stage is "Off", Number two refrigeration circuit, standalone compressor is "On". (d) First stage is "Off", Number two refrigeration circuit, manifolded compressor pair is "On" operating simultaneously. 64 RT-SVX34U-EN Startup Table 39. Condenser fan/compressor sequence - high efficiency 27.5-35 Ton High Efficiency Fan #1 ON Compressor Stage 1 Compressor Stage 2 Fan #2 OFF OFF ON ON ON Fan #3 OFF OFF OFF OFF ON Ambient Range (F) 0-70 70-75 75-80 80-85 85-115 # Cond Fans On 1 1 or 2 2 2 or 3 3 Fan #1 ON Fan #2 OFF OFF ON ON ON Fan #3 OFF OFF OFF OFF ON Ambient Range (F) 0-58 58-63 63-70 70-75 75-115 27.5-35 Ton High Efficiency # Cond Fans On 1 1 OR 2 2 2 OR 3 3 Fan #1 ON Compressor Stages 3 or 4 Compressor Stage 5 Fan #2 OFF OFF ON ON ON Fan #3 OFF OFF OFF OFF ON Ambient Range (F) 0-60 60-65 65-70 70-75 75-115 # Cond Fans On 1 1 OR 2 2 2 OR 3 3 Fan #1 ON Fan #2 OFF OFF ON ON ON Fan #3 OFF OFF OFF OFF ON Ambient Range (F) 0-50 50-55 55-60 60-65 65-115 40 Ton High Eff. and Std Eff. CV # Cond Fans On 1 1 OR 2 2 2 OR 3 3 Fan #1 ON Compressor Stages 1 & 2 Ambient Fan #2 Fan #3 & 4 Range (F) OFF OFF 0-60 OFF OFF 60-70 ON OFF 70-80 ON OFF 80-85 ON ON 85-115 40 Ton High Eff. and Std Eff. CV # Cond Fans On 1 1 or 2 2 2 or 4 4 Fan #1 ON Compressor Stages 3 & 4 Ambient Fan #2 Fan #3 & 4 Range (F) OFF OFF 0-40 OFF OFF 40-45 ON OFF 45-75 ON OFF 75-80 ON ON 80-115 50 Ton High Eff. and Std Eff. CV # Cond Fans On 1 1 OR 2 2 2 OR 4 4 Fan #1 ON Compressor Stage 5 Compressor Stages 1 & 2 Fan #2 OFF OFF ON ON ON Ambient Fan #3 & 4 Range (F) OFF 0-40 OFF 40-45 OFF 45-65 OFF 65-70 ON 70-115 # Cond Fans On 1 1 OR 2 2 2 OR 4 4 Fan #1 ON Fan #2 OFF OFF ON ON ON Ambient Fan #3 & 4 Range (F) OFF 0-60 OFF 60-65 OFF 65-75 OFF 75-80 ON 80-115 50 Ton High Eff. and Std Eff. CV # Cond Fans On 1 1 or 2 2 2 or 4 4 Compressor Stages 3 & 4 Compressor Stage 5 Fan #1 Fan #2 Fan #3 & 4 Ambient Range (F) # Cond Fans On Fan #1 Fan #2 Fan #3 & 4 Ambient Range (F) # Cond Fans On OFF OFF 0-35 1 OFF OFF 0-35 1 OFF OFF 35-40 1 OR 2 OFF OFF 35-40 1 OR 2 ON ON OFF 40-70 2 ON ON OFF 40-60 2 ON OFF 70-75 2 OR 4 ON OFF 60-65 2 OR 4 Notes: 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. ON ON 75-115 4 ON ON 65-115 4 Condenser fan will de-energize at 5ºF below the energizing temperature Compressor Stage 1 = CPR1 Compressor Stage 2 = CPR2 or CPR3 depending on staging sequence Compressor Stage 3 = CPR1 & CPR2 or CPR2 & CPR3 depending on staging sequence Compressor Stage 4 = CPR2 & CPR3 Compressor Stage 5 = CPR1 & CPR2 & CPR3 Conventional three stage thermostat sequence: Y1=CPR1 (Stage 1), Y2=CPR1&2 (Stage 3), Y1 + Y2 = CPR1,2,3 (Stage 5) During active hot gas reheat all compressors will be staged "On". For units equipped with four condenser fans (40 and 50 Ton), the condenser fan output states will be controlled based on the O/A temperature. If O/A is above 85°F, all condenser fan outputs will be energized. If O/A falls below 80°F, Output B will de-energize and will not re-energize again until the O/A rises above 85°F. For units configured with three condenser fans (27.5 to 35 Ton), a maximum of two condenser fans will energize. Output A will energize above 85° F and de-energize when the O/A falls below 80°F; Output B will remain de-energized during active hot gas reheat. If O/A falls below 80°F, Output A will de-energize and will not re-energize again until O/A rises above 85°F. RT-SVX34U-EN 65 Startup Preparing the Unit for Operation Be sure to complete all of the procedures described in this section before starting the unit for the first time. Use the checklist provided below in conjunction with the "Installation Checklist" to ensure that the unit is properly installed and ready for operation. WARNING Hazardous Voltage! Failure to disconnect power before servicing could result in death or serious injury. Disconnect all electric power, including remote disconnects before servicing. Follow proper lockout/tagout procedures to ensure the power can not be inadvertently energized. Verify that no power is present with a voltmeter. · Check all electrical connections for tightness and "point of termination" accuracy. · Verify that the condenser airflow will be unobstructed. · Check the compressor crankcase oil level. Oil should be visible in the compressor oil sight glass. The oil level may be above the sight glass prior to the initial start. Use appropriate lighting (flashlight) to verify the presence of oil. · Prior to unit startup allow the crankcase heater to operate a minimum of 8 hours to remove liquid refrigerant from the compressor sump. · Optional Service Valves - Verify that the discharge service valve and suction service valve fully open on each circuit. Note: High Efficiency units come standard with discharge service valves. · Check the supply fan belts for proper tension and the fan bearings for sufficient lubrication. If the belts require adjustment, or if the bearings need lubricating, refer to the Maintenance section of this manual for instructions. · Inspect the interior of the unit for tools and debris and install all panels in preparation for starting the unit. Electrical Phasing Unlike traditional reciprocating compressors, scroll compressors are phase sensitive. Proper phasing of the electrical supply to the unit is critical for proper operation and reliability. The compressor motor is internally connected for clockwise rotation with the incoming power supply phased as A, B, C. Proper electrical supply phasing can be quickly determined and corrected before starting the unit by using an instrument such as an Ideal - Sperry 61-520 Phase Sequence Indicator and following the steps below: 66 WARNING Hazardous Voltage! Failure to disconnect power before servicing could result in death or serious injury. Disconnect all electric power, including remote disconnects before servicing. Follow proper lockout/tagout procedures to ensure the power can not be inadvertently energized. Verify that no power is present with a voltmeter. · Open the disconnect switch or circuit protector switch that provides the supply power to the unit's power terminal block or to the unit mounted disconnect switch. · To be consistent with the compressor leads, connect the phase sequence indicator leads to the terminal block or unit mounted disconnect switch as follows; Table 40. Phase sequence leads Phase Sequence Leads Red (phase A) Blue (phase B) Black (Phase C) Unit Power Terminal L1 L2 L3 · Turn the "System" selection switch to the "Off" position and the "Fan" selection switch (if Applicable) to the "Auto" position. · Close the disconnect switch or circuit protector switch that provides the supply power to the unit's power terminal block or unit mounted disconnect switch. WARNING Live Electrical Components! Failure to follow all electrical safety precautions when exposed to live electrical components could result in death or serious injury. When it is necessary to work with live electrical components, have a qualified licensed electrician or other individual who has been properly trained in handling live electrical components perform these tasks. HIGH VOLTAGE IS PRESENT AT TERMINAL BLOCK HTB1 OR UNIT DISCONNECT SWITCH. · Observe the ABC and CBA phase indicator lights on the face of the sequencer. The ABC indicator light will glow if the phase is ABC. If the CBA indicator light glows, open the disconnect switch or circuit protection switch and reverse any two power wires. · Restore main electrical power and recheck phasing. If the phasing is correct, open the disconnect switch or circuit protection switch and remove the phase sequence indicator. RT-SVX34U-EN Voltage Supply and Voltage Imbalance Supply Voltage Electrical power to the unit must meet stringent requirements for the unit to operate properly. Measure each leg (phase-to-phase) of the power supply. Each reading must fall within the utilization range stamped on the unit nameplate. If any of the readings do not fall within the proper tolerances, notify the power company to correct this situation before operating the unit. Voltage Imbalance Excessive voltage imbalance between phases in a three phase system will cause motors to overheat and eventually fail. The maximum allowable voltage imbalance is 2%. Measure and record the voltage between phases 1, 2, and 3 and calculate the amount of imbalance as follows: % Voltage Imbalance = [(AV VD)/AV] x 100 where; AV (Average Voltage) = (Volt 1 + Volt 2 + Volt 3) / 3 Volt 1, Volt 2, Volt 3 = Line Voltage Readings VD = Line Voltage reading that deviates the farthest from the average voltage. Example: · If the voltage readings of the supply power measured 221, 230, and 227, the average volts would be: (221 + 230 + 227) / 3 = 226 Avg · VD (reading farthest from average) = 221 · The percentage of imbalance equals: [(226221) / 226] x 100 = 2.2% The 2.2% imbalance in this example exceeds the maximum allowable imbalance of 2.0%. This much imbalance between phases can equal as much as a 20% current imbalance with a resulting increase in motor winding temperatures that will decrease motor life. If the voltage imbalance at the job site is over 2%, notify the proper agencies to correct the voltage problem to within 2.0% before operating this equipment. Starting the Unit Before closing the main power disconnect switch, insure that the "System" selection switch is in the "Off" position and the "Fan" selection switch for Constant Volume or SZ VAV units is in the "Auto" position. Close the main power disconnect switch and the unit mounted disconnect switch, if applicable. RT-SVX34U-EN Startup WARNING Live Electrical Components! Failure to follow all electrical safety precautions when exposed to live electrical components could result in death or serious injury. When it is necessary to work with live electrical components, have a qualified licensed electrician or other individual who has been properly trained in handling live electrical components perform these tasks. HIGH VOLTAGE IS PRESENT AT TERMINAL BLOCK HTB1 OR UNIT DISCONNECT SWITCH. Upon power initialization, the RTRM performs selfdiagnostic checks to insure that all internal controls are functional. It also checks the configuration parameters against the components connected to the system. The LED located on the RTRM module is turned "On" within one second of power-up if internal operation is okay. The economizer dampers are driven open for 5 seconds then fully closed (if applicable). When an economizer is installed DO NOT ENTER the TEST mode until all calibration startup functions have been completed. Otherwise, the economizer actuator and power exhaust output may not function properly during any of the test mode steps. Allow 2 minutes after unit power up to complete economizer calibration before entering the test mode function. Use the following "Test" procedure to bypass some time delays and to start the unit at the control panel. Each step of unit operation can be activated individually by temporarily shorting across the "Test" terminals for two to three seconds. The LED located on the RTRM module will blink when the test mode has been initiated. The unit can be left in any "Test" step for up to one hour before it will automatically terminate, or it can be terminated by opening the main power disconnect switch. Once the test mode has been terminated, the LED will glow continuously and the unit will revert to the "System" control, i.e. zone temperature for constant volume units or discharge air temperature for variable air volume units. Test Modes There are three methods in which the "Test" mode can be cycled at LTB1-Test 1 and LTB1-Test 2. Note: For Constant Volume or Variable Air Volume test steps, test modes, and step resistance values to cycle the various components, refer to Table 41, p. 69 - Table 46, p. 74. Step Test Mode This method initiates the different components of the unit, one at a time, by temporarily shorting across the two test terminals for two to three seconds. For the initial startup of either a Constant Volume or Variable Air Volume (Single Zone or Traditional) unit, 67 Startup this method allows the technician to cycle a component "on" and have up to one hour to complete the check. Resistance Test Mode This method can be used for startup providing a decade box for variable resistance outputs is available. This method initiates the different components of the unit, one at a time, when a specific resistance value is placed across the two test terminals. The unit will remain in the specific test mode for approximately one hour even though the resistance is left on the test terminals. Auto Test Mode This method is not recommended for startup due to the short timing between individual component steps. This method initiates the different components of the unit, one at a time, when a jumper is installed across the test terminals. The unit will start the first test step and change to the next step every 30 seconds. At the end of the test mode, control of the unit will automatically revert to the applied "System" control method. Service Test Switch Location A toggle service switch is offered as a standard feature to provide hassle free startup option for the service person in the field. This toggle switch is located in the low voltage section of the control box. Figure 49. Service test switch 68 RT-SVX34U-EN Startup Table 41. Test mode states for traditional VAV units with modulating hot gas reheat and staged heat TEST STEP MODE FAN VFD COMMAND ECON COMP COMP COMP HEAT HEAT 1 2 3 1 2 PUMPOUT COOL VALVE REHEAT VALVE VAV BOX VFD 100% (10 1 SIGNAL OFF 100% VDC) CLOSED OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF 100% 0% ON VFD 2 SIGNAL OFF 0% 0% (0 VDC) CLOSED OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF 100% 0% ON 3 MIN VENT ON INCONTROL MIN OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF 100% 0% ON 4 ECON TEST OPEN ON INCONTROL OPEN OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF 100% 0% ON 5 COOL 1 ON INCONTROL MIN ON OFF OFF OFF OFF INCONTROL 100% 0% ON 6 COOL 2 ON INCONTROL MIN ON ON OFF OFF OFF INCONTROL 100% 0% ON 7 COOL 3 ON INCONTROL MIN ON ON ON OFF OFF INCONTROL 100% 0% ON 8 REHEAT ON INCONTROL MIN ON ON ON OFF OFF INCONTROL 50% 50% ON 9 HEAT 1 ON INCONTROL MIN OFF OFF OFF ON OFF OFF 100% 0% ON 10 HEAT 2 ON INCONTROL MIN OFF OFF OFF ON ON OFF 100% 0% ON 11 RESET Notes: 2 and 3 stage standard efficiency units (excluding 4050T std eff. CV): 1. For Traditional VAV units, the VFD Command when "In-Control" will be controlled based on Supply Air Pressure Requirements. For SZ VAV units, the VFD Command will be at discrete points during Test Mode. 2. For 27.5-35T units, both compressors will be energized during the Cool 2 Step. For 40-50T units, only Compressor 2 will be energized during the Cool 2 Step. 3. The Reheat Pumpout relay will be energized any time the Reheat circuit is energized in active Cooling Mode. 4. For units with Statitrac installed, the Exhaust Damper will track the Economizer position during Service Test Mode and the Exhaust Fan will be energized once the Economizer rises above the Exhaust Enable Setpoint. 5. Heating will not be energized during Service Test until the 6 minute VAV Box ON timer has expired. Notes: 5 stage high efficiency units (including 4050T std eff. CV): 1. Compressor 1 is the smaller compressor on the circuit. 2. Condenser fans are controlled as defined for normal operation. 3. Exhaust fan operates as defined for normal operation based on economizer position. 4. When Compressor 1 is energized with either C1, C2, or with both for 30 minutes continuously, C3 will be required to de-energize for 30 seconds. RT-SVX34U-EN 69 Startup Table 42. Test mode states for CV units with modulating hot gas reheat and staged heat TEST STEP MODE FAN COMP COMP COMP HEAT HEAT ECON 1 2 3 1 2 PUMPOUT COOL REHEAT VAV VALVE VALVE BOX 1 FAN ON ON MIN OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF 100% 0% ON 2 ECONOMIZER ON OPEN OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF 100% 0% ON 3 COOL 1 ON MIN ON OFF OFF OFF OFF INCONTROL 100% 0% ON 4 COOL 2 ON MIN ON ON OFF OFF OFF INCONTROL 100% 0% ON 5 COOL 3 ON MIN ON ON ON OFF OFF INCONTROL 100% 0% ON 6 REHEAT ON MIN ON ON ON OFF OFF INCONTROL 50% 50% ON 7 HEAT 1 ON MIN OFF OFF OFF ON OFF OFF 100% 0% ON 8 HEAT 2 ON MIN OFF OFF OFF ON ON OFF 100% 0% ON 9 RESET Notes: 2 and 3 stage standard efficiency units (excluding 4050T std eff. CV): 1. For 27.5-35T units, both compressors will be energized during the Cool 2 Step. For 40-50T units, only Compressor 2 will be energized during the Cool 2 Step. 2. The Reheat Pumpout relay will be energized any time the Reheat circuit is energized in active Cooling Mode. 3. For units with Statitrac installed, the Exhaust Damper will track the Economizer position during Service Test Mode and the Exhaust Fan will be energized once the Economizer rises above the Exhaust Enable Setpoint. 4. Heating will not be energized during Service Test until the 6 minute VAV Box ON timer has expired. Notes: 5 stage high efficiency units (including 4050T std eff. CV): 1. Compressor 1 is the smaller compressor on the circuit. 2. Condenser fans are controlled as defined for normal operation. 3. Exhaust fan operates as defined for normal operation based on economizer position. 4. When Compressor 1 is energized with either C1, C2, or with both for 30 minutes continuously, C3 will be required to de-energize for 30 seconds. 70 RT-SVX34U-EN Startup Table 43. Test mode states for SZ VAV units with modulating hot gas reheat and staged heat TEST STEP 1 MODE FAN ON FAN ON VFD COMMAND 45% (0 VDC) ECON COMP 1 COMP 2 COMP 3 HEAT 1 HEAT 2 PUMPOUT COOL VALVE REHEAT VALVE MIN OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF 100% 0% 45% 2 ECONOMIZER ON (0 VDC) OPEN OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF 100% 0% 3 COOL 1 80% ON (6.67 VDC) MIN ON OFF OFF OFF OFF INCONTROL 100% 0% 4 COOL 2 ON INCONTROL MIN ON ON OFF OFF OFF INCONTROL 100% 0% 5 COOL 3 ON INCONTROL MIN ON ON ON OFF OFF INCONTROL 100% 0% 6 REHEAT 73% ON (5.24 VDC) MIN ON ON ON OFF OFF INCONTROL 50% 50% 100% 7 HEAT 1 ON (10 VDC) MIN OFF OFF OFF ON OFF OFF 100% 0% 100% 8 HEAT 2 ON (10 VDC) MIN OFF OFF OFF ON ON OFF 100% 0% 9 RESET Notes: 2 and 3 stage standard efficiency units (excluding 40-50T Std Efficiency CV): 1. For Traditional VAV units, the VFD Command when "In-Control" will be controlled based on Supply Air Pressure Requirements. For SZ VAV units, the VFD Command will be at discrete points during Test Mode. 2. For 27.5-35T units, both compressors will be energized during the Cool 2 Step. For 40-50T units, only Compressor 2 will be energized during the Cool 2 Step. 3. The Reheat Pumpout relay will be energized any time the Reheat circuit is energized in active Cooling Mode. 4. For units with Statitrac installed, the Exhaust Damper will track the Economizer position during Service Test Mode and the Exhaust Fan will be energized once the Economizer rises above the Exhaust Enable Setpoint. Notes: 5 stage high efficiency units (including 40-50T Std Efficiency CV): 1. Compressor 1 is the smaller compressor on the circuit. 2. Condenser fans are controlled as defined for normal operation. 3. Exhaust fan operates as defined for normal operation based on economizer position. 4. When Compressor 1 is energized with either C1, C2, or with both for 30 minutes continuously, C3 will be required to de-energize for 30 seconds. RT-SVX34U-EN 71 Startup Table 44. Test mode states for traditional VAV units with modulating hot gas reheat and modulating heat TEST STEP MODE FAN VFD COMMAND COMP COMP COMP HEAT ECON 1 2 3 OUTPUT PUMPOUT COOL VALVE REHEAT VALVE VAV BOX VFD 100% 1 SIGNAL OFF (10VDC) CLOSED OFF OFF OFF OFF 100% OFF 100% 0% ON 2 VFD SIGNAL OFF 0% (0 VDC) CLOSED OFF OFF OFF OFF 0% OFF 100% 0% ON 3 MIN VENT ON INCONTROL MIN OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF 100% 0% ON 4 ECON TEST OPEN ON INCONTROL OPEN OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF 100% 0% ON 5 COOL 1 ON INCONTROL MIN ON OFF OFF OFF INCONTROL 100% 0% ON 6 COOL 2 ON INCONTROL MIN ON ON OFF OFF INCONTROL 100% 0% ON 7 COOL 3 ON INCONTROL MIN ON ON ON OFF INCONTROL 100% 0% ON 8 REHEAT ON INCONTROL MIN ON ON ON OFF INCONTROL 50% 50% ON 9 HEAT 1 ON INCONTROL MIN OFF OFF OFF 50% OFF 100% 0% ON 10 HEAT 2 ON INCONTROL MIN OFF OFF OFF 100% OFF 100% 0% ON 11 RESET Notes: 2 and 3 stage standard efficiency units (excluding 40-50T Std Efficiency CV): 1. For Traditional VAV units, the VFD Command when "In-Control" will be controlled based on Supply Air Pressure Requirements. For SZ VAV units, the VFD Command will be at discrete points during Test Mode. 2. For 27.5-35T units, both compressors will be energized during the Cool 2 Step. For 40-50T units, only Compressor 2 will be energized during the Cool 2 Step. 3. The Reheat Pumpout relay will be energized any time the Reheat circuit is energized in active Cooling Mode. 4. For units with Statitrac installed, the Exhaust Damper will track the Economizer position during Service Test Mode and the Exhaust Fan will be energized once the Economizer rises above the Exhaust Enable Setpoint. 5. Heating will not be energized during Service Test until the 6 minute VAV Box ON timer has expired. Notes: 5 stage high efficiency units (including 40-50T Std Efficiency CV): 1. Compressor 1 is the smaller compressor on the circuit. 2. Condenser fans are controlled as defined for normal operation. 3. Exhaust fan operates as defined for normal operation based on economizer position. 4. When Compressor 1 is energized with either C1, C2, or with both for 30 minutes continuously, C3 will be required to de-energize for 30 seconds. 72 RT-SVX34U-EN Startup Table 45. Test mode states for CV units with modulating hot gas reheat and modulating heat TEST STEP MODE FAN COMP COMP COMP HEAT COOL REHEAT ECON 1 2 3 OUTPUT PUMPOUT VALVE VALVE VAV BOX 1 FAN ON ON MIN OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF 100% 0% ON 2 ECONOMIZER ON OPEN OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF 100% 0% ON 3 COOL 1 ON MIN ON OFF OFF OFF INCONTROL 100% 0% ON 4 COOL 2 ON MIN ON ON OFF OFF INCONTROL 100% 0% ON 5 COOL 3 ON MIN ON ON ON OFF INCONTROL 100% 0% ON 6 REHEAT ON MIN ON ON ON OFF INCONTROL 50% 50% ON 7 HEAT 1 ON MIN OFF OFF OFF 50% OFF 100% 0% ON 8 HEAT 2 ON MIN OFF OFF OFF 100% OFF 100% 0% ON 9 RESET Notes: 2 and 3 stage standard efficiency units (excluding 40-50T Std Efficiency CV): 1. For 27.5-35T units, both compressors will be energized during the Cool 2 Step. For 40-50T units, only Compressor 2 will be energized during the Cool 2 Step. 2. The Reheat Pumpout relay will be energized any time the Reheat circuit is energized in active Cooling Mode. 3. For units with Statitrac installed, the Exhaust Damper will track the Economizer position during Service Test Mode and the Exhaust Fan will be energized once the Economizer rises above the Exhaust Enable Setpoint. 4. Heating will not be energized during Service Test until the 6 minute VAV Box ON timer has expired. Notes: 5 stage high efficiency units (including 40-50T Std Efficiency CV): 1. Compressor 1 is the smaller compressor on the circuit. 2. Condenser fans are controlled as defined for normal operation. 3. Exhaust fan operates as defined for normal operation based on economizer position. 4. When Compressor 1 is energized with either C1, C2, or with both for 30 minutes continuously, C3 will be required to de-energize for 30 seconds. RT-SVX34U-EN 73 Startup Table 46. Test mode states for SZ VAV units with modulating hot gas reheat and modulating heat TEST STEP 1 MODE FAN ON FAN ON VFD COMMAND 45% (0 VDC) ECON MIN COMP COMP COMP HEAT 1 2 3 OUTPUT OFF OFF OFF 0% PUMPOUT OFF COOL VALVE 100% REHEAT VALVE 0% 2 ECONOMIZER ON 45% (0 VDC) OPEN OFF OFF OFF 80% (6.67 3 COOL 1 ON VDC) MIN ON OFF OFF 4 COOL 2 ON IN-CONTROL MIN ON ON OFF 5 COOL 3 ON IN-CONTROL MIN ON ON ON 73% (5.24 6 REHEAT ON VDC) MIN ON ON ON 0% OFF 100% 0% 0% INCONTROL 100% 0% 0% INCONTROL 100% 0% 0% INCONTROL 100% 0% 0% INCONTROL 50% 50% 100% (10 7 HEAT 1 ON VDC) MIN OFF OFF OFF 50% OFF 100% 0% 100% (10 8 HEAT 2 ON VDC) MIN OFF OFF OFF 100% OFF 100% 0% 9 RESET Notes: 2 and 3 stage standard efficiency units (excluding 40-50T Std Efficiency CV): 1. For Traditional VAV units, the VFD Command when "In-Control" will be controlled based on Supply Air Pressure Requirements. For SZ VAV units, the VFD Command will be at discrete points during Test Mode. 2. For 27.5-35T units, both compressors will be energized during the Cool 2 Step. For 40-50T units, only Compressor 2 will be energized during the Cool 2 Step. 3. The Reheat Pumpout relay will be energized any time the Reheat circuit is energized in active Cooling Mode. 4. For units with Statitrac installed, the Exhaust Damper will track the Economizer position during Service Test Mode and the Exhaust Fan will be energized once the Economizer rises above the Exhaust Enable Setpoint. Notes: 5 stage high efficiency units (including 40-50T Std Efficiency CV): 1. Compressor 1 is the smaller compressor on the circuit. 2. Condenser fans are controlled as defined for normal operation. 3. Exhaust fan operates as defined for normal operation based on economizer position. 4. When Compressor 1 is energized with either C1, C2, or with both for 30 minutes continuously, C3 will be required to de-energize for 30 seconds. Verifying Proper Fan Rotation WARNING Rotating Components! Failure to disconnect power before servicing could result in rotating components cutting and slashing technician which could result in death or serious injury. Disconnect all electric power, including remote disconnects before servicing. Follow proper lockout/tagout procedures to ensure the power can not be inadvertently energized. Using Table 41, p. 69 to Table 46, p. 74 as a reference, momentarily jump across the test terminals to start the Minimum Ventilation Test. The Exhaust Fan will start anytime the economizer damper position is equal to or greater than the exhaust fan setpoint. The economizer will drive to the minimum position setpoint, exhaust fans may start at random, and the supply fan will start. Once the supply fan has started, check for proper rotation. The direction of rotation is indicated by an arrow on the fan housing. If the fan is rotating backwards, open the main power disconnect switch upstream of the unit terminal block or the unit factory mounted disconnect switch. WARNING Hazardous Voltage! Failure to disconnect power before servicing could result in death or serious injury. Disconnect all electric power, including remote disconnects before servicing. Follow proper lockout/tagout procedures to ensure the power can not be inadvertently energized. Verify that no power is present with a voltmeter. Interchange any two of the field connected power wires at the unit terminal block or factory mounted disconnect switch. 74 RT-SVX34U-EN Startup Note: Interchanging "Load" side power wires at the supply fan contactor will only affect the Fan Rotation. Ensure that the voltage phase sequence at the main unit terminal block or the unit mounted disconnect switch is ABC as outlined in "Electrical Phasing," p. 66. Verifying Proper Air Flow (CFM) - CV or VFD's 1. All systems - Set the minimum position setting for the economizer to 0º using the setpoint potentiometer located on the Economizer Actuator in the return section with the supply fan "On" and rotating in the proper direction: CV applications - Measure the amperage at the supply fan contactor and compare it with the full load amp (FLA) rating stamped on the motor nameplate. VFD's - With the O/A dampers fully closed, read the amperage displayed on the VFD screen and compare it to the motor nameplate. Note: On VAV applications, the VFD will be under control of the discharge Static Pressure setpoint for the first six minutes of this test mode. Verify that the VFD output is at 60 Hz before measuring the fan motor amps. If the actual amperage exceeds the nameplate value, static pressure is less than design and air flow is too high. If the actual amperage is below the nameplate value, static pressure is greater than design and air flow is too low. 2. To determine the actual CFM (within + 5%), plot the fan's operating RPM and the theoretical BHP onto the appropriate Fan Performance Curve in Figure 50, p. 75 to Figure 53, p. 77. Theoretical BHP Formula: [(Actual Motor Amps)/ (Motor Nameplate Amps)] x 100 Where the two points intersect, read straight down to the CFM line. Use or Table 52, p. 82 to select a new fan drive if the CFM is not within specifications. Figure 50. Supply fan performance curves 27.5 - 35 ton -- 60Hz RT-SVX34U-EN 75 Startup Figure 51. Supply fan performance curves 40 and 50 ton -- 60Hz Static Presure(InWC) 50% WOCFM 60% WOCFM 70% W OCFM Figure 52. Supply fan performance -- 22.9-29.2 tons -- 50Hz 4.0 (996) 800 RPM Supply Fan Performance 3.5(872) 3.0(747) 700 RPM 2.5 (623) 2.0(498) 600 RPM 1.5(374) 500 RPM 1.0(249) 400 RPM 0.5(125) 15 HP 10 HP 7.5 HP 5 HP 3 HP OCFM W 80% WOCFM 90% 0.0 (0.0) 0 (0) 2000 (.94) 4000 (1.89) 6000 (2.83) 8000 (3.78) 10000 12000 14000 16000 18000 20000 22000 24000 26000 Volumetric Airflow Rate(CFM) (4.72) (5.66) (6.61) (7.55) (8.5) (9.44) (10.38) (11.33) (12.27) L/S in 1000's 76 RT-SVX34U-EN Figure 53. Supply fan performance -- 33.3 and 41.7 ton (IP) -- 50Hz 5 (1245) Static Presure(InWC) 40% WOCFM 50% WOCFM 4 (996) 3 (747) 2 (498) 1 (249) 800 RPM 750 RPM 700 RPM 650 RPM 600 RPM 550 RPM 500 RPM 450 RPM 400 RPM 330500RRPPMM WOCFM 60% 10 HP 7.5 HP 20 HP 15 HP WOCFM 70% 80% WOCFM 90% WOCFM 0 (0.0) 0 (0) 2000 (.94) 4000 (1.89) 6000 (2.83) 8000 (3.78) 10000 12000 14000 16000 18000 20000 22000 24000 26000 28000 Volumetric Airflow Rate(CFM) (4.72) (5.66) (6.61) (7.55) L/S in 1000's (8.5) (9.44) (10.38) (11.33) (12.27) (13.22) Startup RT-SVX34U-EN 77 Startup Table 47. TC*/YC*300600 MBH economizer (R/A) damper pressure drop 60Hz Unit Capacity Airflow (CFM) Pressure Drop (iwc) 8000 0.035 8500 0.038 9000 9500 10000 0.042 0.046 0.051 10500 0.056 11000 0.061 11500 0.067 12000 0.073 12500 9000 0.080 0.042 9500 0.046 10000 0.051 10500 0.056 30 11000 0.061 11500 0.067 12000 12500 13000 0.073 0.080 0.087 10000 0.051 10500 0.056 11000 0.061 11500 35 12000 12500 14000 0.067 0.073 0.095 0.103 14500 0.111 Table 47. TC*/YC*300600 MBH economizer (R/A) damper pressure drop 60Hz (continued) Unit Capacity Airflow (CFM) Pressure Drop (iwc) 12000 0.072 12500 0.075 13000 0.079 13500 0.083 14000 0.087 14500 0.092 40 15000 0.098 15500 0.104 16000 0.110 16500 0.117 17000 0.124 17500 0.132 18000 0.140 15000 0.098 15500 0.104 16000 0.110 16500 0.117 17000 0.124 50 17500 0.132 18000 18500 0.140 0.149 19000 0.159 19500 0.168 20000 0.179 Notes: 1. 2. Static pressure drops for the return air damper must be added to the system external static pressure as an accessory when using the fan performance tables and the fan curves to determine actual fan performance. Pressure drops are listed in inches of water column. 78 RT-SVX34U-EN Table 48. Supply air fan drive selections -- 60 Hz Nominal Tons 27.5 30 7.5 HP RPM Drive No. 550 A 600 B 650 C 550 600 650 10 HP RPM Drive No. 700 D 750(a) E 700 D 750 E 600 B 650 C 700 D 35 750 E 500 H 525 J 575 K 40 525 J 575 K 50 (a) For YC gas heat units only. (b) For TC/TE Cooling only and Electric Heat units only. Startup 15 HP RPM Drive No. 20 HP RPM Drive No. 750 E 790(b) F 800(a) G 750 E 790(b) F 800(a) G 625 L 675 M 725 N 625 L 675 M 675 M 725 N RT-SVX34U-EN 79 Startup Table 49. Component static pressure drops (in. W.G.) -- 60Hz Nom. CFM Tons Std Air 27.5 30 35 40 50 8000 9000 10000 11000 12000 9000 10000 11000 12000 13000 10500 11500 12500 13500 14500 12000 13000 14000 15000 16000 17000 15000 16000 17000 18000 19000 20000 Heating System Gas Heat Electric Heat Standard Efficiency ID Coil High Efficiency ID Coil Filters Throwaway MERV 8 High Eff MERV 14 High Eff Economizer Low 0.08 0.10 0.13 0.15 0.18 0.10 0.13 0.15 0.18 0.21 0.14 0.17 0.20 0.23 0.26 0.01 0.01 0.02 0.02 0.02 0.02 0.02 0.02 0.02 0.03 0.03 0.03 High 0.06 0.08 0.10 0.12 0.14 0.08 0.10 0.12 0.14 0.16 0.11 0.13 0.15 0.18 0.20 0.03 0.04 0.05 0.05 0.06 0.07 0.05 0.06 0.07 0.08 0.08 0.09 1 2 Ele- Ele- Dry ment ments 0.05 0.06 0.12 0.07 0.07 0.14 0.08 0.09 0.17 0.10 0.11 0.20 0.12 0.13 0.23 0.07 0.07 0.14 0.08 0.09 0.17 0.10 0.11 0.20 0.12 0.13 0.23 0.14 0.15 0.27 0.09 0.1 0.25 0.11 0.12 0.29 0.13 0.14 0.33 0.15 0.16 0.38 0.18 0.19 0.42 0.08 0.13 0.24 0.10 0.15 0.28 0.11 0.18 0.31 0.13 0.20 0.35 0.15 0.23 0.39 0.17 0.26 0.43 0.13 0.2 0.44 0.15 0.23 0.49 0.17 0.26 0.54 0.19 0.29 0.59 0.21 0.32 0.65 0.23 0.36 0.71 Wet 0.19 0.22 0.26 0.30 0.34 0.22 0.26 0.30 0.34 0.38 0.37 0.42 0.48 0.53 0.59 0.36 0.41 0.46 0.50 0.55 0.60 0.63 0.69 0.75 0.82 0.89 0.96 Dry 0.16 0.19 0.23 0.27 0.31 0.19 0.23 0.27 0.31 0.35 0.25 0.29 0.33 0.38 0.42 0.30 0.35 0.39 0.44 0.49 0.54 0.44 0.49 0.54 0.59 0.65 0.71 Wet 0.25 0.29 0.34 0.39 0.45 0.29 0.34 0.39 0.45 0.50 0.37 0.42 0.48 0.53 0.59 0.45 0.51 0.57 0.63 0.69 0.75 0.63 0.69 0.75 0.82 0.89 0.96 2" 0.08 0.09 0.10 0.12 0.13 0.09 0.10 0.12 0.14 0.15 0.11 0.13 0.14 0.15 0.17 0.10 0.12 0.13 0.14 0.15 0.17 0.14 0.15 0.17 0.18 0.19 0.20 2" 0.12 0.14 0.16 0.20 0.21 0.14 0.16 0.20 0.23 0.26 0.18 0.21 0.24 0.26 0.30 0.19 0.23 0.25 0.28 0.31 0.35 0.28 0.31 0.35 0.38 0.42 0.45 4" 0.11 0.13 0.15 0.17 0.20 0.13 0.15 0.17 0.21 0.23 0.16 0.19 0.21 0.23 0.27 0.17 0.20 0.22 0.24 0.27 0.30 0.24 0.27 0.30 0.33 0.35 0.38 4" 0.33 0.39 0.45 0.52 0.59 0.39 0.45 0.52 0.59 0.66 0.48 0.55 0.62 0.70 0.77 0.48 0.53 0.59 0.66 0.72 0.79 0.66 0.72 0.79 0.85 0.92 0.99 0.04 0.04 0.05 0.06 0.07 0.04 0.05 0.06 0.07 0.09 0.06 0.07 0.08 0.10 0.11 0.07 0.08 0.09 0.10 0.11 0.12 0.1 0.11 0.12 0.14 0.16 0.18 Hot Gas Reheat Coil 0.08 0.10 0.12 0.14 0.17 0.10 0.12 0.14 0.17 0.20 0.13 0.16 0.18 0.22 0.25 0.06 0.07 0.08 0.09 0.10 0.11 0.09 0.10 0.11 0.13 0.14 0.16 Note: Static pressure drops of accessory components must be added to external static pressure to enter fan selection tables. Table 50. Component static pressure drops in. W.G (I-P) -- 50Hz Nom. CFM Tons Std Air 23 (80) 25 (88) 29 (103) 6670 7500 8330 9170 10000 7500 8330 9170 10000 8750 9580 11200 12100 Heating System Gas Heat Electric Heat Standard Efficiency ID Coil High Efficiency ID Coil Filters Throwaway MERV 8 High Eff MERV 14 High Eff Economizer Low 0.07 0.08 0.10 0.13 0.15 0.08 0.10 0.13 0.15 0.11 0.14 0.19 0.22 High 0.05 0.07 0.08 0.10 0.12 0.07 0.08 0.10 0.12 0.09 0.11 0.15 0.17 1 2 Ele- Ele- Dry ment ments 0.04 0.05 0.09 0.06 0.06 0.11 0.07 0.08 0.13 0.08 0.09 0.15 0.10 0.11 0.17 0.06 0.06 0.11 0.07 0.08 0.13 0.08 0.09 0.15 0.10 0.11 0.17 0.08 0.08 0.18 0.09 0.10 0.21 0.13 0.14 0.28 0.15 0.16 0.31 Wet 0.14 0.17 0.20 0.23 0.26 0.17 0.20 0.23 0.26 0.28 0.32 0.41 0.46 Dry 0.12 0.14 0.17 0.20 0.23 0.14 0.17 0.20 0.23 0.18 0.21 0.28 0.31 Wet 0.19 0.23 0.26 0.30 0.34 0.23 0.26 0.30 0.34 0.28 0.32 0.41 0.46 2" 0.05 0.07 0.08 0.09 0.11 0.07 0.08 0.09 0.11 0.09 0.10 0.12 0.13 2" 0.08 0.11 0.13 0.15 0.18 0.11 0.13 0.15 0.18 0.15 0.17 0.21 0.22 4" 0.07 0.10 0.12 0.14 0.16 0.10 0.12 0.14 0.17 0.13 0.16 0.19 0.21 4" 0.20 0.24 0.28 0.32 0.37 0.24 0.28 0.32 0.37 0.30 0.34 0.43 0.48 0.331 0.040 0.049 0.059 0.070 0.04 0.049 0.059 0.070 0.054 0.065 0.077 0.091 Hot Gas Reheat Coil 0.05 0.07 0.08 0.10 0.12 0.07 0.08 0.10 0.12 0.09 0.11 0.15 0.17 80 RT-SVX34U-EN Startup Table 50. Component static pressure drops in. W.G (I-P) -- 50Hz (continued) Nom. CFM Tons Std Air 33 (118) 42 (146) 10000 10800 11700 12500 13300 14200 12500 13300 14200 15800 16700 Heating System Gas Heat Electric Heat Standard Efficiency ID Coil High Efficiency ID Coil Filters Throwaway MERV 8 High Eff MERV 14 High Eff Economizer Low 0.01 0.01 0.01 0.01 0.02 0.02 0.01 0.02 0.02 0.02 0.03 High 0.03 0.03 0.04 0.04 0.05 0.06 0.04 0.05 0.06 0.07 0.08 1 2 Ele- Ele- Dry ment ments 0.07 0.11 0.18 0.08 0.13 0.20 0.10 0.15 0.23 0.11 0.17 0.26 0.12 0.19 0.29 0.14 0.22 0.32 0.11 0.17 0.33 0.12 0.19 0.36 0.16 0.24 0.40 0.18 0.27 0.48 0.20 0.30 0.53 Wet 0.28 0.31 0.35 0.39 0.42 0.46 0.48 0.53 0.58 0.68 0.74 Dry 0.22 0.25 0.29 0.32 0.36 0.40 0.33 0.36 0.40 0.48 0.53 Wet 0.35 0.39 0.44 0.48 0.53 0.58 0.48 0.53 0.58 0.68 0.74 2" 0.11 0.12 0.13 0.14 0.15 0.17 0.14 0.15 0.17 0.19 0.20 2" 0.18 0.21 0.23 0.26 0.28 0.32 0.26 0.28 0.34 0.38 0.41 4" 0.16 0.18 0.20 0.23 0.25 0.28 0.23 0.25 0.29 0.34 0.36 4" 0.37 0.41 0.46 0.50 0.55 0.61 0.50 0.55 0.61 0.71 0.77 0.070 0.076 0.085 0.096 0.107 0.120 0.095 0.108 0.120 0.136 0.155 Hot Gas Reheat Coil 0.04 0.05 0.05 0.06 0.07 0.08 0.06 0.07 0.08 0.10 0.11 Note: Static pressure drops of accessory components must be added to external static pressure to enter fan performance tables. Table 51. Component static pressure drops Pa (SI) -- 50 Hz Nom. Std Tons L/s Std (kW) Air Heating System Gas Heat Electric Heat Standard Efficiency ID Coil Low High 1 2 Dry Element Elements Wet Throwaway Adder 3150 17 13 11 3540 21 16 14 80 (23) 3930 26 20 17 4320 31 24 21 4720 37 29 25 3540 21 16 14 3930 26 20 17 88 (25) 4320 31 24 21 5120 44 34 29 4130 29 22 19 4520 34 27 23 103 (29) 4920 41 32 27 5310 47 37 32 4720 2 7 18 5120 3 8 21 5510 3 10 24 118 (33) 5900 4 11 27 6290 4 12 31 6680 5 14 35 12 21 34 12 15 26 41 17 19 30 48 19 23 36 55 22 27 41 62 26 15 26 41 17 19 30 48 19 23 36 55 22 32 41 62 26 21 44 68 22 25 51 78 24 29 66 97 29 34 75 109 31 27 43 67 26 32 49 75 29 37 56 84 31 42 62 92 34 48 69 101 36 54 77 111 41 Filters MERV 8 High Eff MERV 14 High Eff Economizer 50mm 100mm 100mm 19 17 38 8 26 24 45 10 31 29 50 12 36 34 57 15 43 38 65 17 26 24 45 10 31 29 50 12 36 34 57 15 43 41 67 17 36 31 55 13 41 38 62 16 50 46 77 19 53 50 86 23 43 38 65 17 50 43 69 19 55 48 77 21 62 55 84 24 67 60 88 27 77 67 98 30 RT-SVX34U-EN 81 Startup Table 51. Component static pressure drops Pa (SI) -- 50 Hz (continued) Nom. Std Tons L/s Std (kW) Air Heating System Gas Heat Electric Heat Standard Efficiency ID Coil Low High 1 2 Dry Element Elements Wet Throwaway Adder 5900 4 11 27 42 78 115 34 6290 4 12 31 146 (42) 6680 5 14 35 48 86 126 36 54 96 139 41 7070 5 16 39 60 115 162 46 7470 6 18 44 67 126 176 48 Filters MERV 8 High Eff MERV 14 High Eff Economizer 50mm 100mm 100mm 62 55 84 24 67 60 88 27 82 72 100 30 91 82 112 34 98 86 124 39 Note: Static pressure drops of accessory components must be added to external static pressure to enter fan selection tables. Table 52. Supply air fan drive selections -- 50 Hz Nominal Tons (kW) 7.5 hp (5.6 kW) rpm Drive No 10 hp (7.5 kW) rpm Drive No 458 A -- -- 500 B -- -- 23 (80) 541 C -- -- 583 -- 583 D 625 -- 625(a) E 458 A -- -- 25 (88) 500 B 541 C -- -- -- -- 583 -- 583 D 625 -- 625 E 500 B -- -- 541 -- 541 C 29 (103) 583 -- 583 D 658 -- -- -- 664 -- -- -- 417 -- 417 H 437 -- 437 J 479 -- 479 K 33 (118) 521 -- -- -- 562 -- -- -- 604 -- -- -- 437 -- 437 J 479 -- 479 K 42 (146) 521 -- -- -- 562 -- -- -- 604 -- -- -- (a) For YC gas/electric only. (b) For TC and TE Cooling only and with electric Heat units only. 15 hp (10 kW) rpm Drive No -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- 658(b) F 664(a) G -- -- -- -- -- -- 521 L 562 M 604 N -- -- -- -- 521 L 562 M -- -- 20 hp (15 kW) rpm Drive No -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- 604 N 82 RT-SVX34U-EN Exhaust Fan Operation To start the optional power exhaust fans, use the economizer test procedures in Table 41, p. 69 - Table 46, p. 74 to drive the economizer dampers to the open position. The exhaust fans will start when the damper position is equal to or greater than the exhaust fan setpoint. If optional power exhaust is selected, an access door must be field-installed on the horizontal return ductwork to provide access to exhaust fan motors. The exhaust fan will start anytime the economizer damper position is equal to or greater than the exhaust fan setpoint. WARNING Rotating Components! Failure to disconnect power before servicing could result in rotating components cutting and slashing technician which could result in death or serious injury. Disconnect all electric power, including remote disconnects before servicing. Follow proper lockout/tagout procedures to ensure the power can not be inadvertently energized. Verify that the fans are operating properly and the CFM is within the job specifications. Refer to power exhaust fan performance tables beginning with Table 53, p. 83 for the exhaust fan performance characteristics. Available power adjustments: · The power exhaust fan(s) comes on based on the position of the of the exhaust fan setpoint potentiometer on the RTOM (Reliatel Options Module). The setpoint is factory set at 25%. The exhaust fan(s) will come on anytime the economizer damper position is equal to or greater than the active exhaust fan setpoint. · Physical damper blade stops limit the amount of exhaust airflow by limiting the maximum opening of the damper blades. These stops (sliding brackets secured with wing-nuts) are present under the rain hood on the non-modulating power exhaust option. There is one stop on each side of each damper. The practical range of blade position control is between 1.5" and 4.0" blade opening. The damper is wideopen at 4.0". The stops on each side of a damper must be in the same position, such that the damper blade connecting member contacts the stops at the same time. · The modulating power exhaust actuator tracks the position of the economizer damper actuator such that the power exhaust dampers proportionally follow or track the fresh air damper position. · When the Statitrac option is selected, the exhaust actuator will operate independently of the economizer in order to relieve positive building pressure. If a Space Pressure Transducer failure RT-SVX34U-EN Startup occurs, the unit will revert back to fresh air tracking control. · The proportional offset between the dampers is adjustable. With direct-drive ultra-low-leak exhaust options, actuator stroke can be adjusted as described in "Economizer (O/A) Dampers," p. 84. The stroke limit can be set between 33% and 100% of full stroke. Note: The barometric damper continues to function as a pressure relief damper up to the maximum stop position. To adjust the damper blade stops, refer to figure Figure 54, p. 84 to Figure 57, p. 84. If the fan speed needs to be changed from the current operating speed, refer to the unit wiring diagram and the XTB1 and XTB2 terminal strip located in the economizer section. Table 53. Power exhaust fan performance-- 27.5-35 Ton -- 60 Hz Power Exhaust Selection 50% (min) 100% (max) Return Duct Static (in. wc) Damper Blade Open Distance (in.) (min) (max) (min) (max) CFM 0.0 3812 6866 7624 13742 0.1 3497 5296 6995 10591 0.2 3190 4458 6325 9000 0.3 2884 3812 5768 7635 0.4 2621 3359 5241 6719 0.5 2342 2885 4683 5771 Table 54. Power exhaust fan performance -- 40-50 Ton -- 60 Hz Power Exhaust Selection 50% (min) 100% (max) Return Duct Static (in. wc) 0.0 0.1 0.2 0.3 0.4 0.5 Damper Blade Open Distance (in.) (min) (max) (min) (max) CFM 4854 8035 9708 16069 4575 7410 9151 14820 4262 6450 8552 13496 4011 3718 6027 5526 8021 7436 12054 11051 3467 5186 6933 10373 83 Startup Table 55. Power exhaust fan performance -- 22.9 29.2 Ton -- 50 Hz Power Exhaust Selection 50% (min) 100% (max) Return Duct Static (Pa) Damper Blade Open Distance (mm) (min) (max) (min) (max) L/s 0.0 1499 2701 2999 5405 24.9 1375 2083 2751 4166 49.8 1255 1753 2488 3540 74.7 99.6 1134 1031 1499 1321 2269 2061 3003 2643 124.5 921 1135 1842 2270 Table 56. Power exhaust fan performance -- 33.3 41.7 Ton -- 50 Hz Power Exhaust Selection 50% (min) 100% (max) Damper Blade Open Distance (mm) Return Duct Static (Pa) (min) (max) (min) L/s (max) 0.0 1909 3160 3818 6321 24.9 1800 2915 3599 5829 49.8 1676 2537 3364 5308 74.7 99.6 1577 1462 2371 2173 3155 2925 4741 4347 124.5 1364 2040 2727 4080 Figure 54. (Upflow) Exhaust damper actuator adjustment Figure 55. (Horizontal) Exhaust damper actuator adjustment Damper Actuator Adjustment Figure 56. (Upflow) Exhaust maximum damper position More Exhaust Less Exhaust Figure 57. (Horizontal) Exhaust maximum damper position Less Exhaust More Exhaust Damper Actuator Adjustment Economizer Damper Adjustment Economizer (O/A) Dampers Arbitrarily adjusting the outside air dampers to open fully when the return air dampers are fully closed can overload the supply fan motor or deliver higher CFM to the space than designed. This causes higher operating 84 RT-SVX34U-EN duct static pressures and over pressurization of the space when the unit is operating in the "economizer" mode. The purpose of adjusting the amount of O/A damper travel is to maintain a balance or equal pressure between the O/A dampers and the pressure drop of the return air system. For models with standard or low-leak economizers, the O/A and R/A damper linkage is attached to a plate with a series of holes that allows the installer or operator to modify the O/A damper travel to compensate for various RA duct losses. Figure 58, p. 85 illustrates the damper assembly and Table 57, p. 85 through Table 60, p. 86 list the various damper positions based on the air flow (CFM) and the return duct losses (static pressure) for Downflow and Horizontal units. To adjust the O/A damper for the correct pressure drop: 1. Measure the return duct static pressure. 2. Enter the calculated CFM from the previous section "Verifying Proper Airflow" Table 47, p. 78 to obtain the return air damper pressure drop. 3. Add the measured return duct static pressure and the return air damper pressure drop together to obtain the Total Return Static Pressure. Apply this calculation and the calculated CFM to the appropriate Table 57, p. 85 through Table 60, p. 86. 4. Set the drive rod swivel to the appropriate hole according to Table 57, p. 85 through Table 60, p. 86. The units are shipped using hole "A" with no reference to any specific operating condition. Figure 58. Economizer (O/A) damper assembly Table 57. 27.5 - 35 Ton downflow economizer (O/A) damper static pressure setup System Design CFM 8000 8500 9500 Return Air Duct Static + Return Air Damper Static (Inches of Water) 0.2- 0.4- 0.6- 0.8- 1.0- 1.2- 1.4- 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Drive Rod Position B E E E E E E B D E E E E E A C E E E E E RT-SVX34U-EN Startup Table 57. 27.5 - 35 Ton downflow economizer (O/A) damper static pressure setup (continued) System Design CFM 10000 10500 11000 11500 12000 12500 13000 Return Air Duct Static + Return Air Damper Static (Inches of Water) 0.2- 0.4- 0.6- 0.8- 1.0- 1.2- 1.4- 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Drive Rod Position A C D E E E E A C D E E E E A B D D E E E A B C D E E E A A C D E E E A A C D D E E A A B B C D E Table 58. 27.5 - 35 Ton horizontal economizer (O/A) damper static pressure setup System Design CFM 8000 8500 9000 9500 10000 11000 11500 12000 12500 13000 13500 14000 14500 Return Air Duct Static + Return Air Damper Static (Inches of Water) 0.2- 0.4- 0.6- 0.8- 1.0- 1.2- 1.4- 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Drive Rod Position A F G G G G G A F G G G G G A E G G G G G A E F G G G G A D E G G G G A D E F G G G A B E F G G G A A D F G G G A A D E F G G A A D E F G G A A C E F F G A A C D E F G A A B D E F F 85 Startup Table 59. 40 - 50 Ton downflow economizer (O/A) damper static pressure setup System Design CFM 12000 12500 13000 13500 14000 14500 15000 15500 16000 16500 17000 17500 18000 18500 19000 19500 20000 Return Air Duct Static + Return Air Damper Static (Inches of Water) 0.2- 0.4- 0.6- 0.8- 1.0- 1.2- 1.4- 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Drive Rod Position A A C D E E E A A C D D E E A A B C D E E A A B C D D E A A B C C D E A A B B C D D A A A B C D D A A A B C D D A A A B C C D A A A B B C D A A A B B C C A A A A B C C A A A A B C C A A A A B B C A A A A B B C A A A A B B B A A A A A B B Table 60. 40 - 50 Ton horizontal economizer (O/A) damper static pressure setup System Design CFM 12000 12500 13000 13500 14000 14500 15000 15500 16000 16500 17000 17500 Return Air Duct Static + Return Air Damper Static (Inches of Water) 0.2- 0.4- 0.6- 0.8- 1.0- 1.2- 1.4- 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Drive Rod Position A B E F G G G A B D E F G G A A D E F G G A A D E F G G A A C E F F G A A C D E F F A A B D E F F A A B D E E F A A A C D E F A A A C D E F A A A B D E E A A A B D E E 86 Table 60. 40 - 50 Ton horizontal economizer (O/A) damper static pressure setup (continued) System Design CFM 18000 18500 19000 19500 20000 Return Air Duct Static + Return Air Damper Static (Inches of Water) 0.2- 0.4- 0.6- 0.8- 1.0- 1.2- 1.4- 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Drive Rod Position A A A B C D E A A A A C D E A A A A B D E A A A A B C E A A A A B C D Models with Ultra-Low Leak Economizers The installer can adjust the stroke of the direct drive actuator on the O/A damper to compensate for various R/A duct losses. Figure 60, p. 87 and Figure 61, p. 87 illustrate the damper & actuator assembly and Table 61, p. 87 through Table 64, p. 88 list the various O/A actuator limit positions based on the air flow (CFM) and the return duct losses (static pressure) for Downflow and Horizontal units. The actuator stroke limit can be adjusted between 33% and 100% of full stroke. To adjust the O/A damper for the correct pressure drop: 1. Measure the return duct static pressure. 2. Enter the calculated CFM from the previous section "Verifying Proper Air Flow (CFM) - CV or VFD's," p. 75 to obtain the return air damper pressure drop. 3. Add the measured return duct static pressure and the return air damper pressure drop together to obtain the Total Return Static Pressure. Apply this calculation and the calculated CFM to the appropriate table. See Table 61, p. 87 through Table 64, p. 88. 4. To set the actuator stroke limit: a. Loosen the screw that secures the angle of rotation limiter on the actuator adjacent to the damper drive shaft clamp. b. Move the limiter to the desired % open position and, making sure the limiter teeth are engaged, retighten the screw. (See Figure 59, p. 87). 5. After setting the end stop, the actuator needs to be cycled through its auto-adapt feature to re-scale the control range. With 24 VAC power applied to the actuator, turn the control signal reversing switch forward and back again two times. Within a few seconds, the actuator will cycle itself to the new limiter position and then back to zero. This process may take up to 5 minutes. The actuator will then be set to respond to the 2-10 VDC control signal to cycle within the new range of rotation set by the limiter. Verify that the control signal reversing RT-SVX34U-EN switch is set back to its original default position - Y = 0 - same direction as spring return. (See Figure 62, p. 87). Figure 59. Actuator stroke limit adjustment Angle of Rotation Limiter Scale Shows % of Full Stroke 9 Startup Figure 62. Actuator auto-scaling feature details Control Reversing Switch Must Be Set to Match Spring Return Direction Philips screwdriver Figure 60. Actuator for OA damper - Downflow Actuator for Down ow OA Damper Figure 61. Actuator for OA damper - horizontal Actuator for Horizontal OA Damper RT-SVX34U-EN Table 61. 27.5 - 35 Ton downflow economizer (O/A) ultra-low leak economizer System Design CFM Return Air Duct Static + Return Air Damper Static (in WC) 0.2- 0.4- 0.6- 0.8- 1.0- 1.2- 1.4- 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 stroke limit setting % on OA damper actuator 8000 75 55 55 55 55 55 55 8500 75 60 55 55 55 55 55 9500 100 65 55 55 55 55 55 10000 100 65 60 55 55 55 55 10500 100 65 60 60 55 55 55 11000 100 75 65 60 55 55 55 11500 100 75 65 60 55 55 55 12000 100 100 65 60 55 55 55 12500 100 100 65 60 60 55 55 13000 100 100 75 75 65 60 55 Table 62. 27.5 - 35 Ton horizontal economizer (O/A) ultra-low-leak economizer System Design CFM Return Air Duct Static + Return Air Damper Static (in WC) 0.2- 0.4- 0.6- 0.8- 1.0- 1.2- 1.4- 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 stroke limit setting % on OA damper actuator 8000 100 45 40 40 40 40 40 8500 100 45 40 40 40 40 40 9000 100 50 40 40 40 40 40 9500 100 50 45 40 40 40 40 10000 100 60 50 40 40 40 40 11000 100 60 50 45 40 40 40 87 Startup Table 62. 27.5 - 35 Ton horizontal economizer (O/A) ultra-low-leak economizer (continued) System Design CFM 11500 12000 12500 13000 13500 14000 14500 Return Air Duct Static + Return Air Damper Static (in WC) 0.2- 0.4- 0.6- 0.8- 1.0- 1.2- 1.4- 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 stroke limit setting % on OA damper actuator 100 80 50 45 40 40 40 100 100 60 45 40 40 40 100 100 60 50 45 40 40 100 100 60 50 45 40 40 100 100 70 50 45 45 40 100 100 70 60 50 45 40 100 100 80 60 50 45 45 Table 63. 40 - 50 Ton downflow economizer (O/A) ultra-low-leak economizer System Design CFM Return Air Duct Static + Return Air Damper Static (in WC) 0.2- 0.4- 0.6- 0.8- 1.0- 1.2- 1.4- 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 stroke limit setting % on OA damper actuator 12000 100 100 65 60 55 55 55 12500 100 100 65 60 60 55 55 13000 100 100 75 65 60 55 55 13500 100 100 75 65 60 60 55 14000 100 100 75 65 65 60 55 14500 100 100 75 75 65 60 60 15000 100 100 100 75 65 60 60 15500 100 100 100 75 65 60 60 16000 100 100 100 75 65 65 60 16500 100 100 100 75 75 65 60 17000 100 100 100 75 75 65 65 17500 100 100 100 100 75 65 65 18000 100 100 100 100 75 65 65 18500 100 100 100 100 75 75 65 19000 100 100 100 100 75 75 65 19500 100 100 100 100 75 75 75 20000 100 100 100 100 100 75 75 Table 64. 40 - 50 Ton horizontal economizer (O/A) ultra-low-leak economizer System Design CFM Return Air Duct Static + Return Air Damper Static (in WC) 0.2- 0.4- 0.6- 0.8- 1.0- 1.2- 1.4- 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 stroke limit setting % on OA damper actuator 12000 100 80 50 45 40 40 40 12500 100 80 60 50 45 40 40 13000 100 100 60 50 45 40 40 13500 100 100 60 50 45 40 40 14000 100 100 70 50 45 45 40 14500 100 100 70 60 50 45 45 15000 100 100 80 60 50 45 45 15500 100 100 80 60 50 50 45 16000 100 100 100 70 60 50 45 16500 100 100 100 70 60 50 45 17000 100 100 100 80 60 50 50 17500 100 100 100 80 60 50 50 18000 100 100 100 80 70 60 50 18500 100 100 100 100 70 60 50 19000 100 100 100 100 80 60 50 19500 100 100 100 100 80 70 50 20000 100 100 100 100 80 70 60 Manual Outside Air Damper Units ordered with the 25% manual outside air option have two slidable dampers. By adjusting one or both, the desired amount of fresh air entering the system can be obtained. To adjust the outside air damper; 1. Turn the "System" selection switch to the "Off" position and the "Fan" selection switch (if applicable) to the "Auto" position. 2. Close the disconnect switch or circuit protector switch that provides the supply power to the unit's power terminal block or the unit factory mounted disconnect switch. 88 RT-SVX34U-EN Startup WARNING Live Electrical Components! Failure to follow all electrical safety precautions when exposed to live electrical components could result in death or serious injury. When it is necessary to work with live electrical components, have a qualified licensed electrician or other individual who has been properly trained in handling live electrical components perform these tasks. HIGH VOLTAGE IS PRESENT AT TERMINAL BLOCK HTB1 OR UNIT DISCONNECT SWITCH. 3. Remove the mist eliminator retainer bracket and the mist eliminators from the fresh air hood. 4. Remove the five (5) screws in the top and bottom of each fresh air damper located inside the hood area. 5. Using the Service Test guide in Table 41, p. 69 -- Table 46, p. 74, momentarily jump across the test terminals one time for constant volume applications, or three consecutive times for a variable air volume application, to start the Minimum Ventilation Test. 6. With the supply fan "On" and rotating in the proper direction, measure the return duct static pressure. 7. Using Table 65, p. 89, enter the desired amount of fresh air and the return air static pressure reading to obtain the proper damper opening dimension. 8. Loosen the adjustment screws on each side of the damper and slide it downward to the required opening. 9. Tighten the adjustment screws and re-install the mist eliminators and the mist eliminator retainer bracket. 10. Open the main power disconnect or the unit mounted disconnect switch to shut the unit off and to reset the RTRM. 11. Before closing the disconnect switch, ensure that the compressor discharge service valve(s) and suction service valve(s) are backseated. Table 65. Damper adjustment Damper Opening (in.) Damper #1 Damper #2 2 0 4 0 6 0 8 0 10 0 10 2 10 4 10 6 10 8 10 10 -0.20 430 780 1185 1530 1930 2295 2660 3010 3345 3690 -0.40 590 1080 1620 2110 2655 3165 3650 4150 4600 5125 Return Air Static Pressure - Inches w.c. -0.60 -0.80 -1.00 -1.20 725 840 950 1040 1330 1545 1730 1890 1990 2300 2575 2815 2600 3025 3390 3705 3270 3800 4250 4650 3910 4545 5095 5575 4510 5255 5905 6480 5130 5965 6690 7330 5680 6610 7410 8120 6350 7395 8295 9075 -1.40 1120 2035 3030 3985 5005 6010 6995 7900 8765 9775 -1.60 740 2170 3240 4240 5345 6415 7470 8440 9365 10420 Starting the Compressor Optional service valves must be fully opened before startup (suction and discharge line). NOTICE Compressor Failure! Failure to follow instruction below could result in compressor failure. Unit must be powered and crankcase heaters energized at least 8 hours BEFORE compressors are started. Starting 27.5 to 35 Ton Standard Efficiency Units Install a set of service gauges onto the suction and discharge service ports. To start the compressor test, close the main power disconnect switch or the unit mounted disconnect switch. Jump across the "Test terminals" on LTB1 or toggle the test switch three consecutive times if it is a constant volume application, or five times if it is a variable air volume application for two to three seconds per jump. Refer to Table 41, p. 69 - Table 46, p. 74 for the Cooling Test sequence. RT-SVX34U-EN 89 Startup Important: The compressors are protected from reverse rotation caused by improper sequencing of the customer supplied unit power wires by the unit phase monitor. It is imperative to verify correct sequencing of compressor power wires to prevent compressor failure from reverse rotation. Refer to the unit wiring schematic and/or wire color markers vs. the compressor terminal block color markers. Figure 63. Compressor terminal block color markers If a scroll compressor is rotating backwards, it will not pump and a loud rattling sound can be observed. If allowed to run backward for even a very short period of time, internal compressor damage may occur and compressor life may be reduced. If allowed to run backwards for an extended period of time, the compressor will likely fail or the motor windings will overheat and cause the motor winding thermostats to open. The opening of the motor winding thermostat will cause a "compressor trip" diagnostic and stop the compressor. Starting 40 to 50 Ton Standard Efficiency VAV Units Install a set of service gauges onto the suction and discharge service ports of each circuit. Follow the same procedures as above to start the first stage of compressor operation. After the compressor and the condenser fans have been operating for approximately 30 minutes, use Figure 72, p. 92 through Figure 97, p. 104 to determine the proper operating pressures for that circuit. Jump across the "Test Terminals" once again. This will allow the second stage compressors to start. The first stage compressor will shut off providing the 3 minute "On" time has elapsed. Note: When the second refrigerant circuit is requested to operate, both compressors of the 50 ton unit will run simultaneously. Verify that the compressors are rotating in the correct direction. Observe the operation of the compressor(s) and the system operating pressures. After compressors and condenser fans for the circuit have been operating for approximately 30 minutes, use Figure 72, p. 92 through 90 Figure 97, p. 104 to determine the proper operating pressures. For subcooling guidelines, refer to "Measuring Subcooling," p. 105. Units with Lead/Lag function disabled, jump across the "Test Terminals" once again. This will allow the third stage of cooling (number one circuit) to start providing the 3 minute "Off" time has been satisfied. Starting 27.5-50 Tons High Efficiency Units and 40-50 Tons Standard Efficiency Constant Volume Units Install a set of service gauges onto the suction and discharge service ports of the circuit. Jump across the "Test Terminals" on LTB1 or toggle the test switch three consecutive times if it is a constant volume application, or five times if it is a variable air volume application for two to three seconds per jump in order to get to cooling stage 1. Jump across the "Test Terminals" two more times for full load cooling. After the compressor and the condenser fans have been operating for approximately 30 minutes, use Figure 72, p. 92 through Figure 97, p. 104 to determine the proper operating pressures for that circuit. For subcooling guidelines, refer to "Measuring Subcooling," p. 105. Line Weights The standard and high efficiency units use line weights to dampen vibration. Do not remove, relocate, or overtorque these weights. The torque specification for the attaching bolts is 6 ft-lbs ± 1.0 ft-lb. The locations of the line weights are shown in the following figures. Figure 64. Line weight locations TE, YC, TC*330, 360, and 420 standard efficiency w/o service valves 0.75±0.25 0.75±0.25 RT-SVX34U-EN Figure 65. Line weight location TE, YC, TC*330, 360, and 420 standard efficiency with service valves 0.75±0.25 Startup Figure 69. Line weight locations TE, YC, TC*500 and 600 standard efficiency VAV with service valves 0.75±0.25 Figure 66. Line weight location TE, YC, TC*400 standard efficiency VAV w/o service valves 0.75±0.25 Figure 67. Line weight location TE, YC, TC*400 and 480 standard efficiency VAV with service valves and TE, YC, TC*480 with reheat valve with service valves 0.25±0.25 Figure 70. Line weight location TE, YC, TC*600 standard efficiency VAV reheat with service valves 0.25±0.25 Figure 71. Line weight location TE, YC, TC*275500 high efficiency and 400, 500 standard efficiency CV 0.25±0.25 Top View 0.25±0.25 Figure 68. Line weight locations TE, YC, TC*500 and 600 standard efficiency VAV w/o service valves 0.75±0.25 0.75±0.25 RT-SVX34U-EN Compressor Oil Once all of the compressors have been started, verify that the oil level is visible through the sight glass or above the sight glass. Use appropriate lighting (flash light) to verify the presence of oil. A tandem manifold set may have different oil heights, but still must be visible in the sight glass or above the sight glass. After shutting the compressors off, check the oil's appearance. Discoloration of the oil indicates that an abnormal condition has occurred. If the oil is dark, overheating may have occurred. Potential causes of overheating: compressor is operating at extremely high condensing temperatures; high superheat; a compressor mechanical failure; or, occurrence of a 91 Startup motor burnout. If the oil is black and contains metal flakes, a mechanical failure has occurred. This symptom is often accompanied by a high compressor amperage draw. Refer to the refrigeration system in the maintenance section for details on testing and replacing oil. Figure 72. 27.5 Ton operating pressure -- standard efficiency (60Hz) Figure 73. 30 Ton operating pressure -- standard efficiency (60 Hz) 92 RT-SVX34U-EN Figure 74. 35 Ton operating pressure -- standard efficiency (60 Hz) Startup Figure 75. 40 Ton dual circuit operating pressure, Cir #1 -- standard efficiency VAV (60 Hz) RT-SVX34U-EN 93 Startup Figure 76. 40 Ton dual circuit operating pressure Cir #2 -- standard efficiency VAV (60 Hz) Figure 77. 40 Ton operating pressure -- standard efficiency CV (60 Hz) 800 750 700 Discharge Pressure (Psig) 68/57F ID DB/WB 74/62F ID DB/WB 80/67F ID DB/WB 86/72F ID DB/WB 650 600 550 500 450 400 350 300 250 200 90 120F OD Ambient 115F OD Ambient 105F OD Ambient 95F OD Ambient 85F OD Ambient 75F OD Ambient 65F OD Ambient 55F OD Ambient 100 110 120 130 140 150 160 170 180 190 200 Suction Pressure (Psig) 94 RT-SVX34U-EN Figure 78. 50 Ton dual circuit operating pressure Cir #1 -- standard efficiency VAV (60 Hz) Startup Figure 79. 50 Ton dual circuit operating pressure Cir #2 -- standard efficiency VAV (60 Hz) RT-SVX34U-EN 95 Startup Figure 80. 27.5 Ton operating pressure -- high efficiency (60 Hz) Figure 81. 30 Ton operating pressure -- high efficiency (60 Hz) 96 RT-SVX34U-EN Figure 82. 35 Ton operating pressure -- high efficiency (60 Hz) Startup Figure 83. 40 Ton operating pressure -- high efficiency (60 Hz) RT-SVX34U-EN 97 Startup Figure 84. 50 Ton operating pressure -- high efficiency and standard efficiency CV (60 Hz) Figure 85. 22.9 Ton operating pressure -- standard efficiency (50 Hz) 98 RT-SVX34U-EN Figure 86. 25.4 Ton operating pressure -- standard efficiency (50 Hz) Startup Figure 87. 29.2 Ton operating pressures -- standard efficiency (50 Hz) RT-SVX34U-EN 99 Startup Figure 88. 33.3 Ton operating pressure -- standard efficiency CV (50 Hz) 800 750 700 Discharge Pressure (Psig) 68/57F ID DB/WB 74/62F ID DB/WB 80/67F ID DB/WB 86/72F ID DB/WB 650 600 550 500 450 400 350 300 250 200 90 120F OD Ambient 115F OD Ambient 105F OD Ambient 95F OD Ambient 85F OD Ambient 75F OD Ambient 65F OD Ambient 55F OD Ambient 100 110 120 130 140 150 160 170 180 190 200 Suction Pressure (Psig) Figure 89. 33.3 Ton dual circuit operating pressure, circuit #1 -- standard efficiency VAV (50 Hz) 100 RT-SVX34U-EN Figure 90. 33.3 Ton dual circuit operating pressure, circuit #2 -- standard efficiency VAV (50 Hz) Startup Figure 91. 41.7 Ton dual circuit operating pressure, circuit #1 -- standard efficiency VAV (50 Hz) RT-SVX34U-EN 101 Startup Figure 92. 41.7 Ton dual circuit operating pressure, circuit #2 -- standard efficiency VAV (50 Hz) Figure 93. 22.9 Ton operating pressure -- high efficiency (50 Hz) 102 RT-SVX34U-EN Figure 94. 25.4 Ton operating pressure -- high efficiency (50 Hz) Startup Figure 95. 29.2 Ton operating pressure -- high efficiency (50 Hz) RT-SVX34U-EN 103 Startup Figure 96. 33.3 Ton operating pressure -- high efficiency (50 Hz) Figure 97. 41.7 Ton operating pressure -- high efficiency and standard efficiency CV (50 Hz) Scroll Compressor Operational Noises Because the scroll compressor is designed to accommodate liquids (both oil and refrigerant) and solid particles without causing compressor damage, there are some characteristic sounds that differentiate it from those typically associated with a reciprocating compressor. These sounds (which are described 104 below) are characteristic, and do not affect the operation or reliability of the compressor. At Shutdown When a Scroll compressor shuts down, the gas within the scroll compressor expands and causes momentary reverse rotation until the discharge check valve closes. This results in a "flutter" type sound. RT-SVX34U-EN At Low Ambient Startup When the compressor starts up under low ambient conditions, the initial flow rate of the compressor is low due to the low condensing pressure. This causes a low differential across the thermal expansion valve that limits its capacity. Under these conditions, it is not unusual to hear the compressor rattle until the suction pressure climbs and the flow rate increases. During Normal Operation The scroll compressor emits a higher frequency tone (sound) than a reciprocating compressor. Compressor Crankcase Heaters Each compressor is equipped with a crankcase heater. When the compressor is "Off", the crankcase heater is energized. When the compressor is "On", the crankcase heater is de-energized. The proper operation of the crankcase heater is important to maintain an elevated compressor oil temperature during the "Off" cycle which reduces the potential for refrigerant to migrate into the compressor oil. If present during a compressor start, liquid refrigerant could damage compressor bearings due to reduced lubrication and eventually could cause compressor mechanical failures. Prior to the initial start or when power to the unit has been "Off" for an extended period, allow the crankcase heater to operate a minimum of 8 hours before starting the unit. Charging by Subcooling The unit is shipped with a complete refrigerant charge. However, if it becomes necessary to add refrigerant, it should be done so by adding charge to obtain an acceptable subcooling as described below. Refer to the maintenance section for proper refrigerant charging practices. The outdoor ambient temperature must be between 65° and 105° F and the relative humidity of the air entering the evaporator must be above 40 percent. When the temperatures are outside of these ranges, measuring the operating pressures can be meaningless. With the unit operating at "Full Circuit Capacity", acceptable subcooling ranges between 14° F to 22° F. Startup Measuring Subcooling WARNING R-410A Refrigerant under Higher Pressure than R-22! Failure to use proper equipment or components as described below, could result in equipment failing and possibly exploding, which could result in death, serious injury, or equipment damage. The units described in this manual use R-410A refrigerant which operates at higher pressures than R-22. Use ONLY R-410A rated service equipment or components with these units. For specific handling concerns with R-410A, please contact your local Trane representative. 1. Measure the liquid line pressure. Using a Refrigerant R-410A pressure/temperature chart, convert the pressure reading into the corresponding saturated temperature. 2. Measure the actual liquid line temperature. To ensure an accurate reading, clean the line thoroughly where the temperature sensor will be attached. After securing the sensor to the line, insulate the sensor and line to isolate it from the ambient air. Note: Glass thermometers do not have sufficient contact area to give an accurate reading. 3. Determine the system subcooling by subtracting the actual liquid line temperature (measured in step 2) from the saturated liquid temperature (converted in step 1). Gas Heat Units Open the main disconnect switch to shut the unit off and to reset the RTRM. Follow the Test Guide in Table 41, p. 69 to Table 46, p. 74 to start the unit in the heating mode. Jumping the "Test" terminals several times for two to three seconds will be required. When starting the unit for the first time or servicing the heaters, it is a good practice to start the heater with the main gas supply turned "Off". All heating units have either two stage or modulating heat capabilities. The "High" heat models contain two heat exchangers. In staged units, the heat exchangers operate simultaneously at either the low or high fire state. In modulating units, the modulating furnace fires first and adjusts to the needed capacity. If more heat is required than the modulating can provide, the second bank is fired at full fire and the modulating bank again adjusts to the heating load present. Check both ignition systems (if applicable) when going through the test procedures. RT-SVX34U-EN 105 Startup Once the ignition system and ignitors have been checked, open the main power disconnect switch to reset the RTRM. WARNING Hazardous Gases and Flammable Vapors! Failure to observe the following instructions could result in exposure to hazardous gases, fuel substances, or substances from incomplete combustion, which could result in death or serious injury. The state of California has determined that these substances may cause cancer, birth defects, or other reproductive harm. Improper installation, adjustment, alteration, service or use of this product could cause flammable mixtures or lead to excessive carbon monoxide. To avoid hazardous gases and flammable vapors follow proper installation and setup of this product and all warnings as provided in this manual. Turn the main gas supply to the unit "On" and check the gas pressure at the unit's gas train. Refer to "Installation Piping," p. 40 for the proper gas supply pressure and Figure 35, p. 41 for the location of the gas pressure taps. Close the main power disconnect switch and start the first stage heating Test again. Wait approximately 60 seconds for the heater to switch to low fire and check the manifold gas pressure. The manifold pressure for a two stage burner must be set at negative 0.2" w.c., +/0.05" w.c. The manifold pressure on a modulating burner should be set at a positive 0.5" w.c., +/-0.05" w. c. For modulating burners, expect to see the manifold pressure reading fluctuate while the burner is operating, but it should never read negative. WARNING Hot Surface! Failure to follow instructions below could result in severe burns. Surface temperatures may exceed 300°F (150°C). To avoid possible skin burns, stay clear of these surfaces. If possible, allow surfaces to cool before servicing. If servicing is necessary while surface temperatures are still elevated, you MUST put on all Personal Protective Equipment (PPE). Jump the test terminals momentarily to initiate second stage heat operation. The combustion blower motor should go to high speed. The second stage of heat in units with modulating gas will initiate the second heater bank to fire and both banks will operate at high fire. The manifold pressures of the two heater banks in a high heat modulating unit will be different. The pressure setting of the two stage burner will be a 106 negative 0.2" w.c., while the modulating burner will be a positive 0.05" w.c. Note: When firing a modulating unit for the first time, a "humming", or resonance sound may be heard. This is an operational sound made by the burner screen as it burns in. This sound is not a concern unless it persists longer than the first few times the unit is fired. Electric Heat Units Start the service test and check the amperage draw for each heating stage. Refer to the heater electrical data in Table 9, p. 29 (60 Hz) and Table 13, p. 31 (50 Hz) for the full load amps of a specific heater size. Once the operation of the heaters have been checked, open the main power disconnect switch or the unit mounted disconnect switch to shut the unit "Off" and to reset the RTRM. This concludes the setup and testing for the major components and controls within the unit. Follow the Test guide in Table 41, p. 69 - Table 46, p. 74 to verify that the optional VFD, economizer actuator, and minimum ventilation controls are functioning. Final Unit Checkout After completing all of the checkout and startup procedures outlined in the previous sections (i.e., operating the unit in each of its modes through all available stages of cooling and heating), perform these final checks before leaving the unit: Verify that the RTRM is in the normal operation mode. The LED located on the UCP module is "on" and glowing continuously. For Variable Air Volume Units For Constant Volume Units Verify that the "Mode" selection switch and the "Zone Temperature" setpoints are set and/or programmed at the sensor modules. For Variable Air Volume Units The RTAM has input setpoint potentiometers inside the control panel that are set at the factory which will allow the unit to operate and maintain system control. For specific job specifications; · Verify that the control input potentiometers are set according to the job specifications, i.e.; Outside air reset temperature - _______ Setpoint Reset amount °F. - _______ Setpoint Static pressure - _______ Setpoint Static pressure deadband - ________ Setpoint Discharge air temperature - _______Setpoint RT-SVX34U-EN Morning warm up temperature - _______ Setpoint Exhaust Fan - _______ Setpoint · Inspect the unit for misplaced tools, hardware and debris. · Verify that all unit exterior panels--including the control panel doors--are secured in place. For Single Zone Variable Air Volume Units Verify that the "Mode" selection switch and the "Zone Temperature" setpoints are set and/or programmed at the sensor modules. Startup The RTOM has input setpoint potentiometers inside the control panel that are set at the factory which will allow the unit to operate and maintain system control. For specific job specifications: · Verify that the control input potentiometers are set according to the job specifications: DA Heat -_____Setpoint DA Cool - Fan SPD - _____Setpoint EXH Fan - _____Setpoint · Inspect the unit for misplaced tools, hardware and debris. · Verify that all unit exterior panels--including the control panel doors--are secured in place. RT-SVX34U-EN 107 Sequence of Operation Mechanical Cooling Sequence Of Operation Time delays are built into the controls to increase reliability and performance by protecting the compressors and maximizing unit efficiency. Units Without an Economizer For 27.5 to 35 Ton units, when mechanical cooling is required, the RTRM energizes the Compressor Contactor (CC1) coil. When the CC1 contacts close, the Compressor CPR1 and Outdoor Fan Motor (ODM1) will start providing the 3 minute "off" time has elapsed. ODM2 and ODM3 cycles off/on based on the outdoor ambient temperature as measured by the Outdoor Air Sensor (OAS). CPR1 cycles off as required providing the 3 minute "on" time has elapsed. With CPR1 operating for a minimum of 3 minutes. If additional cooling is required, the RTRM energizes the 2nd compressor contactor (CC2) to bring on CPR2. While CPR1 continues to run, CPR2 cycles on/off as needed to meet the cooling requirements. For 40 Ton constant volume and variable air volume applications, once CPR1 has operated for a minimum of 3 minutes, and additional cooling is required, the RTRM cycles CPR1 off and energizes compressor contactor CC2. If additional cooling is required, the RTRM energizes compressor contactor (CC1) providing CPR1 has been off for a minimum of 3 minutes. This configuration will allow the dual circuit unit to operate with three steps of cooling if CPR1 is the lead compressor. For 50 Ton constant volume and variable air volume applications, once CPR1 has operated for a minimum of 3 minutes, and additional cooling is required, the RTRM cycles CPR1 off and energizes compressor contactors CC2 and CC3 simultaneously. If additional cooling is required, the RTRM energizes compressor contactor (CC1) providing CPR1 has been off for a minimum of 3 minutes. This configuration allow the dual circuit unit to operate with three steps of cooling if CPR1 is the lead compressor. If the indoor Fan selection switch is set to the "AUTO" position on constant volume applications, the RTRM energizes the Indoor Fan Contactor (F) coil approximately one second after energizing first stage compressor contactor (CC1). When the cooling cycle is complete and CC1 is de-energized, the RTRM keeps the Fan on for approximately 60 seconds to enhance unit efficiency. On variable air volume applications, the Fan operates continuously. 108 Economizer Operation Based on Dry Bulb Standard economizer dry bulb change over has five field selectable temperatures 55, 63, 67, 70, 73°F. Refer to Table 34, p. 59 for the proper potentiometer setting for each temperature selection. The economizer option allows cooling utilizing outdoor air when the temperature is below the specified dry bulb setpoint (73° ±2°F factory setting). The air is drawn into the unit through modulating dampers. The ECA modulates the economizer dampers from minimum position to full open based on a 1.5°F control point below either the space temperature setpoint for constant volume applications or 1.5°F around the supply air temperature setpoint for variable air volume applications. If the Mixed Supply Air Sensor (MAS) senses that supply air temperature is too cold, the dampers are held in their current position until the supply air temperature rises, or begin to modulate toward the minimum position if the supply air temperature continues to drop. The economizer control allows fully integrated cooling operation between the compressor(s) and the economizer when needed to satisfy the cooling setpoint. The RTRM will not allow a compressor to operate until the economizer dampers have been fully open for at least three minutes. The RTRM evaluates the rate of temperature change during this delay and will energize compressor(s) as needed to maintain temperatures within setpoint deadbands. If a power exhaust option is installed: · The power exhaust fan(s) comes on based on the position of the of the exhaust fan setpoint potentiometer on the RTOM (ReliaTel Options Module). The setpoint is factory set at 25%. The exhaust fan(s) will come on anytime the economizer damper position is equal to or greater than the exhaust fan setpoint. · The exhaust dampers have provisions to limit the amount of exhaust airflow by limiting the maximum opening of the damper blades. Barometric dampers have physical damper blade stops. These stops (sliding brackets secured with wing-nuts) are present under the rain hood on the non-modulating power exhaust option. There is one stop on each side of each damper. The practical range of blade position control is between 1.5" and 4.0" blade opening. The damper is wide-open at 4.0". The stops on each side of a damper must be in the same position, such that the damper blade connecting member contacts the stops at the same time. RT-SVX34U-EN · The modulating power exhaust actuator is a slave to the position of the economizer damper actuator such that the power exhaust dampers proportionally follow or track the fresh air damper position. The proportional offset between the dampers is adjustable. With barometric dampers the offset between the dampers is adjusted under the rain hood by hole position selection of the power exhaust actuator jack shaft on the damper linkage arm. With direct-drive ultra-low-leak exhaust options, the actuator stroke can be adjusted as described in "Economizer (O/A) Dampers," p. 84. The stroke limit can be set between 33% and 100% of full stroke. · When the StatitracTM option is selected, the Exhaust Blade Actuator will modulate independently to the economizer in order the relieve positive building pressure. If the space pressure transducer fails, the unit will revert back to fresh air tracking control. Economizer Operation Based on Reference Enthalpy Reference enthalpy is accomplished by using an Outdoor Humidity Sensor (OHS). The reference enthalpy is field selectable to one of five standard enthalpies. Refer to Table 34, p. 59 for the proper potentiometer setting for each enthalpy selection. If the outdoor air enthalpy is greater than the selected reference enthalpy, the economizer will not operate and the damper will not open past the minimum position setting. If the outdoor air enthalpy is less than the reference enthalpy, the dampers will modulate to maintain a 45° to 55°F minimum supply air temperature (constant volume or variable air volume applications). The ECA modulates the economizer dampers from minimum position to fully open based on a 1.5°F control point below either the space temperature setpoint for constant volume applications or 1.5° F below the discharge air temperature setpoint for variable air volume applications. With reference enthalpy control, reference enthalpy is not allowed if the outdoor temperature is below 32°F. Below 32°F, dry bulb economizer control is enabled. If communications between the Outdoor Humidity Sensor (OHS) and the Economizer Actuator Control (ECA) were to fail, the economizer will operate using the dry bulb parameters. RT-SVX34U-EN Current in mA Sequence of Operation Figure 98. Humidity vs. current input Humidity in %RH Economizer Operation Based on Comparative Enthalpy Comparative enthalpy is accomplished by using an outdoor humidity sensor (OHS), return humidity sensor (RHS), and the return air sensor (RAS). If the outdoor air enthalpy is greater than the return air enthalpy, the economizer will not operate and the damper will not open past the minimum position setting. The economizer will not operate at outdoor air temperatures above 75°F. If the outdoor air enthalpy is less than the return air enthalpy, the dampers will modulate to maintain a 45° to 55°F supply air temperature (constant volume or variable air volume applications). The ECA modulates the economizer dampers from minimum position to fully open based on a 1.5°F control point below either the space temperature setpoint for constant volume applications or 1.5°F around the supply air temperature setpoint for variable air volume applications. Refer to Figure 98, p. 109 for the Humidity versus Voltage Input Values. If either or both the return air humidity sensor (RHS) or the return air sensor (RAS) fails, the economizer will operate using the reference enthalpy setpoint perimeters. Economizers with Traq OA Damper Min Position Arbitration The Economizer Minimum Position will be controlled to maintain outdoor air CFM at a CFM control setpoint. Air Velocity will be measured across the Traq assembly utilizing a pressure transducer and will be calibrated (zeroed) against ambient pressure to correct for changing environmental conditions. The local Minimum OA CFM Setpoint input (or a calculated Min OA Flow Target Setpoint from the DCV description below) is used unless a valid BAS/Network Minimum OA CFM Setpoint has been selected and received in which case the BAS/Network value is used. The BAS/Network Minimum OA CFM Setpoint, if valid, 109 Sequence of Operation overrides the DCV CO2 reset calculation of Min OA Flow Target as well. The measured OA CFM value from the local sensor input will normally be used for this function. At this time OA CFM value from other sources is not supported. The algorithm used for this function will be P+I, with integration occurring only when outside the deadband. As long as the measured airflow is within the deadband, the control will be satisfied. When the OA CFM value is above the upper deadband limit the algorithm will decrease the Traq OA Min Damper Position Request allowing less fresh air into the space. When the OA CFM value is below the lower deadband limit the algorithm will increase the Traq OA Damper Min Position Request allowing more fresh air into the space. The OA CFM Deadband will be hard coded to +/250 CFM. Traq with Demand Controlled Ventilation (DCV) If Demand Controlled Ventilation is enabled, the Minimum OA CFM control point will be modified by high CO2 concentrations resetting the setpoint between Design and DCV Minimum OA CFM setpoint limits. The Traq airflow control functionality described above will then use the calculated Min OA Flow Target for determining the Traq OA Minimum Position Request. Modulating Hot Gas Reheat Sequence of Operation When the relative humidity in the controlled space (as measured by the sensor assigned to space humidity sensing) rises above the space humidity setpoint, compressors and the supply fan will energize to reduce the humidity in the space. All compressors on both refrigerant circuits will be staged up during active hot gas reheat. A Voyager Commercial Rooftop unit can contain one or two refrigerant circuits. Units with hot gas reheat will have one circuit with an outdoor condenser coil located in the outdoor section for normal head pressure control and a reheat coil located in the indoor air stream section for supply air reheat; both coils are for the same circuit. For 40-50 ton Voyager Commercial units the reheat circuit is circuit# 2. For 27.5-35 ton Voyager Commercial units there is only one circuit. During hot gas reheat mode, the CLV and RHP will modulate which will allow refrigerant to flow through both the condenser coil and the reheat coil. The RHP will be de-energized when in hot gas reheat mode. During hot gas reheat mode, the Supply Air Temperature is controlled to the Supply Air Reheat Setpoint by controlling the reheat and cooling modulating valve position. The range for the Supply 110 Air Reheat Setpoint is 65°F to 80°F and the default is 70°F. The Supply Air Reheat Setpoint is adjusted by using a potentiometer on the RTOM. During cooling operation, the cooling valve (CLV) will be open 100% and the reheat valve (RHV) will be closed which will allow refrigerant to flow through the condenser coil and not the reheat coil. During cooling mode the reheat pump-out solenoid (RHP) will also be energized to allow refrigerant to be removed from the reheat coil. During cooling or hot gas reheat mode, to ensure proper oil distribution throughout the reheat and cooling condenser circuits, a purge is initiated by a hard coded purge interval timer. After the purge interval timer reaches 60 minutes, the unit performs a purge for a fixed 3-minute time period. During this state the reheat and cooling valve will be driven 50% and the reheat pump-out solenoid is energized. See Hot Gas Reheat Low Pressure Control section for the reheat low pressure control (RLP) function during active dehumidification. See Hot Gas Reheat Frost Protection section for the control scheme during active dehumidification. See the Condenser Fan / Compressor sequence section for Condenser fan staging during active dehumidification. Sensible Cooling or Heating Control Overrides Hot Gas Reheat Control For both multi-circuit and single circuit units, any sensible heating request will terminate hot gas reheat control. If heating is active at the time a call for hot gas reheat control is received the heating operation must complete and an additional 5 minutes from the time heat is terminated must elapse before hot gas reheat will be allowed. Note: Occupied VAV operation in cooling mode will consider a critical zone temperature and when the sensible cooling requirements of this zone are not being met, the unit will terminate hot gas reheat control. Note: Occupied CV and all unoccupied operation will terminate hot gas reheat if the sensible zone cooling requirements exceeds one-half the available cooling capacity of the unit. Gas Heat Sequence Of Operation When heating is required, the RTRM initiates the heating cycle through the ignition control module (IGN). The IGN normally open contacts close to start the combustion blower motor (CBM) on high speed. Next, the IGN control energizes the hot surface igniter (IP) for 45 seconds. After a preheat period, the gas valve (GV) is energized for approximately 7 seconds. If the burner lights, the gas valve remains energized. If the burner fails to ignite, the ignition module will RT-SVX34U-EN attempt two retries and then lock out if flame is not proven. The unit will attempt to ignite at 60 minute intervals until the heating call is removed. An IGN lockout due to flame loss can be reset by: · Open and close the main power disconnect switch. · Switch the MODE switch on the zone sensor to "Off" and then to the desired position (VAV units remove and reapply the mode input). · Allow the IGN to reset automatically after one hour. When ignition takes place, the hot surface igniter (IP) is de-energized and functions as the flame sensor. Two Stage--If, after 60 seconds, the unit requires 1st stage heating only, the IGN will change the combustion blower from high speed to low speed. If additional heating is required and first stage heat has been operating for a minimum of 10 seconds, the IGN inducer relay will change the combustion blower motor (CBM) to high speed, delivering second stage heat capacity. Modulating--Units with modulating heat will fire the modulating bank first at high fire for 60 seconds. The unit will then modulate the heater to the necessary rate. If the modulating heat bank cannot satisfy the zone needs alone, the second bank will come on and the modulating will find the appropriate operating point. Constant Volume (CV) Unit Fan Operation If the fan selection switch is in the "AUTO" position for constant volume units, the RTRM will delay starting the supply fan for 60 seconds to allow the heat exchanger to warm up. When the zone temperature rises above the heating setpoint, the IGN control module will terminate the heat cycle. The supply fan remains energized for an additional 90 seconds. Variable Air Volume (VAV) Unit Fan Operation (2 Stage and Modulating Gas Heat) During Unoccupied heating, Morning Warm up, and Daytime Warm up mode, the VFD must be at 100%. Therefore, before the unit can heat, the VHR relay must have been energized for at least 6 minutes to ensure that the VAV boxes have driven to maximum. For example, 6 minutes after a Daytime Warm up mode is initiated, the VFD output will go to 100% and then the heat cycle will begin. The VHR relay is energized during Unoccupied mode, Morning Warm up mode, and Daytime Warm up mode. Variable Air Volume (VAV) Unit Fan Operation (Modulating Gas Heat Only) During Changeover Heat (LTB5-1 shorted to LTB5-2), the unit will heat to the Supply Air Heating Setpoint +/- RT-SVX34U-EN Sequence of Operation 7ºF. The VFD will modulate to maintain the Static Pressure Setpoint. Ignition Control Module There is a green LED located on the ignition module. Any time the Ignition module is powered, the LED will be on to provide status of the ignition system. · Steady OFF - no power/ internal failure · Steady ON - no diagnostic, no call for heat · Slow flash rate ¾ second on, ¼ second off - normal call for heat Error Code Flashes · One flash - Communication loss between RTRM and IGN · Two flashes - System lockout; failed to detect or sustain flame (3 tries, lockout after 3rd try) · Three flashes - Not used · Four flashes - High limit switch TCO1, TCO2, or TCO3 open (auto reset) · Five flashes - Flame sensed and gas valve not energized; or flame sensed and no call for heat (auto reset) The pause between groups of flashes is approximately two seconds. High Temperature Limit Operation and Location All of the heater limit controls are automatic reset. The high limit cutouts (TCO1) and/or (TCO3) protect against abnormally high supply air temperature. The fan failure limit (TCO2) protects against abnormally high heat build up due to excessive high limit (TCO1) (TCO3) cycling if the indoor fan motor (IDM) fails. If TCO1, TCO2, or TCO3 open during a heating call, the heat will shut down and the supply fan will be forced to run. The heat will automatically restart should the TCO circuit re-close during an active heating call. While the TCO circuit is open, a heat fail diagnostic will be sent from the IGN to the RTRM. The TCO1 and TCO3 is located in the bottom right corner of the burner assemblies on both downflow and horizontal units. TCO2 is located on the IDM partition panel; below and to the right of the blower housing on downflow units. On horizontal units, TCO2 is located on the IDM partition panel above the blower housing. Electric Heat Sequence Of Operation Constant Volume (CV) When heat is required and the Fan selection switch is in the "AUTO" position for constant volume applications, the RTRM energizes the Supply Fan approximately one 111 Sequence of Operation second before energizing the first stage electric heat contactor (AH). A 10 seconds minimum "off" time delay must elapse before the first stage heater is activated. When the heating cycle is completed, the RTRM de-energizes the Fan and the heater contactor (AH) at the same time. The RTRM cycles the first stage of heat as required to maintain zone temperature. If the first stage cannot satisfy the heating requirement, the RTRM energizes the second stage electric heat contactors (BH) and (CH) providing first stage has been on for at least 10 seconds or the second stage has been off for at least 10 seconds. (CH contactor is used on 54KW and larger heaters.) The RTRM cycles the second stage electric heat as required to maintain the zone temperature. Variable Air Volume (VAV) During Unoccupied heating, Morning Warm up, or Daytime Warm up, the VHR relay will be energized for at least 6 minutes and the VFD output will go to 100%. The heaters will stage on and off to satisfy the zone temperature setpoint. Variable Air Volume Applications (Single Zone VAV) Sequence of Operation Occupied Cooling Operation For normal Cooling operation, available Cooling capacity will be staged or modulated in order to meet the calculated discharge air setpoint between the user selected upper and lower limits. If the current active cooling capacity is controlling the discharge air within the deadband no additional Cooling capacity change will be requested. As the Discharge Air Temperature rises above the deadband the control will request additional capacity as required (additional compressor operation or economizer). As the Discharge Air Temperature falls below the deadband the algorithm will request a reduction in active capacity. Economizer Cooling During normal Economizer Cooling, the fan speed will operate at its minimum. However, if the economizer is able to meet the demand alone, due to desirable ambient conditions, the supply fan speed will be allowed to increase above the minimum prior to utilizing mechanical cooling. Note that Economizer Enable/Disable decisions will be made based on the previous sections, however, the economizer control point will now be variable based on the zone cooling demand. 112 Economizer Enabled at Cooling Start Once the unit has a request for economizer cooling and the unit has met all Cool mode transition requirements, the Economizer will open beyond minimum position with the Supply Fan Speed at 45% in order to meet the calculated discharge air setpoint value. If the economizer at 100% alone cannot meet the active discharge air setpoint, the Supply Fan Speed will increase to 100% for 3 minutes. Once the 3 minute compressor inhibit delay has expired, compressors will be allowed to energize to meet the space demand. The supply fan speed output will continue to modulate in order to meet the zone cooling requirements. Once compressors are being utilized for additional cooling capacity, the economizer will be forced to 100% if enabled. As the cooling capacity begins to stage back (less cooling load) the economizer will remain at 100%, if enabled, until all compressors have de-energized. Economizer Enabled to Disabled If the economizer is enabled and the unit is actively cooling with the economizer, if the economizer becomes disabled the economizer will be closed to the active minimum position and compressors will be allowed to stage without delay if the minimum off timers have expired and there is a Cooling demand requesting compressor operation. During this transition, the fan will continue to modulate in order to meet the space demand. Economizer Disabled to Enabled If compressors are energized for Cooling and the economizer was disabled, but becomes enabled due to desirable ambient conditions, the economizer will be forced to 100% as on traditional VAV units. Compressor Cooling Compressor output control and protection schemes will function much like on non-SZ VAV units. Normal compressor HPC and LPC control will remain in effect as well as normal 3-minute minimum on, off, and interstage timers. Also, the condenser fans will be controlled as on non-SZ VAV units and compressor staging sequences will be as described in Table 23, p. 46 and Table 24, p. 47 based on unit tonnage configuration and lead/lag status. Cooling Sequence If the control determines that there is a need for compressor stages in order to meet the discharge air requirements, once supply fan proving has been made, the unit will begin to stage compressors accordingly. Note that a 5 second delay will be enforced between the command for supply fan output operation and the command for compressor output operation. This delay is enforced to ensure that the supply fan is energized and ramping up to operating speed prior to energizing compressors. RT-SVX34U-EN As the zone cooling demand continues to increase, if additional capacity is required, the supply fan output will be modulated above minimum speed in order to meet the zone requirements. Note: The supply fan speed will remain at the compressor stage's associated minimum value until the control requires additional capacity to meet the zone demand. As the cooling load in the zone decreases the control will reduce the speed of the fan down to minimum per compressor stage and control the compressor outputs accordingly. As the compressors begin to de-energize, the Supply Fan speed will fall back to the Cooling Stage's associated minimum fan speed but not below. As the load in the zone continues to drop, cooling capacity will be reduced in order to maintain the calculated discharge air setpoint. Cooling Stages Minimum Fan Speed As the unit begins to stage compressors to meet the cooling demand, the following minimum Supply Fan Speeds will be utilized for each corresponding Cooling Stage. Note that the Supply Fan Speed will be allowed to ramp up beyond the minimum speed in order to meet the zone cooling demand. 2-Stage Cooling Units (27.5-35T Units) The minimum fan speed for units with 2 stages of DX Cooling will be 45% of the unit's full airflow capacity. At Stage 1 of DX Cooling the Fan Speed will be at a minimum of 45% and at Stage 2 of DX Cooling the Fan Speed will be at a minimum of 67%. 3-Stage Cooling Units (40-50T Standard Efficiency VAV Units) The minimum fan speed for units with 3 stages of DX Cooling will be 45% of the unit's full airflow capacity. At Stage 1 of DX Cooling the Fan Speed will be at a minimum of 45% and at Stages 2 and 3 of DX Cooling the Fan Speed will be at a minimum of 67%. 5-Stage High Efficiency Cooling Units and 40-50T Standard Efficiency CV Units The minimum fan speed for units with 5 stages of DX Cooling will be 33% of the unit's full airflow capacity. At Stage 1 of DX Cooling the Fan Speed will be at a minimum of 33%. Add % for other stages 2-5. Occupied Heating Operation Occupied Heating operation on units configured with Single Zone VAV control will utilize two separate control methodologies based on heating configurations. For all "Staged" Heating types (Electric and Gas), the unit will utilize 100% full airflow during all active heating periods like traditional Constant Volume units. For Modulating Gas heat units, the unit will have the ability to control the discharge air temperature to RT-SVX34U-EN Sequence of Operation the calculated discharge air heating setpoint in order to maintain the Zone Temperature to the Zone Heating setpoint. Staged Heating Operation For units configured with Staged Heat once the control determines that there is an active heating capacity request, the unit will energize the Supply Fan and ramp up to full speed. The control methodology during Active Heating on units configured with Staged Heat types will be identical to traditional Constant Volume units; heating stages will be energized/de-energized to meet the Zone Heating demand. Note that all Electric and Gas Heat staging sequences will be identical to as on Constant Volume units. Modulating Heat Operation with SZVAV Heating Units configured with Modulating Gas Heat will utilize true Single Zone VAV control in the same manner as during Active Cooling. Heating Sequence Once the unit has met all Auto-Changeover requirements and the control determines that there is a space heating demand, the unit will transition into zone heating. Once the Discharge Air Temperature falls below the calculated discharge air temperature setpoint, the unit will initiate the Modulating Heat output request and control the supply fan at minimum speed. At this point, the Modulating Heat output will be controlled to maintain the discharge air temperature requirements and the supply fan speed will be controlled between 58%-100% to meet the zone heating requirements. As the heating load in the zone decreases the fan speed will decrease down to minimum (58%) and control the modulating heat output as necessary to meet the discharge air heating requirements. As the load in the zone continues to drop the fan speed will be maintained at this minimum airflow and the modulating heat output will be controlled accordingly. Note: The gas heat staging sequences will be the same on SZ VAV units as on traditional CV units. Unoccupied Cooling and Heating Operation For SZ VAV units, the unit will control Heating, Cool, and Hot Gas Reheat as during Occupied periods using the normal heating and cooling Single Zone VAV algorithms. In Unoccupied periods the unit will utilize setback setpoints, a 0% Minimum OA Damper position, and Auto fan mode operation as on normal Constant Volume units. 113 Sequence of Operation Modulating Hot Gas Reheat Operation Singe Zone VAV units support modulating hot gas reheat operation. Most functions will be identical to hot gas reheat control on CV and Traditional VAV units. Entering Hot Gas Reheat At startup a zone heating or cooling demand will prevent hot gas reheat operation as on a non-Single Zone VAV unit. At this point the unit will perform normal sensible cooling or heating control until the respective setpoint is satisfied. After startup, the unit will monitor the unit conditions to determine when to enter and leave hot gas reheat mode. As long as the unit is not actively heating or actively cooling with more than half the unit design mechanical cooling capacity for Standard Efficient units and have a call for stage 3 or below for High Efficient units (5 stage units), hot gas reheat mode will be allowed (also the unit has not been disabled due to the override limits described below). When hot gas reheat mode is entered the unit will: · Energize the Supply Fan, if not already ON, and ramp the Fan Speed output up to 80% airflow. · Stage up all compressors with ~2 seconds between stages. · Command the OA damper to minimum position. · The Supply Air Reheat setpoint (R130 located on the RTOM) will become the maximum discharge air control setpoint. · The reheat and cooling valves will be modulated to meet the calculated discharge air setpoint. Leaving Hot Gas Reheat On a call to leave hot gas reheat mode the unit will perform the following: · Mechanical cooling will stage back to 50% (Cool 1) of the available capacity then will be released to normal Single Zone VAV control to meet the space demand. · The economizer will be released to normal control. · The Supply Fan output will be released to meet the space load. · The cooling valve will be driven to 100% and the reheat valve will be driven to 0%. · The Reheat Pumpout relay will be energized if the reheat circuit is requested or de-energized if the reheat circuit de-energizes. Typical causes to leave hot gas reheat are: · Space humidity levels have fallen below the Active Occ/Unocc Dehumidification Setpoint -5% Dehumidification Hysteresis Offset, · The zone temperature has dropped too close to the Zone Heating Setpoint in any unit mode (Zone Temp. ? ZHSP + 0.5°F). 114 · The zone temperature rises above the Zone Cooling Setpoint +2°F in any unit mode. · Entering Evaporator Temperature falls too low or Froststat input becomes active. · Dehumidification/Reheat becomes disabled. Hot Gas Reheat Overrides Sensible cooling or heating control overrides hot gas reheat control. Any heating request will terminate hot gas reheat control. If heating is active at the time a call for hot gas reheat control is received the heating operation must complete and an additional 5 minutes from the time heat is terminated must elapse before hot gas reheat will be allowed. Hot gas reheat will also be disabled if any of the functional disables that apply to CV or traditional VAV have gone active. Purge Mode (Comfort and Dehumidification) Purge cycle operation will operate identically to Purge on non-Single Zone VAV Hot Gas Reheat units; if the Reheat Circuit operates in one mode (dehumidification or cooling) for a cumulative 60 minutes the unit will initiate a 3-minute Purge cycle with all compressors energized, the Cooling and Reheat Valves at 50%, and the Reheat Pumpout relay de-energized. During an active Purge Cycle the Supply Fan Speed will operate at the appropriate speed based on the active compressor step. If a dehumidification purge is initiated, the unit will run at 80%, if performing a cooling purge the supply fan will track based on the appropriate minimum speed for the associated number of compressors energized. After the Purge Cycle is complete, the Supply Fan will be released to normal control based on the Cooling/Dehumidification demand. Hot Gas Reheat - Humidistat Operation A humidistat input located on the Options module will be supported as on non-SZ VAV. Other Hot Gas Reheat Related Topics The following aspects of Single Zone VAV units configured with Modulating hot gas reheat will operate identically to non-Single Zone VAV units: · Outdoor Fan Control. · Low Pressure/High Pressure Cutout input handling. · Function Enable/Disable Details. Failure and Overriding Conditions Certain failure and overriding conditions require special handling of the Supply Fan Speed on units configured with Single Zone VAV. See below for a list of these conditions: · Supply Fan Proving Failure - If a Supply Fan Proving failure is detected the Supply Fan will be deenergized after 40s of run time and the Fan Speed output will go to 0 Vdc (0%). RT-SVX34U-EN · Ventilation Override Mode - If a VOM goes active in which the Supply Fan is commanded ON (Purge, Pressurize, etc.) the Supply Fan will be energized and the Fan Speed output will ramp to 100%. · Zone Temperature Sensor Failure - If the Active Zone Temperature input goes out of range, the unit will discontinue all Heating, Cooling, and Hot Gas Reheat operation. · Supply Air Temperature Sensor Failure - If the Supply Air Temperature input goes out of range, the unit will revert back to Full Airflow, Traditional CV control. The unit will call out a Supply Air Temperature Sensor Failure Alarm, the RTRM System LED will flash the 2-blink error code, and the Zone Sensor Heat (Modulating Heat Only) and Cool LEDs will flash. · Frostat Failure - If the unit has a Froststat Failure occur, all active Heating, Cooling, and Hot Gas Reheat will be de-energized immediately and the Supply Fan will ramp up to 100%. · Heat Failure (High Temp. Limit Trip) - If a unit configured with Gas Heat has a High Temp. Limit trip the Supply Fan will be requested to remain ON and the Fan Speed output will ramp to full speed. Sequence of Operation Low Pressure Control (LPC) Sequence of Operation (ReliaTel Control) When the LPC is opened for one (1) continuous second, the compressor for that circuit is turned off immediately. The compressor will not be allowed to restart for a minimum of three (3) minutes. If four consecutive open conditions occur during the first three minutes of operation, the compressor will be locked out, a diagnostic communicated to ICSTM if applicable, and a manual reset will be required to restart the compressor. High Pressure Control and Temperature Discharge Limit (ReliaTel Control) The Temperature Discharge Limit (TDL) is located in the Compressor Output circuit and is connected in series with the High Pressure Control (HPC). The RTRM will register an auto reset lockout if either the high pressure control switch or the temperature discharge limit opens during compressor operation. If the compressor output circuit is opened four consecutive times during compressor operation, the RTRM will generate a manual reset lockout. RT-SVX34U-EN 115 Maintenance Fan Belt Adjustment The supply fan belts must be inspected periodically to assure proper unit operation. Replacement is necessary if the belts appear frayed or worn. Units with dual belts require a matched set of belts to ensure equal belt length. When installing new belts, do not stretch them over the sheaves; instead, loosen the adjustable motor-mounting base. Once the new belts are installed, adjust the belt tension using a Browning or Gates tension gauge (or equivalent) illustrated in Figure 99, p. 116. Figure 99. Typical belt tension gauge Deflection = Belt Span (in.) 64 Deflection = Belt Span (mm) 152 Belt Span Small O-Ring Force Scale Large O-Ring Span Scale WARNING Hazardous Voltage w/Capacitors! Failure to disconnect power and discharge capacitors before servicing could result in death or serious injury. Disconnect all electric power, including remote disconnects and discharge all motor start/run capacitors before servicing. Follow proper lockout/tagout procedures to ensure the power cannot be inadvertently energized. For variable frequency drives or other energy storing components provided by Trane or others, refer to the appropriate manufacturer's literature for allowable waiting periods for discharge of capacitors. Verify with a CAT III or IV voltmeter rated per NFPA 70E that all capacitors have discharged. 1. To determine the appropriate belt deflection: a. Measure the center-to-center distance, in inches, between the fan sheave and the motor sheave. b. Divide the distance measured in Step 1a by 64; the resulting value represents the amount of belt deflection for the proper belt tension. 2. Set the large O-ring on the belt tension gauge at the deflection value determined in Step 1b. 3. Set the small O-ring at zero on the force scale of the gauge. 4. Place the large end of the gauge on the belt at the center of the belt span. Depress the gauge plunger until the large O-ring is even with the of the second belt or even with a straightedge placed across the sheaves. 5. Remove the tension gauge from the belt. Notice that the small O-ring now indicates a value other than zero on the force scale. This value represents the force (in pounds) required to deflect the belt(s) the proper distance when properly adjusted. 6. Compare the force scale reading in step 5 with the appropriate "force" value in Table 66, p. 117. If the force reading is outside of the listed range for the type of belts used, either readjust the belt tension or contact a qualified service representative. Note: The actual belt deflection force must not exceed the maximum value shown in Table 66, p. 117 . 7. Recheck the new belt's tension at least twice during the first 2 to 3 days of operation. Readjust the belt tension as necessary to correct for any stretching that may have occurred. Until the new belts are "run in", the belt tension will decrease rapidly as they stretch. 116 RT-SVX34U-EN Maintenance Table 66. Belt tension measurements and deflection forces Deflection Force (Lbs.) Belts Cross Section Small P.D Range Super Gripbelts Min. Max. Gripnotch Min. Max. Steel Cable Gripbelts Min. Max. 358 Gripbelts Min. Max. 3.0 -3.6 3 4 1/2 3 7/8 5 1/2 3 1/4 4 -- -- A 3.8 - 4.8 3 1/2 5 4 1/2 6 1/4 3 3/4 4 3/4 -- -- 5.0 - 7.0 4 5 1/2 5 6 7/8 4 1/4 5 1/4 -- -- 3.4 - 4.2 4 5 1/2 5 3/4 8 4 1/2 5 1/2 -- -- B 4.4 - 5.6 5 1/8 7 1/8 6 1/2 9 1/8 5 3/4 7 1/4 -- -- 5.8 - 8.8 6 3/8 8 3/4 7 3/8 10 1/8 7 8 3/4 -- -- 4.4 - 8.7 -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- 5V 7.1 - 10.9 -- -- -- -- -- -- 10 1/2 15 3/4 11.8 - 16.0 -- -- -- -- -- -- 13 19 1/2 358 Gripnotch Belts Min. Max. -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- 10 15 12 7/8 18 3/4 15 22 Table 67. Supply fan sheave and belt RPTons Motor M 27.5 and 30 550 7.5 hp 600 650 650 27.5 and 30 10 hp (f) 700 750 7.5 hp 600 650 10 hp 35 700 15 hp (g) 790 800 Fan Sheave(a) (b) (c) Browning SST BK190 X 1 7/16 BK190-17/16 BK160 X 1 7/16 BK160-17/16 BK160 X 1 7/16 BK160-17/16 BK190 X 1 7/16 BK190-17/16 BK160 X 1 7/16 BK160-17/16 BK160 X 1 7/16 BK160-17/16 BK160 X 1 7/16 BK160-17/16 BK190 X 1 7/16 BK190-17/16 BK160 X 1 7/16 BK160-17/16 BK160 X 1 7/16 BK160-17/16 BK160 X 1 7/16 BK160-17/16 Fan Bushing Browning SST Motor Sheave (d) Browning SST BK62H BK62H BK57H BK57H BK62H BK62H BK75H BK75H BK67H BK67H BK72H BK72H BK57H BK57H BK75H BK75H BK67H BK67H 1B5V68 1B68SDS 1B5V70 1B70SDS Motor Bushing (e) Browning SST H 1-3/8 H-1-3/8 H 1-3/8 H-1-3/8 H 1-3/8 H-1-3/8 H 1-3/8 H-1-3/8 H 1-3/8 H-1-3/8 H 1-3/8 H-1-3/8 H 1-3/8 H-1-3/8 H 1-3/8 H-1-3/8 H 1-3/8 H-1-3/8 B 1 5/8 SDS 1 5/8 B 1 5/8 SDS 1 5/8 Belt BX108 Notched BX100 Notched BX103 Notched BX108 Notched BX103 Notched BX103 Notched BX100 Notched BX108 Notched BX103 Notched BX103 Notched BX103 Notched RT-SVX34U-EN 117 Maintenance Table 67. Supply fan sheave and belt (continued) RPTons Motor M Fan Sheave(a) (b) (c) Browning SST Fan Bushing Browning SST Motor Sheave (d) Browning SST Motor Bushing (e) Browning SST 500 2B5V124 2B124SK B 1 11/16 SK 1 11/16 2BK36H 2BK36H H 1-3/8 H-1-3/8 10 hp 525 2B5V124 2B124SK B 1 11/16 SK 1 11/16 2BK40H 2BK40H H 1-3/8 H-1-3/8 575 2B5V124 2B124SK B 1 11/16 SK 1 11/16 2BK45H 2BK45H H 1-3/8 H-1-3/8 40 625 2B5V124 2B124SK B 1 11/16 SK 1 11/16 2B5V42 2B42SH P1 1-5/8 SH 1 5/8 15 hp 675 2B5V136 2B136SK B 1 11/16 SK 1 11/16 2B5V50 2B50SDS B 1 5/8 SDS 1 5/8 725 2B5V136 2B136SK B 1 11/16 SK 1 11/16 2B5V54 2B54SDS B 1 5/8 SDS 1 5/8 525 2B5V124 10 hp 575 2B5V124 2B124SK B 1 11/16 SK 1 11/16 2BK40H 2BK40H 2B124SK B 1 11/16 SK 1 11/16 2BK45H 2BK45H H 1-3/8 H 1-3/8 H-1-3/8 H-1-3/8 50 625 2B5V124 2B124SK B 1 11/16 SK 1 11/16 2B5V42 2B42SH P1 1-5/8 SH 1 5/8 15 hp 675 2B5V136 2B136SK B 1 11/16 SK 1 11/16 2B5V50 2B50SDS B 1 5/8 SDS 1 5/8 20 hp 725 2B5V136 2B136SK B 1 11/16 SK 1 11/16 2B5V54 2B54SDS B 1 5/8 (a) Browning BK160 X 1 7/16 and SST BK160-1-7/16 sheaves are interchangeable. (b) Browning BK190 X 1 7/16 and SST BK190-1-7/16 sheaves are interchangeable. (c) All other sheaves & bushings are interchangeable only in sheave/bushing combination sets. Sets do not mix vendors. (d) Browning and SST sheaves with identical numbers are interchangeable and can be used with each other's bushings. (e) Browning H 1-3/8 and SST H-1-3/8 bushings are interchangeable and can be used with each other's sheaves. (f) For YC gas/electric only. (g) For TC and TE Cooling only and with electric heat units only. SDS 1 5/8 Belt BX95 Notched BX95 Notched BX95 Notched BX95 Notched BX97 Notched BX97 Notched BX95 Notched BX95 Notched BX95 Notched BX97 Notched BX97 Notched Monthly Maintenance WARNING Hazardous Voltage w/Capacitors! Failure to disconnect power and discharge capacitors before servicing could result in death or serious injury. Disconnect all electric power, including remote disconnects and discharge all motor start/run capacitors before servicing. Follow proper lockout/tagout procedures to ensure the power cannot be inadvertently energized. For variable frequency drives or other energy storing components provided by Trane or others, refer to the appropriate manufacturer's literature for allowable waiting periods for discharge of capacitors. Verify with a CAT III or IV voltmeter rated per NFPA 70E that all capacitors have discharged. Filters Inspect the return air filters. Clean or replace them if necessary. Refer to the table below for filter information. Table 68. Filters Unit Model Quantity Filter Dimension (inches)(a) TC, TE, YC*330 - 420 16 15½ X 19½ X 2 or 4* TC, TE, YC*480 & 600 17 15½ X 19½ X 2 or 4* (a) Filter dimensions are actual. Nominal filter size is 16 x 20. Condensate Overflow Switch During maintenance, the switch float (black ring) must be checked to ensure free movement up and down. Before completing the following checks, turn the unit OFF and lock the main power disconnect switch open. 118 RT-SVX34U-EN Cooling Season WARNING Hazardous Voltage! Failure to disconnect power before servicing could result in death or serious injury. Disconnect all electric power, including remote disconnects before servicing. Follow proper lockout/tagout procedures to ensure the power can not be inadvertently energized. Verify that no power is present with a voltmeter. Check the unit's drain pans and condensate piping to ensure that there are no blockages. Inspect the evaporator and condenser coils for dirt, bent fins, etc. If the coils appear dirty, clean them according to the instructions described in "Coil Cleaning" later in this section. Inspect the F/A-R/A damper hinges and pins to ensure that all moving parts are securely mounted. Keep the blades clean as necessary. WARNING Rotating Components! Failure to disconnect power before servicing could result in rotating components cutting and slashing technician which could result in death or serious injury. During installation, testing, servicing and troubleshooting of this product it may be necessary to work with live and exposed rotating components. Have a qualified or licensed service individual who has been properly trained in handling exposed rotating components, perform these tasks. Manually rotate the condenser fans to ensure free movement and check motor bearings for wear. Verify that all of the fan mounting hardware is tight. Verify that all damper linkages move freely; lubricate with white grease, if necessary. Check supply fan motor bearings; repair or replace the motor as necessary. Check the fan shaft bearings for wear. Replace the bearings as necessary. Note: These bearings are considered permanently lubricated for normal operation. For severe dirty applications, if relubrication becomes necessary, use a lithium based grease. See Table 69, p. 120 for recommended greases. Important: The bearings are manufactured using a special synthetic lithium-based grease designed for long life and minimum relube intervals. Over lubrication can be just as harmful as not enough. RT-SVX34U-EN Maintenance Use a hand grease gun to lubricate these bearings; add grease until a light bead appears all around the seal. Do not over lubricate! After greasing the bearings, check the setscrews to ensure that the shaft is held securely. Make sure that all bearing braces are tight. Check the supply fan belt(s). If the belts are frayed or worn, replace them. Refer to the "Fan Belt Adjustment," p. 116 for belt replacement and adjustments. Check the condition of the gasket around the control panel doors. These gaskets must fit correctly and be in good condition to prevent water leakage. Verify that all wire terminal connections are tight. Remove any corrosion present on the exterior surfaces of the unit and repaint these areas. Generally inspect the unit for unusual conditions (e. g., loose access panels, leaking piping connections, etc.) Make sure that all retaining screws are reinstalled in the unit access panels once these checks are complete. With the unit running, check and record the following: ambient temperature compressor oil level (each circuit) compressor suction and discharge pressures (each circuit) superheat and subcooling (each circuit) Record this data on an "operator's maintenance log" like the one shown in Table 70, p. 122. If the operating pressures indicate a refrigerant shortage, measure the system superheat and system subcooling. For guidelines, refer to "Charging by Subcooling," p. 105. Important: Do not release refrigerant to the atmosphere! If adding or removing refrigerant is required, the service technician must comply with all federal, state and local laws. Refer to general service bulletin MSCU-SB-1 (latest edition). Heating Season WARNING Hazardous Voltage! Failure to disconnect power before servicing could result in death or serious injury. Disconnect all electric power, including remote disconnects before servicing. Follow proper lockout/tagout procedures to ensure the power can not be inadvertently energized. Verify that no power is present with a voltmeter. 119 Maintenance Before completing the following checks, turn the unit OFF and lock the main power disconnect switch open. Inspect the unit air filters. If necessary, clean or replace them. Check supply fan motor bearings; repair or replace the motor as necessary. Check the fan shaft bearings for wear. Replace the bearings as necessary. Note: These bearing are considered permanently lubricated for normal operation. For severe dirty applications, if relubrication becomes necessary, use a lithium based grease. See Table 69, p. 120 for recommended greases. Important: The bearings are manufactured using a special synthetic lithium-based grease designed for long life and minimum relube intervals. Over lubrication can be just as harmful as not enough. Use a hand grease gun to lubricate these bearings; add grease until a light bead appears all around the seal. Do not over lubricate! After greasing the bearings, check the setscrews to ensure that the shaft is held securely. Make sure that all bearing braces are tight. Inspect both the main unit control panel and heat section control box for loose electrical components and terminal connections, as well as damaged wire insulation. Make any necessary repairs. Gas units only - Check the heat exchanger(s) for any corrosion, cracks, or holes. Check the combustion air blower for dirt or blockage from animals or insects. Clean as necessary. Note: Typically, it is not necessary to clean the gas furnace. However, if cleaning does become necessary, remove the burner plate from the front of the heat exchanger to access the drum. Be sure to replace the existing gaskets with new ones before reinstalling the burner. Open the main gas valve and apply power to the unit heating section; then initiate a "Heat" test using the startup procedure described in "Gas Heat Units," p. 105. WARNING Hazardous Gases and Flammable Vapors! Failure to observe the following instructions could result in exposure to hazardous gases, fuel substances, or substances from incomplete combustion, which could result in death or serious injury. The state of California has determined that these substances may cause cancer, birth defects, or other reproductive harm. Improper installation, adjustment, alteration, service or use of this product could cause flammable mixtures or lead to excessive carbon monoxide. To avoid hazardous gases and flammable vapors follow proper installation and setup of this product and all warnings as provided in this manual. Verify that the ignition system operates properly. Table 69. Grease recommendations Recommended Grease Recommended Operating Range Exxon Unirex #2 Mobil 532 -20 F to 250 F Mobil SHC #220 Texaco Premium RB Coil Cleaning Regular coil maintenance, including annual cleaning enhances the unit's operating efficiency by minimizing the following: · Compressor head pressure and amperage draw · Water carryover · Fan brake horsepower · Static pressure losses At least once each year--or more often if the unit is located in a "dirty" environment--clean the evaporator, microchannel condenser, and reheat coils using the instructions outlined below. Be sure to follow these instructions as closely as possible to avoid damaging the coils. 120 RT-SVX34U-EN WARNING Hazardous Chemicals! Failure to follow this safety precaution could result in death or serious injury. Coil cleaning agents can be either acidic or highly alkaline and can burn severely if contact with skin or eyes occurs. Handle chemical carefully and avoid contact with skin. ALWAYS wear Personal Protective Equipment (PPE) including goggles or face shield, chemical resistant gloves, boots, apron or suit as required. For personal safety refer to the cleaning agent manufacturer's Materials Safety Data Sheet and follow all recommended safe handling practices. Refrigerant Coils To clean refrigerant coils, use a soft brush and a sprayer. Important: DO NOT use any detergents with microchannel condenser coils. Pressurized water or air ONLY. For evaporator and reheat coil cleaners, contact the local Trane Parts Center for appropriate detergents. 1. Remove enough panels from the unit to gain safe access to coils. a. For the 50 ton unit with the 3rd coil closest to the bulk-head, safe access can be gained by removal of the unit side panels. b. For the 40 ton and 50 ton units, access to the 2row microchannel condenser coils removal of the corner posts will be necessary. WARNING No Step Surface! Failure to follow instruction below could result in death or serious injury. Do not walk on the sheet metal drain pan. Walking on the drain pan could cause the supporting metal to collapse and result in the operator/technician falling. Note: Before attempting to enter the unit, bridge between the main supports. Bridging may consist of multiple 2 by 12 boards or sheet metal grating. 2. Straighten any bent coil fins with a fin comb. Maintenance 3. For accessible areas, remove loose dirt and debris from both sides of the coil. For dual row microchannel condenser coil applications, seek pressure coil wand extension through the local Trane Parts Center. 4. When cleaning evaporator and reheat coils, mix the detergent with water according to the manufacturer's instructions. If desired, heat the solution to 150° F maximum to improve its cleansing capability. Important: DO NOT use any detergents with microchannel coils. Pressurized water or air ONLY. 5. Pour the cleaning solution into the sprayer. If a high-pressure sprayer is used: a. The minimum nozzle spray angle is 15 degrees. b. Do not allow sprayer pressure to exceed 600 psi. c. Spray the solution perpendicular (at 90 degrees) to the coil face. d. For evaporator and reheat coils, maintain a minimum clearance of 6" between the sprayer nozzle and the coil. For microchannel condenser coils, optimum clearance between the sprayer nozzle and the microchannel coil is 1"-3". 6. Spray the leaving-airflow side of the coil first; then spray the opposite side of the coil. For evaporator and reheat coils, allow the cleaning solution to stand on the coil for five minutes. 7. Rinse both sides of the coil with cool, clean water. 8. Inspect both sides of the coil; if it still appears to be dirty, repeat Steps 6 and 7. 9. Reinstall all of the components and panels removed in Step 1; then restore power to the unit. 10. For evaporator and reheat coils, use a fin comb to straighten any coil fins which were inadvertently bent during the cleaning process. Microchannel Condenser Coil Repair and Replacement If microchannel condenser coil repair or replacement is required, refer to General Service Bulletin RT-SVB83*EN for further details. Final Process Record the unit data in the blanks provided. RT-SVX34U-EN 121 RT-SVX34U-EN 122 Table 70. Sample maintenance log Refrigerant Circuit #1 Date Current Ambient Temp F/ C Compr. Oil Level - ok - low - ok - low - ok - low - ok - low - ok - low - ok - low - ok - low - ok - low - ok - low - ok - low - ok - low - ok - low - ok - low - ok - low Suct. Press. Psig/ kPa Disch. Press Psig/ kPa Liquid Press Psig/ kPa Super- Sub- Compr. heat F/C cool F/C Oil Level - ok - low - ok - low - ok - low - ok - low - ok - low - ok - low - ok - low - ok - low - ok - low - ok - low - ok - low - ok - low - ok - low - ok - low Refrigerant Circuit #2 Suct. Press. Psig/ kPa Disch. Press Psig/ kPa Liquid Press Psig/ kPa Super- Sub- heat F/C cool F/C Maintenance Fall Restraint WARNING Falling Off Equipment! Failure to follow instructions below could result in death or serious injury. This unit is built with fall restraint slots located on unit top that MUST be used during servicing. These slots are to be used with fall restraint equipment that will not allow an individual to reach the unit edge. However such equipment will NOT prevent falling to the ground, as they are NOT designed to withstand the force of a falling individual. The fall restraint is located approximately 3 feet from the unit edge. Figure 100. Fall restraint Fall Restraint Maintenance WARNING Refrigerant under High Pressure! Failure to follow instructions below could result in an explosion which could result in death or serious injury or equipment damage. System contains refrigerant under high pressure. Recover refrigerant to relieve pressure before opening the system. See unit nameplate for refrigerant type. Do not use non-approved refrigerants, refrigerant substitutes, or refrigerant additives. Refrigerant Evacuation and Charging NOTICE Compressor Damage! Failure to follow instructions below result in permanent damage to the compressor. The unit is fully charged with R-410A refrigerant from the factory. However, if it becomes necessary to remove or recharge the system with refrigerant, it is important that the following actions are taken. Refrigeration System WARNING R-410A Refrigerant under Higher Pressure than R-22! Failure to use proper equipment or components as described below, could result in equipment failing and possibly exploding, which could result in death, serious injury, or equipment damage. The units described in this manual use R-410A refrigerant which operates at higher pressures than R-22. Use ONLY R-410A rated service equipment or components with these units. For specific handling concerns with R-410A, please contact your local Trane representative. RT-SVX34U-EN 123 Maintenance Important: Do Not release refrigerant to the atmosphere! If adding or removing refrigerant is required, the service technician must comply with all federal, state, and local laws. · To prevent cross contamination of refrigerants and oils, use only dedicated R-410A service equipment. · Disconnect unit power before evacuation and do not apply voltage to compressor while under vacuum. Failure to follow these instructions will result in compressor failure. · Due to the presence of POE oil, minimize system open time. Do not exceed 1 hour. · When recharging R-410A refrigerant, it should be charged in the liquid state. · The compressor should be off when the initial refrigerant recharge is performed. · Charging to the liquid line is required prior to starting the compressor to minimize the potential damage to the compressor due to refrigerant in the compressor oil sump at startup. · If suction line charging is needed to complete the charging process, only do so with the compressor operating. Do not charge liquid refrigerant into the suction line with the compressor off! This increases both the probability that the compressor will start with refrigerant in the compressor oil sump and the potential for compressor damage. · Allow the crankcase heater to operate a minimum of 8 hours before starting the unit. Charge Storage Due to the reduced capacity of the microchannel condenser coil compared to the round tube plate fin evaporator coil, pumping refrigerant into the condenser coil to service the refrigerant system is no longer an option. Compressor Oil If a motor burn out is suspected, use an acid test kit to check the condition of the oil. Test results will indicate an acid level has exceeded the limit if a burn out occurred. Oil test kits must be used for POE oil (OIL00079 for a quart container or OIL00080 for a gallon container) to determine whether the oil is acid. If a motor burn out has occurred, change the oil in both compressors in a tandem set. This will require that the oil equalizer tube be removed to suck the oil out of the 124 oil sump. A catch pan must be used to catch the oil when the compressor oil equalizer line is loosened. Note: Refrigerant oil is detrimental to some roofing materials. Care must be taken to protect the roof from oil leaks or spills. Charge the new oil into the Schrader valve on the shell of the compressor. Due to the moisture absorption properties of POE oil, do not use POE oil from a previously opened container. Also discard any excess oil from the container that is not used. Compressor model CSHD075-161 Oil amount 7.0 pts CSHD183 CSHN250 7.6 pts 14.2 pts Compressor Replacements Electrical Phasing If it becomes necessary to replace a compressor, it is very important to review and follow the Electrical Phasing procedure described in the startup procedure of this manual. If the compressors are allowed to run backward for even a very short period of time, internal compressor damage may occur and compressor life may be reduced. If allowed to run backwards for an extended period of time the motor windings can overheat and cause the motor winding thermostats to open. This will cause a "compressor trip" diagnostic and stop the compressor. If a scroll compressor is rotating backwards, it will not pump and a loud rattling sound can be observed. Check the electrical phasing at the compressor terminal box. If the phasing is correct, before condemning the compressor, interchange any two leads to check the internal motor phasing. Precision Suction Restrictor Tandem manifold compressors that have unequal capacity sizes use a precision suction restrictor to balance the oil levels in the compressors (see figure below). This restrictor is placed in the smaller capacity compressor. When replacing this compressor, it is imperative that the proper restrictor is selected from those provided with the replacement compressor. When the compressors are restarted, verify that correct oil levels are obtained with both compressors operating. RT-SVX34U-EN Figure 101. Precision suction restrictor Compressor Suction Suction Tube Suction Restrictor Table 71. Compressor restrictor location Model TC/TE/YC*275 and 330 TC/TE/YC*350 and 420 TC/TE/YC*500 and 600 TC/TE/YC*275 and 330 TC/TE/YC*305 and 360 TC/TE/YC*500 and 600 Efficiency Restrictor Location CPR 1 CPR2 CPR 3 Standard X Standard X Standard VAV X High X High X High and Std CV X Figure 102. Compressors 27.5, 30, 35 Tons Std Eff. 40 Tons Std Eff. VAV Only 50 Tons Std Eff. VAV Only 27.5-50 Tons High Eff. & 40-50 Tons Std Eff. CV VFD Programming Parameters (Supply) Units shipped with an optional variable frequency drive (VFD) are preset and run tested at the factory. If a problem with a VFD occurs, ensure that the programmed parameters listed in Table 72, p. 127 have been set before replacing the drive. Verify Parameters Verify parameter 1-23 is set to 60 Hz (or 50 Hz where RT-SVX34U-EN Maintenance applicable) and that parameter 0-06 is set to the correct supply voltage/frequency range. 1. To check parameter 1-23 press the Main Menu button twice (if TR150 drive) (press the Back button if the main menu does not display) 2. Scroll down to Load & Motor, press OK 3. Select 1-2, press OK 4. Press down until parameter 1-23 is displayed. Parameter 1-23 can then be modified by pressing OK and pressing the Up and Down buttons. 5. When the desired selection has been made, press OK . Should replacing the VFD become necessary, the replacement is not configured with all of Trane's operating parameters. The VFD must be programmed before attempting to operate the unit. To verify and/or program a VFD, use the following steps: 1. To modify parameters: a. Press Main Menu twice (if TR150 drive) (press Back if the main menu does not display) b. Use the Up and Down buttons to find the parameter menu group (first part of parameter number) c. Press OK d. Use the Up and Down buttons to select the correct parameter sub-group (first digit of second part of parameter number) e. Press OK f. Use the Up and Down buttons to select the specific parameter g. Press OK h. To move to a different digit within a parameter setting, use the Left and Right buttons (Highlighted area indicates digit selected for change) i. Use the Up and Down buttons to adjust the digit j. Press Cancel to disregard change, or press OK to accept change and enter the new setting 2. Repeat previous step for each menu selection setting in Table 72, p. 127. 3. To reset all programming parameters back to default: a. Go to parameter 14-22 Operation Mode b. Press OK c. Select Initialization d. Press OK e. Cut off the mains supply and wait until the display turns off. f. Reconnect the mains supply - the frequency converter is now reset. 125 Maintenance g. Ensure parameter 14-22 Operation Mode has reverted back to "Normal Operation". Notes: · Item 3 resets the drive to the default factory settings. The program parameters listed in Table 72, p. 127 will need to be verified or changed as described in Items 1 and 2. · Some of the parameters listed in the table are motor specific. Due to various motors and efficiencies available, use only the values stamped on the specific motor nameplate. Do not use the Unit nameplate values. · A backup copy of the current setup may be saved to the LCP before changing parameters or resetting the drive using parameter 0-50 LCP Copy (All to LCP to save all parameters to keypad and All from LCP to download all parameters into drive/replacement drive).. See LCP Copy in the VFD Operating Instructions for details. 4. Follow the start-up procedures for supply fan in the "Variable Air Volume System" section. 5. After verifying that the VFD(s) are operating properly, press the STOP key at the Human Interface Module to stop the unit operation. 6. Follow the applicable steps in the "Final Unit Checkout" section to return the unit to its normal operating mode. If a problem with a VFD occurs, ensure that the programmed parameters listed for supply VFD have been set before replacing the drive. 126 RT-SVX34U-EN Maintenance Table 72. Supply fan VFD programming parameters Menu ID 0-01 0-03 Operation/Display 0-06 (TR150 only) Name Language Regional Settings Grid Type FC English US North America Set to applicable unit power supply 200-240V/60Hz for 200 & 230V/60Hz units; 440-480V/ 60Hz for 460V/60Hz units; 525600V/60Hz for 575V/60Hz units; 380-440V/50Hz for 380 & 415V/ 50Hz supply.For IT Grid (no ground connections) or cornergrounded Delta power supply systems, select the applicable voltage/Hz and IT-Grid or Delta. 0-20 (TR200 only) Display Line 1.1 Small Analog Input 53 0-22 (TR200 only) Display Line 1.3 Small Input Power [hp] 0-40 1-03 1-20 (TR150)1-21 (TR200) [Hand on] Key on LCP Torque Characteristics Motor Power [HP] Disabled Variable Torque Per Motor Nameplate HP Load and Motor 1-22 1-23 1-24 1-25 Motor Voltage Motor Frequency Motor Current Motor Nominal Speed Per Motor Nameplate Voltage Per Motor Nameplate Per Motor Nameplate FLA Per Motor Nameplate Rated Speed Brakes Reference / Ramps Limits / Warnings Digital In/Out 1-39 1-73 1-90 2-00 2-01 2-04 3-03 3-16 3-17 3-41 3-42 4-12 4-14 4-18 4-19 5-12 5-13 5-40 Motor Poles Flying Start Motor Thermal Protection DC Hold/Preheat Current DC Brake Current DC Brake Cut In Speed [Hz] Maximum Reference Reference 2 Source Reference 3 Source Ramp 1 Ramp up Time Ramp 1 Ramp Down Time Motor Speed Low Limit [Hz] Motor Speed High Limit [Hz] Current Limit Max Output Frequency Terminal 27 Digital Input Terminal 29 Digital Input Function Relay 4 Enabled ETR Trip1 0 0 10 60 No function No function 30 30 35 60 100 60 Coast inverse No operation Relay 1 active No alarm, Relay 2 active Motor Running (Relay 1 [160], Relay 2 [5]) Unit hp V Hz A RPM % % Hz Hz s s Hz Hz % Hz RT-SVX34U-EN 127 Maintenance Table 72. Supply fan VFD programming parameters (continued) Menu Analog In/Out ID 6-14 6-15 14-01 Name Terminal 53 Low Ref./Feedb. Value Terminal 53 High Ref./Feedb. Value Switching Frequency FC 35 60 8.0 kHz (drive dependant, set to 5kHz if 8kHz not available) Special Function 14-11 (TR200 only) 14-12 14-20 1427 14-50 14-60 (TR200 only) Mains Voltage at Mains Fault Function at Mains Imbalance Reset Mode Action at Inverter Fault RFI Filter Function at Over Temperature 391V for 460V 60Hz unit, leave at default otherwise Derate Automatic reset x 5 Warning Off Derate 14-61 (TR200 only) Function at Inverter Overload Derate Note: For 50Hz units parameters 0-06 Grid Type (TR150s only) and 1-23 Motor Freq will need to be set accordingly. Unit 128 RT-SVX34U-EN Diagnostics The RTRM has the ability to provide the service personnel with some unit diagnostics and system status information. Before turning the main power disconnect switch "Off", follow the steps below to check the Unit Control. All diagnostics and system status information stored in the RTRM will be lost when the main power is turned "Off". WARNING Live Electrical Components! Failure to follow all electrical safety precautions when exposed to live electrical components could result in death or serious injury. When it is necessary to work with live electrical components, have a qualified licensed electrician or other individual who has been properly trained in handling live electrical components perform these tasks. HIGH VOLTAGE IS PRESENT AT TERMINAL BLOCK HTB1 OR UNIT DISCONNECT SWITCH. 1. Verify that the LED on the RTRM is on. If the LED is on or blinking (2 blinks every 2 seconds). If so, go to step 3. 2. If the LED is not on, verify that 24 Vac is present between RTRM J1-1 and J1-2. If 24 Vac is present, proceed to Step 3. If 24 Vac is not present, check the unit main power supply, check transformer (TNS1) and fuse. If the LED is not on or blinking yet 24Vac is present, the RTRM has failed and must be replaced. 3. If the LED is blinking, a diagnostic is present. If the LED is on, certain diagnostics may still be present. Utilizing "System Status/Diagnostics," p. 129, check the following system status: · Service status · Heating status · Cooling status 4. If any diagnostic is seen, refer to the appropriate Diagnostics section for CV, SZ VAV, or Traditional VAV units. Once the condition causing the diagnostic is cleared, proceed to the next step. 5. If no diagnostics are present, use one of the TEST mode procedures described in "Test Modes," p. 67 to start the unit. This procedure will allow you to check all of the RTRM outputs, and all of the external controls (relays, contactors, etc.) that the RTRM outputs energize, for each respective mode. Proceed to the next step. 6. Step the system through all of the available modes and verify operation of all outputs, controls, and modes. If a problem in operation is noted in any RT-SVX34U-EN mode, you may leave the system in that mode for up to one hour while troubleshooting. Refer to the sequence of operations for each mode to assist in verifying proper operation. Make the necessary repairs and proceed to the next step. 7. If no abnormal operating conditions appear in the test mode, exit the test mode by turning the power "Off" at the main power disconnect switch. 8. Refer to the individual component test procedures if other microelectronic components are suspect. System Status/Diagnostics System status and/or diagnostics can be observed at the ZSM, through ICS, or at the unit by using a DC voltmeter. The LED on the RTRM module does not indicate whether diagnostics are present or not. This RTRM LED is an indicator that the RTRM has power, and it pulses during the TEST mode. Figure 103. Terminal locations System Status / Diagnostics Checkout Procedure (DC Voltmeter Required) The method described below to determine unit status or to see if diagnostics are present assumes the Zone Sensor or NSB panel is not within sight or close by or is not being used. If a zone sensor is within sight however, DC readings need not be taken - just look at the LED or display and go to STEP 3. 1. Measure and record DC voltage from J6-6 (common) to each output: J6-7, J6-8, J6-9, and J610. 2. Using the data below, determine if each output is ON, OFF, or PULSING. All voltages are approximate - this is a sensitive circuit, so the type of voltmeter used, sensor connections etc. may all slightly affect the reading. ON = 30Vdc if no NSB or ZSM with LED's is connected, 25 Vdc if NSB panel (BAYSENS119*) is connected, 2Vdc if ZSM w/ LED's (BAYSENS110*, BAYSENS021*) is connected. OFF = 0.75 Vdc regardless of ZSM / NSB connection PULSING (DIAGNOSTIC PRESENT) = A distinct pulsing from 0.75 Vdc to 30 Vdc will be seen 129 Diagnostics depending on the type of meter used. Some meters may only pulse between 20 and 30 volts DC. 3. Refer to the data in "What Outputs Mean" section to determine course of action. What Outputs Mean: HEAT J6-7 · On = system is actively heating · Off = system is not actively heating · Pulsing = a diagnostic is present (see DIAGNOSTICS section). COOL J6-8 · On = system is actively cooling · Off = system is not actively cooling · Pulsing = a diagnostic is present (see DIAGNOSTICS section). SYSTEM J6-9 · On = RTRM has power · Off = RTRM does not have power or has failed · Pulsing = unit is in the TEST mode SERVICE J6-10 · On = dirty air filter indication · Off = normal operation · Pulsing = a diagnostic is present (see DIAGNOSTICS section). Note: Diagnostics for CV/SZ VAV or VAV units are listed separately. The same diagnostic may have a different meaning depending on whether the unit has VAV controls or CV/SZ VAV controls. Diagnostics (CV and SZ VAV Units Only) If only one diagnostic is present, refer to that diagnostic listing below. If more than one diagnostic is present, refer to combination diagnostics such as COOL + HEAT as appropriate. On a BAYSENS119*, the display will show HEAT FAIL or COOL FAIL or SERVICE (or an appropriate combination) if a diagnostic is present. If the unit is using a conventional thermostat, diagnostics are still available by using a DC voltmeter as described above. HEAT (YC only) · TCO1, TCO2 or TCO3 has opened. · IGN Module lockout (see gas heat section for troubleshooting). · Supply Air Temperature has Failed (SZ VAV Only with Modulating Heat). COOL · Zone temp input (RTRM J6-1) is open, shorted, or has failed after the RTRM sensed a valid input. 130 Note: Since CV units may use a conventional thermostat, the RTRM will not send a diagnostic if a zone sensor is not attached when power is applied to the unit. Also, the RTRM ignores a zone sensor if it is attached to a powered-up unit. (after a brief time-out). Therefore, always reset power after installing a mechanical ZSM to terminals RTRM J6-1 through J6-5. All units configured for SZ VAV will blink the Cool indicator if there is a Zone Temp. input failure because a valid Zone Temperature reading is required for all SZ VAV operation. · Cooling and heating setpoint inputs are both open, shorted, or failed, but the unit has a valid zone temp input. · Programmable ZSM (BAYSENS119*) has failed to communicate after successful communication has occurred. · CC1 or CC2 24 VAC control circuit has opened 3 times during a cooling mode. Check CC1, CC2 coils or any controls in series with the coils (winding thermostat, HPC, circuit breaker auxiliary contacts). · LPC 1 or LPC 2 has opened during the 3 minute minimum "on" time during 4 consecutive compressor starts. Check LPC 1 circuit by measuring voltage from RTRM J1-8 to chassis ground. Check LPC 2 circuit by measuring voltage from RTRM J3-2 to chassis ground. If 24 VAC is not present, the circuit is open. 24 VAC should be present at these terminals at all times. · Discharge air sensor (DTS) input is open, shorted, or has failed. SERVICE The supply fan proving switch (FFS) has failed to close within 40 seconds after the fan starts or has closed during fan operation. HEAT + COOL · The Emergency Stop input (LTB1-5 and LTB1-6) is open. Check this input at the RTRM by measuring voltage from RTRM J1-12 to chassis ground. 24 VAC should be present whenever the Emergency Stop input is closed. · Outdoor air sensor (OAS) input is open, shorted, or has failed. HEAT + COOL + SERVICE · Smoke Detector input active. · Supply Air Temperature Failure on units with modulating hot gas reheat · Entering Evaporator Temperature Failure on units with modulating hot gas reheat. · RTDM Communication Failure on units with modulating hot gas reheat. RT-SVX34U-EN Diagnostics (VAV only) If only one diagnostic is present, refer to that diagnostic. If more than one diagnostic is present, refer to combination diagnostics such as COOL + HEAT as appropriate. On a BAYSENS119*, the display will show HEAT FAIL or COOL FAIL or SERVICE (or an appropriate combination) if a diagnostic is present. HEAT (YC only) · TCO1, TCO2, or TCO3 has opened. · IGN Module lockout (see gas heat section for troubleshooting). COOL · Discharge air sensor (DTS) is open, shorted, or has failed. · Zone temp input (RTRM J6-1) is open, shorted, or failed during an unoccupied mode. If the unit has a default mode input (jumper from RTRM J6-2 to RTRM J6-4, a valid zone temp input is needed for unoccupied heating, MWU and DWU. · CC1 or CC2 24 VAC control circuit has opened 3 times during a cooling mode. Check CC1, CC2 coils or any controls in series with the coils (winding thermostat, HPC, circuit breaker auxiliary contacts). · LPC 1 or LPC 2 has opened during the 3 minute minimum "on" time during 4 consecutive compressor starts. Check LPC 1 circuit by measuring voltage from RTRM J1-8 to chassis ground. Check LPC 2 circuit by measuring voltage from RTRM J3-2 to chassis ground. If 24 VAC is not present, the circuit is open. 24 Vac should present at these terminals at all times. SERVICE The supply fan proving switch (FFS) has failed to open within 40 seconds after the fan starts or has closed during fan operation. COOL + SERVICE Static Pressure Transducer output voltage at RTAM J13 is less than 0.25Vdc. The transducer output is open, shorted, or the transducer is reading a negative supply air pressure. HEAT + COOL · The Emergency Stop input (TB1-5 and TB1-6) is open. Check this input at the RTRM by measuring voltage from RTRM J1-12 to chassis ground. 24 Vac should be present whenever the Emergency Stop input is closed. · Outdoor air sensor (OAS) input is open, shorted, or has failed. Diagnostics HEAT + COOL + SERVICE · Static Pressure High Duct Static Trip. The static pressure has exceeded 3.5" W.C. three consecutive times. · Smoke Detector input active. · Supply Air Temperature Failure on units with modulating hot gas reheat. · Entering Evaporator Temperature Failure on units with modulating hot gas reheat. · RTDM Communication Failure on units with modulating hot gas reheat. Resetting Cooling and Ignition Lockouts Cooling Failures and Ignition Lockouts are reset in an identical manner. Method 1 explains resetting the system from the space; Method 2 explains resetting the system at the unit. Note: Before resetting Cooling Failures and Ignition Lockouts check the Failure Status Diagnostics by the methods previously explained. Diagnostics will be lost when the power to the unit is disconnected. Method 1 To reset the system from the space, turn the "Mode" selection switch at the zone sensor to the "Off" position. After approximately 30 seconds, turn the "Mode" selection switch to the desired mode, i.e. Heat, Cool or Auto. Method 2 To reset the system at the unit, cycle the unit power by turning the disconnect switch "Off" and then "On". Lockouts can be cleared through the building management system. Refer to the building management system instructions for more information. Zone Temperature Sensor (ZSM) Service Indicator The ZSM SERVICE LED is used to indicate a clogged filter, an active Smoke Detector, or a Fan Failure trip. Clogged Filter Switch This LED will remain on 2 minutes after the Normally Open switch is closed. The LED will be turned off immediately after resetting the switch (to the Normally Open position), or any time that the IDM is turned off. If the switch remains closed, and the IDM is turned on, the SERVICE LED will be turned on again after the 2 (±1) minutes. This LED being turned on will have no other affect on unit operation. It is an indicator only. RT-SVX34U-EN 131 Diagnostics Smoke Detector Switch The LED will flash anytime that the N.O. Smoke Detector input is closed and will be reset anytime that the input is returned to its N.O. state. During an Active Smoke Detector trip the unit will be shut down. Fan Failure Switch The LED will flash 40 seconds after the fan is turned "On" if the Fan Proving Switch is not made. This LED will remain flashing until the unit is reset by means explained above. If the "Fan Failure" switch opens for at least 40 seconds during fan operation (indicating a fan failure) the unit will stop. Condensate Overflow Switch When the condensate overflow switch is closed, a drain pan overflow condition is indicated and it will shut unit operations down. RTRM Zone Sensor Module (ZSM) Tests Note: These procedures are not for programmable or digital models and are conducted with the Zone Sensor Module electrically removed from the system. Table 73. Zone Sensor Module (ZSM) terminal identification (constant volume only) Terminal # J6-1 J6-2 J6-3 J6-4 J6-5 Terminal I. D. ZTEMP SIGNAL COMMON CSP* MODE HSP Terminal # J6-6 J6-7 J6-8 J6-9 J6-10 Terminal I. D. LED COMMON HEAT LED COOL LED SYS ON LED SERVICE LED Test 1: Zone Temperature Thermistor (ZTEMP) This component is tested by measuring the resistance between terminals 1 and 2 on the Zone Temperature Sensor. The following are some typical indoor temperatures, and corresponding resistive values. Table 74. Resistance values Zone or Set Point Temperature Nominal ZTEMP Nominal CSP or Resistance HSP Resistance 50° F 19.9 K-Ohms 889 Ohms 55° F 17.47 K-Ohms 812 Ohms 60° F 15.3 K-Ohms 695 Ohms 65° F 13.49 K-Ohms 597 Ohms 70° F 11.9 K-Ohms 500 Ohms 75° F 10.50 K-Ohms 403 Ohms 80° F 9.3 K-Ohms 305 Ohms 132 Table 74. Resistance values (continued) Zone or Set Point Temperature Nominal ZTEMP Nominal CSP or Resistance HSP Resistance 85° F 8.25 K-Ohms 208 Ohms 90° F 7.3 K-Ohms 110 Ohms Test 2: Cooling Set Point (CSP) and Heating Set Point (HSP) The resistance of these potentiometers are measured between the following ZSM terminals. Refer to the chart above for approximate resistances at the given set points. CSP = Terminals 2 and 3 Range = 100 to 900 Ohms approximate HSP = Terminals 2 and 5 Range = 100 to 900 Ohms approximate Test 3: System Mode and Fan Selection The combined resistance of the Mode selection switch and the Fan selection switch can be measured between terminals 2 and 4 on the ZSM. The possible switch combinations are listed below with their corresponding resistance values. Table 75. Nominal resistance VAV System Switch CV System Switch CV Fan Switch Nominal Resistance OFF AUTO 2.3 K-Ohms OFF COOL AUTO 4.9 K-Ohms AUTO AUTO 7.7 K-Ohms OFF ON 11.0 K-Ohms AUTO COOL AUTO ON 13.0 K-Ohms ON 16.0 K-Ohms HEAT AUTO 19.0 K-Ohms HEAT ON 28.0 K-Ohms Test 4: LED Indicator Tests (SYS ON, HEAT, COOL & SERVICE) · Method 1: Testing the LED using a meter with diode test function. Test both forward and reverse bias. Forward bias should measure a voltage drop of 1.5 to 2.5 volts, depending on your meter. Reverse bias will show an over load, or open circuit indication if LED is functional. · Method 2: Testing the LED with an analog Ohmmeter. Connect Ohmmeter across LED in one direction, then reverse the leads for the opposite direction. The LED should have at least 100 times more resistance in reverse direction, as compared with the forward direction. If high resistance in both RT-SVX34U-EN directions, LED is open. If low in both directions, LED is shorted. · Method 3: Testing the LED with an analog Ohmmeter. Connect Ohmmeter across LED in one direction, then reverse the leads for the opposite direction. The LED should have at least 100 times more resistance in reverse direction, as compared with the forward direction. If high resistance in both directions, LED is open. If low in both directions, LED is shorted. Note: Measurements should be made from LED common (ZSM terminal 6 to respective LED terminal). Refer to the Zone Sensor Module (ZSM) Terminal Identification table at the beginning of this section. Programmable & Digital Zone Sensor Test Testing serial communication voltage 1. Verify 24 VAC is present between terminals RTRM J6-14 and RTRM J6-11. 2. Disconnect wires from RTRM J6-11 and RTRM J612. Measure the voltage between RTRM J6-11 and RTRM J6-12; it should be approximately 32 Vdc. 3. Reconnect wires to terminals RTRM J6-11 and RTRM J6-12. Measure voltage again between RTRM J6-11 and RTRM J6-12, voltage should flash high and low every 0.5 seconds. The voltage on the low end will measure about 19 Vdc, while the voltage on the high end will measure from approximately 24 to 38 Vdc. 4. Verify all modes of operation, by running the unit through all of the steps in "Test Modes," p. 67. 5. After verifying proper unit operation, exit the test mode. Turn the fan on continuously at the ZSM, by pressing the button with the fan symbol. If the fan comes on and runs continuously, the ZSM is good. If you are not able to turn the fan on, the ZSM is defective. ReliaTel Refrigeration Module (RTRM) Default Chart - CV and SZ VAV Units If the RTRM loses input from the building management system, the RTRM will control in the default mode after approximately 15 minutes. If the RTRM loses the Heating and Cooling Setpoint input from the potentiometers, the RTRM will control in the default mode instantaneously. The temperature sensing thermistor in the Zone Sensor Module for CV applications is the only component required for the "Default Mode" to operate. Diagnostics Table 76. Constant volume and single zone VAV default operations Component or Function Cooling Setpoint (CSP) Default Operation 74°F Heating Setpoint (HSP) Economizer 71°F Normal Operation Economizer Minimum Position Mode Fan Night Setback Mode Normal Operation Normal operation, or auto if ZSM mode switch has failed Normal operation, or continuous if fan mode switch on ZSM has failed Disabled - Used with Integrated ComfortTM System and Programmable ZSM's only Supply Air Tempering Disabled - Used with Integrated ComfortTM Systems only DA Cool Setpoint 50ºF (SZ VAV Only) DA Heat Setpoint 100ºF (SZ VAV Only) Default Chart - VAV Units If the RTRM loses input from the building management system, the RTRM will control in the default mode after approximately 15 minutes. For VAV units, a "shorted" mode input is the only input required for the "Default Mode" to operate. If the RTRM loses setpoint inputs from the RTAM due to remote setpoint input failure, the RTRM will use default setpoint inputs as defined in the default chart for VAV units. Table 77. Variable air volume default operation Component or Function Default Operation Supply Air Cooling Setpoint Failure Supply Air Reset Setpoint Failure Supply Air Reset Amount Supply Air Static 55° F Disable Reset Disable Reset Setpoint Failure Supply Air Static 0.5 IWC Deadband Failure Morning Warm-Up 0.5 IWC Setpoint Failure Mode Failure "Open Mode Failure "Shorted Disable MWU and DWU "Unit Mode "Off" "Unit Mode "Auto" RT-SVX34U-EN 133 Diagnostics Economizer Actuator (ECA/ RTEM) Test Procedures Economizer Fault Detection and Diagnostics Fault Detection of the Outdoor Air Damper will be evaluated based on the commanded position of the damper actuator compared to the feedback position from the damper actuator. The damper is commanded to a position based on a 2-10 VDC signal. If the damper position is outside of ±10% of the commanded position, a diagnostic is generated. Note: Only one diagnostic will be active at any given time. Unit Not Economizing When it Should Be The unit is operating in cooling mode, economizing is enabled and/or mechanical cooling is enabled. If the commanded economizer position is greater than the current economizer feedback position +10% for 5 continuous minutes, a `Unit Not Economizing When it Should Be' diagnostic is generated. Unit Economizing When it Should Not Be The unit is operating in cooling mode, economizing is enabled and/or mechanical cooling is enabled. If the commanded economizer position is less than the current economizer feedback position -10% for 5 continuous minutes, a `Unit Economizing When it Should Not Be' diagnostic is generated. Outdoor Air Damper Not Modulating If the unit is operating in ventilation only mode - not attempting to economize - and the commanded damper position is greater than the current damper feedback position +10% for 5 continuous minutes, a `Outside Air Damper Not Modulating' diagnostic is generated. Excessive Outdoor Air If the unit is operating in ventilation only mode - not attempting to economize - and the commanded damper position is less than the current damper feedback position -10% for 5 continuous minutes, a `Excessive Outdoor Air' diagnostic is generated. Mixed Air Temperature Low Limit Diagnostic In all conditions on all ReliaTel controlled units, if the Mixed Air Temperature falls below 45°F, the `Mixed Air Temperature Low Limit' diagnostic is active and the economizer actuator will close to the active minimum position. On Title 24 compliant units, ReliaTel will set an Auto-Reset Diagnostic to be used by BAS and TD5 when the Mixed Air Temperature Low Limit is active. The RTEM will revert to normal operation when the Mixed Air Temperature rises above 48°F. The 134 Diagnostic will be reset when the Mixed Air Temperature Low Limit is inactive. Verify Economizer Status by Economizer Actuator (ECA/RTEM) LED indicator: · OFF: No Power or Failure · ON: Normal, OK to Economize · Slow Flash: Normal, Not OK to Economize · Fast Flash: ¼ Second ON/2 Seconds OFF Communications Failure · 1 Flash: Actuator Fault · 2 Flashes: CO2 Sensor out of range · 3 Flashes: RA Humidity Sensor out of range · 4 Flashes: RA Temp Sensor out of range · 6 Flashes: OA Humidity Sensor out of range · 7 Flashes: OA Temp Sensor out of range · 8 Flashes: MA Temp Sensor out of range · 9-11 Flashes: Internal ECA failure Note: The Outdoor Air Sensor (OAS) is also used for the economizer operation. It is connected to the RTRM. Test 1: Voltage Disconnect the OAS from the wires in the return air section. Check the voltage at the wires going to the RTRM. The voltage should be 5 (± 0.25) Vdc. Check the resistance at the wires going to the OAS and measure the temperature at the OAS location. Using the Temperature versus Resistance chart, verify the accuracy of the OAS. If voltage specified is not present, the ECA has failed. Test 2: Testing the ECA sensors 1. Testing the Mixed Air Sensor (MAS). Disconnect the cable connected to MAT on the ECA. Using the Thermistor Resistance / Temperature Chart (Table 18, p. 39): a. Measure the resistance of the sensor between the connector terminals P23-1 and P23-2. b. Measure the temperature at the MAS location. Using the Temperature versus Resistance chart, verify the accuracy of the MAF. Replace the sensor if it is out of range. 2. Testing the Return Air Sensor (RAS). Disconnect the cable connected to RAT on the ECA. Using the Thermistor Resistance / Temperature Chart (Table 18, p. 39): a. Measure the resistance of the sensor between the connector terminals P10-1 and P10-2. b. Measure the temperature at the RAS location. RT-SVX34U-EN Using the Temperature versus Resistance chart, verify the accuracy of the RAS. Replace the sensor if it is out of range. 3. Testing the Humidity Sensors. a. Return Humidity Sensor (RHS). Leave the sensor connected to the ECA, and measure the operating current. The normal current range is 4 to 20 mA (milliampere). Replace the sensor if it is out of range. b. Outdoor Humidity Sensor (OHS). Leave the sensor connected to the ECA, and measure the operating current. The normal current range is 4 to 20 mA (milliampere). Replace the sensor if it is out of range. Note: Both the RHS and the OHS are polarity sensitive. Verify that the polarity is correct before condemning the sensor. Incorrect wiring will not damage any of the controls, but they will not function if wired incorrectly. ReliaTel Air Module (RTAM) Tests WARNING Live Electrical Components! Failure to follow all electrical safety precautions when exposed to live electrical components could result in death or serious injury. When it is necessary to work with live electrical components, have a qualified licensed electrician or other individual who has been properly trained in handling live electrical components perform these tasks. Test 1: Testing the Variable Frequency Drive (VFD) Output 1. Using the procedure for VAV applications outlined in "Test Modes," p. 67, step the unit to the first test (Step 1). Verify that 10 Vdc is present between terminals J4-2 and J4-1. Note: If voltage is incorrect, verify RTAM DIP switch settings. 2. If voltage to the VFD is not present, verify that the wires are properly connected between the RTRM or COMM (Communications Module) and the RTAM. If Step 2 checks out and the voltage is still not present at the VFD output, replace the RTAM. Test 2: Testing the Static Pressure Transducer (SPT) Input 1. With main power to the unit turned "Off", disconnect all of the tubing to the Static Pressure Transducer. RT-SVX34U-EN Diagnostics 2. With the system MODE "Off", apply power to the unit and measure the voltage between J1-4 and J11 on the RTAM. The voltage should be approximately 5 Vdc. If not, check the wiring between the RTRM and the RTAM. If the wiring checks good, replace RTAM. 3. Measure the voltage between J1-3 and J1-1 on the RTAM. The voltage should be approximately 0.25 Vdc. If not, check the wiring between the RTAM and the SPT. If the wiring checks good, replace the SPT. 4. Apply 2.0" w.c. pressure to the HI port on the static pressure transducer (SPT). Measure the voltage between J1-1 and J1-3. The voltage should be 1.75 (± 0.14) Vdc. If not, replace the SPT. Note: The SPT is susceptible to interference from VFD's. Make sure the SPT is mounted on plastic standoffs and is not touching any sheet metal. Test 3: Testing the VAV Setpoint Potentiometers Turn the main power disconnect switch "OFF". Check each potentiometer listed in the table below by measuring resistance. These potentiometers are built into the RTAM and are not replaceable. Static Pressure Setpoint Static Pressure Dead band Reset Setpoint Reset Amount Morning Warm-up Setpoint Supply Air Cooling Setpoint Supply Air Heating Setpoint 0-560 ohms (Approximate) 0-560 ohms (Approximate) 0-560 ohms (Approximate) 0-560 ohms (Approximate) 0-560 ohms (Approximate) 0-560 ohms (Approximate) 0-560 ohms (Approximate) RTAM J7-1,2 RTAM J7-7,8 RTAM J7-11,12 RTAM J7-5,6 RTAM J7-9,10 RTAM J7-3,4 RTAM J7-13,14 Test 4: Testing the VFD 1. Verify that the keypad in control box is powered. If not, check the power wires to the VFD and the Keypad cable. 2. Using the procedure described in "Test Modes," p. 67, verify that the fan starts and the speed increases until the SA Pressure reaches the "Setpoint" on VAV Setpoint panel. If the fan does not start, check for "Fault Conditions" on the VFD Keypad. 3. If no "Fault Conditions" exist and the fan started but did not ramp up to speed, verify the "speed reference voltage" output from the RTAM between terminals J4-1 and J4-2. 135 Diagnostics 4. If no "Fault Conditions" exist and the fan did not start, verify that the Fan relay is energized and the VFD "Start Command" is properly wired from the Fan relay, (24 volts on the Logic Input 2 (LI2) terminal). Verify that the jumper between +24V and the LI1 terminal is properly connected. 5. Verify that 115 Vac is present from the transformer on the VFD assembly panel. Notes: · Begin troubleshooting by checking for any diagnostics. See System Status/ Diagnostics. · Always verify the unit is operating in the proper "MODE" when troubleshooting. ReliaTel Air Module (RTOM) Tests Test 1: Testing the Variable Frequency Drive (VFD) Output 1. Using the "Test Modes," p. 67 procedure for SZ VAV applications in the "Startup," p. 42 section, step the unit to the fourth test (Step 4). Verify that 10 Vdc is present between terminals J11-2 and J111. 2. If the voltage to the VFD is not present, verify that the wires are properly connected between the RTRM or COMM (Communications Module) and the RTOM. 3. If Step 2 checks out and the voltage is still not present at the VFD output, replace the RTOM. Test 2: Testing the VFD 1. Verify that the keypad in control box is powered. If not, check the power wires to the VFD and the Keypad cable. 2. Using the "Step Test Mode" procedure described in the "Startup," p. 42 section, step the unit to the fourth test (Step 4). Verify that the fan starts and the speed increases. If the fan does not start, check for "Fault Conditions" on the VFD Keypad. 3. If no "Fault Conditions" exist and the fan started but did not ramp up to speed, verify the "speed reference voltage" output from the RTOM between terminals J11-1 and J11-2. 4. If no "Fault Conditions" exist and the fan did not start, verify that the Fan relay is energized and the VFD "Start Command" is properly wired from the Fan relay, (24 volts on the Logic Input 2 (LI2) terminal). Verify that the jumper between +24V and the LI1 terminal is properly connected. 5. Verify that 115 Vac is present from the transformer on the VFD assembly panel. Notes: · Begin troubleshooting by checking for any diagnostics. See System Status/ Diagnostics. · Always verify the unit is operating in the proper "MODE" when troubleshooting. Compressor--Blink Codes The CSHN*** large commercial compressors come equipped with a compressor protection device capable of detecting phase reversal, phase loss, and phase unbalance. The compressor protection device uses a green and red LED to indicate the compressor status. A solid green LED denotes a fault-free condition; a blinking red LED indicates an identifiable fault condition. Note: If the compressor has tripped, the resistance will be 4500 ohms or greater; when reset, it will be less than 2750 ohms. The blink code consists of different on / off times of the red LED which is repeated continuously until either the fault is cleared or until power is cycled. Table 78. Blink codes Fault LED on LED off LED on LED off PTC overheat or PTC reset delay active short blink long blink short blink long blink Phase loss long blink long blink long blink long blink Incorrect phase sequence short blink short blink short blink long blink 136 RT-SVX34U-EN Diagnostics Troubleshooting Table 79. Troubleshooting SYMPTOM PROBABLE CAUSE RECOMMENDED ACTION 1. No power to the Unit. 1. Check line voltage at service disconnect. A. Unit will not operate. No Heat, No Cool or No Fan operation. 2. No power to the RTRM. 3. Zone Sensor Module (ZSM) is defective or MODE circuit is open. (VAV only) 4. RTRM is defective. 5. Supply Fan Proving (FFS) switch has opened. 2. Check for 24 VAC at RTRM J1-1 to system ground. 3. See Zone Sensor Module (ZSM) Test Procedures or short MODE input on VAV units. 4. If 24 VAC is present at the RTRM J1-1 to ground, the LED on the RTRM should be on. If the LED is not lit, replace the RTRM. 5. Check the IDM and belts, replace as necessary. 6. Emergency Stop input is open. 6. Check the Emergency Stop input. CV or SZ VAV Units only 1. Zone Sensor Module (ZSM) is defective. B. Unit will not Heat or Cool, but the 2. Problem in (ZSM) wiring. Fan switch operates. 3. RTRM is defective. CV, SZ VAV or VAV (Unoccupied) C. Unit heats and cools, but will not control to set point. 1. Zone Sensor Module (ZSM) is defective. 2. Thermometer on the ZSM out of calibration. D. CPR1 will not operate, ODM's will operate. 1. Compressor failure. 2. Wiring, terminal, or mechanical CC1 contactor failure. 3. LPC1 has tripped 1. ODM has failed. 1. Refer to the Zone Sensor Module (ZSM) Test Procedures. 2. Disconnect the ZSM wiring at RTRM and test the wires using the Zone Sensor Test Procedures to locate any wiring problems. 3. Disconnect the ZSM wiring at the RTRM and perform the Zone Sensor Module (ZSM) Test Procedures. If within range, replace RTRM. 1. Refer to the Zone Sensor Module (ZSM) Test Procedures.Refer to the Default Chart. 2. Check and calibrate the thermometer. 1. Test compressor, mechanically and electrically. Replace if necessary. 2. Check wires, terminals and CC1. Repair or replace if necessary. 3. Leak check, repair, evacuate and recharge as necessary. Check LPC1 operation. 1. Check ODM's, replace if necessary. E. CPR1 operates, ODM's will not operate. 2. ODM capacitor(s) has failed. 3. Wiring, terminal, or mechanical CC1 or CC2 contactor failure. 4. ODF 20 or 34 relay has failed 5. RTRM is defective 1. No power to CC1 coil. Possible Cool Failure F. CPR1 and ODM1 will not operate. 2. CC1 coil defective. Cool Failure Indicated. 3. CC1 contacts defective. 4. RTRM is defective. 5. LPC1 has tripped 2. Check ODM capacitors, replace if necessary. 3. Check wires, terminals,CC1 and CC2. Repair or replace if necessary. 4.Check for proper voltage and contact closure. ODF20 and 34 have a 24 VAC holding Coil. If voltage is present, replace relay. 5. Locate the P3 connector on the RTRM. Check for 24 VAC at terminal P3-6. If 24 VAC is not present, replace RTRM. 1. Check wiring, terminals and applicable controls (CCB1, HPC1, TDL1, WTL1, LPC1) 2. Check CC1 coil. If open or shorted, replace CC1. 3. If 24 VAC is present at CC1coil, verify contact closure. 4. If 24 VAC is not present at CC1 coil, reset the Cool Failure by cycling the main power disconnect switch. Verify system MODE is set for cooling operation. If no controls have opened, and CC1 will not close, replace RTRM. 5. Leak check, repair, evacuate, and recharge as necessary. Check LPC1 operation. RT-SVX34U-EN 137 Diagnostics Table 79. Troubleshooting (continued) SYMPTOM G. ODM 3 and/or 4 will not cycle. PROBABLE CAUSE 1. OAS has failed. 2. ODM3 and/or 4 capacitor has failed. 3. Wiring, terminal, or CC2 contactor failure. 4. ODM3 and/or 4 has failed. RECOMMENDED ACTION 1. Perform OAS Resistance/Temperature check. Replace if necessary. 2. Check ODM capacitor, replace if necessary. 3. Check wires, terminals, and CC2. Repair or replace if necessary. 4. Check ODM, replace if necessary. 5. RTRM is defective. 5. Replace RTRM module H. CPR2 and 3 (if applicable) will not operate. 6. Check for proper voltage and contact closure. 6. ODF20 has failed. ODF20 relay has a 24 VAC holding coil. If voltage is present, replace relay. 1. No power to CC2 and/or 3 coil. Cool Failure Possible. 1. Check wiring, terminals and applicable controls (CCB2, CCB3, HPC2, LPC2, WTL2, WTL3, TDL2 & TDL3) 2. CC2 and/or 3 coil defective. Cool Failure Indicated. 2. Verify integrity of CC2 and/or 3 coil windings. open or shorted replace CC2 and/or CC3. If 3. CC2 and/or 3 contacts defective. 3. If 24 VAC is present at CC2 and/or 3 coil, replace relay. 4. 24 VAC is not present at CC2 and/or 3 coil. Reset the Cool Failure by cycling the service disconnect. Place the unit into Cool Stage 2 Mode, step 4 for 4. RTRM is defective. constant Volume or step 6 for variable air volume, to insure CPR2 and 3 Compressor operation. Check input devices in #1 & #2 above, if no controls have opened, and CC2 and/or 3 will not close, replace RTRM. 4. Check for leaks, Open wire connections, Lose 5. DLT2 and DLT3 has tripped. quick connect terminals, TDL2 and TDL3 resistance check. 1. IDM has failed. 1. Check IDM, replace if necessary. 2. Wiring, terminal, or contactor failure. I. Indoor motor (IDM) will not operate 3. ZSM is defective. 4. RTRM is defective. 5. Supply Fan Proving (FFS) switch has opened. 2. Check wiring, terminals and F contactor. Repair or replace wiring, terminals, or fan contactor F. 3. Place unit in test mode. If the fan operates in the test mode, test the ZSM using the appropriate test procedures. 4. Check the RTRM fan output. Locate P2-1 on the RTRM. Measure voltage to ground. If 24 VAC is not present on a call for fan, replace the RTRM. 5. Check FFS and belts, repair or replace if necessary. 1. CFM has failed. 1. Check CFM, replace if necessary. J. No Heat (YC's only) CFM will not run, IP warms up, GV is energized K. No Heat (YC's only) CFM runs, GV energizes, IP does not warm up. L. No Heat (YC's only) GV does not energize, CFM runs, IP warms up 2. CFM capacitor has failed. 3. Wiring, or terminal failure. 4. TNS3 and/or 4 has failed. (460/575 V units only) 5. Modulating gas is not configured properly. 1. TNS3 and/or 4 has failed. 2. Wiring or terminal failure. 3. IP has failed. 1. Wiring or terminal failure. 2. GV has failed, in two stage units 3. Pressure switch failure, in mod heat units 2. Disconnect BROWN wires from capacitor, test, and replace if necessary. 3. Check wiring, and terminals. Repair, or replace if necessary. 4. Check for 230 VAC at TNS3 and/or 4 secondary, between Y1 and Y2. If 230 VAC is not present, replace TNS3 and/or 4. 5. Check RTOM wiring and control board software versions. 1. Check for 115 VAC at TNS3 and/or 4 secondary, between X1 and X2. If 115 VAC is not present, replace TNS3 and/or 4. 2. Check wiring and terminals. Repair or replace if necessary. 3. With 115 VAC applied to IP, warm up should take place. Cold resistance of IP should be a minimum of 50 Ohms. Nominal current should be 2.5 to 3.0 Amps. 1. Verify presence of 24 VAC between IGN J1-7 terminal to ground, if not present, check wiring and terminals. Repair or replace if necessary. 2. Measure voltage between TH and TR on the gas valve (GV). If 24 VAC is present and the GV will not open, replace the GV. 3. In mod heat units, verify the pressure switch is wired correctly. If wired correctly, verify operation of pressure switch. 138 RT-SVX34U-EN Diagnostics Table 79. Troubleshooting (continued) SYMPTOM PROBABLE CAUSE M. Low Heat Capacity Intermittent Heat. (YC's only) CFM runs in LO or HI speed only, or; may not operate at all CFM has failed. in one speed or the other. N. No Heat (YC's only) "Fan" selection switch on the ZSM is in the "AUTO" position and the fan runs TCO2 has opened. Heat Failure Indicated. continuously. 1. Heater contactor(s) have failed. 2. Heater element temperature limit(s) is open. O. No Heat (TE's only) Electric heat will not operate. 3. Wiring or terminal failure. 4. Heater Element(s) has failed. 5. RTRM is defective. 1. System low on refrigerant charge. P. Evaporator coil freezes up during low ambient operation. 2. System low on air flow. 3. Outdoor Air Sensor (OAS) has Failed. RECOMMENDED ACTION Check CFM, test LO and HI speed windings. System Status Failure Diagnostic. Place the unit in the Heating Test Mode, steps 6 & 7 for constant volume or step 8 & 9 for variable air volume and check the complete heating system for failure. Make necessary repairs or adjustments to the unit. 1. Check for 24 VAC at AH, BH,CH, and DH contactor coils. If 24 VAC is present on a call for heat, and the contacts do not close, the contactor has failed. 2. Check line voltage between the element temperature limit terminals located in heat section. If line voltage is present, the limit is open. Repair heating unit, or replace limit(s) as needed. 3. Check for wiring, or terminal failure in control and power circuit. Repair or replace if necessary. 4. Check element and circuit integrity. Repair or replace as necessary. Replace open elements. 5. Check RTRM heat outputs. "First stage", locate P2 connector, connected to J2 on the RTRM. Locate wire 65E at terminal P2-9, measure between 65E and ground. If 24 VAC is present, repeat #3 above. If 24 Vac is not present, the RTRM has failed. "Second stage", Locate 67B wire at terminal P2-8, measure between 67B and ground. 24 Vac should be present. If 24 Vac is not present, the RTRM has failed. 1. Leak check, repair, evacuate, and recharge system as necessary. 2. Check return air for obstruction or dirty filters. Check fan wheels, motors, and belts. 3. Check OAS at connector P8 by disconnecting P8 from J8 on the RTRM. Check resistance between P8-1 and P8-2, refer to the Resistance versus Temperature chart. Replace sensor if necessary. 4. FrostatTM has Failed 4. Check Frostat Switch Q. Economizer will not operate. 1. Economizer connector not plugged into unit wiring 1. Check connector, and connect if necessary. harness. 2. Verify that 24 VAC is present between ECA terminals 24 VAC and Common. Place the unit in 2. Economizer Actuator (ECA) has failed. econ test mode; economizer actuator should drive open. In any other unit test mode, economizer actuator should drive to minimum position. If ECA does not drive as specified, replace ECA. 3. Wiring or terminal failure. 3. Check wiring and terminals. Repair or replace if necessary. 4. ECA is defective. 4. Perform the ECA Test Procedures discussed previously. 1. Remote Minimum position potentiometer has R. Minimum position is at zero, cannot failed. be adjusted. Economizer still modulates. 2. Minimum position potentiometer has failed. 1. With the main power off, check the resistance between terminals P and P1 at the ECA by rotating the remote minimum position potentiometer knob. Resistance should be 50 to 200 Ohms. 2. Rotate the onboard minimum position potentiometer knob. If ECA does not drive to different minimum position, replace ECA. S. Economizer goes to minimum position, and will not modulate. 1. OAS has failed. 2. MAS has failed. 1. Check the OAS at connector P8 by disconnecting P8 from J8 on the RTRM. Check resistance between P8-1 and P8-2, refer to the Resistance versus Temperature Chart. Replace sensor if necessary. 2. Check the MAS at connector P23 by disconnecting P23 from MAT on the ECA. "MAT" is marked on the actuator. Check for resistance between P23-1 and P23-2, refer to the Resistance versus Temperature Chart. Replace sensor if necessary. RT-SVX34U-EN 139 Diagnostics Table 79. Troubleshooting (continued) SYMPTOM PROBABLE CAUSE RECOMMENDED ACTION 1. Comparative enthalpy setup, RAS or RHS failed. System is operating using Reference enthalpy. T. Economizer modulates, but system does not seem to operate as efficiently as in the past. 1. Check the return air sensor (RAS) at connector P10 by disconnecting P10 from RAT on the ECA. Check for resistance between P10-1 and P10-2, refer to the Resistance versus Temperature Chart. Replace the sensor if necessary. Check the return air humidity sensor (RHS) by measuring the operating current at terminals RAH-1 and RAH-2 on the ECA. Normal operating current is 4 to 20 milliamps mA. Note: The humidity sensors are polarity sensitive, and will not operate if connected backwards. U. Power Exhaust will not operate. 2. Check the outside humidity sensor (OHS) by 2. Reference enthalpy setup, OHS has failed. System measuring the operating current at terminals OAH-1, is operating using dry bulb control. and OAH-2 on the ECA. Normal operating current is 4 to 20 milliamps mA. 3. Comparative enthalpy setup, OHS has failed. System is operating using dry bulb control. 1. Exhaust motor has failed. 2. XFR has failed. 3. Perform #2 above. 1. Check the exhaust fan motor, and replace if necessary. 2. Check the exhaust fan contactor (XFR). Replace if necessary 3. ECA has failed. 3. Perform the ECA Test Procedures discussed previously. 4. XFSP has Failed 4. Perform the Exhaust Fan Setpoint Test Procedures discussed previously. 1. RTAM has Failed 1. Perform the RTAM Test Procedures discussed previously. V. VFD will not operate properly 2. VFD has Failure 3. Setpoint Failure 4. RTOM has Failed 2. Check the VFD 3. Perform the VFD Setpoint Test Procedures discussed previously. 4. Perform the RTOM Test Procedures discussed previously. 1. Space Pressure Deadband is too narrow W. Power Exhaust Fan cycles ON/OFF 2. Space Pressure Setpoint is too high/low 1. Increase the Space Pressure Deadband. 2. Verify Building Pressure with maximum building exhaust enabled. Adjust Space Pressure Setpoint accordingly. Table 80. Component failure mode COMPONENT FAILURE RESPONSE NORMAL RANGE (OAS) Outdoor Air Sensor 1. Economizer in minimum position. Will not modulate. -55 to 175F / 680K to 1.2K 2. ODM3 will not cycle off (runs continuously). -55 to 175F / 680K to 1.2K (RAS) Return Air Sensor Economizer operates using Reference Enthalpy 0 to 209 F / 90K to 7.1K (MAS) Supply Air Sensor Economizer in minimum position, will not modulate. 0 to 209 F / 90K to 7.1K (OHS) Outdoor Humidity Sensor Uses Dry Bulb operation and 4 to 20 mA / 10 to 90% RH economizes if below 60 F DB. Honeywell C7600A. (RHS) Return Humidity Economizer operates using Sensor Reference Enthalpy. Remote Minimum position Potentiometer 1Economizer modulates but minimum position stays at zero. Cooling Setpoint (CSP) for CV Uses HSP and CSP CSP= HSP or SZ VAV ZSM slide + 4 F or use RTRM Default potentiometer Mode. 4 to 20 mA / 10 to 90% RH Honeywell C7600A. Potentiometer range 50 to 200 Ohms. 100 to 900 Ohms Use ZSM Test Procedures. Heating Setpoint (HSP) for CV or SZ VAV ZSM slide Uses CSP and HSP HSP= CSP - 100 to 900 Ohms Use ZSM potentiometer 4 F. Test Procedures. TDL1, TDL2 or TDL3 (Temperature Discharge Limit) Comp1, Comp2 or Comp3 will Open 230 F +/- 6.5 F, Close not operate. 180 F +/- 12.5 F, Normally closed DIAGNOSTIC Heat and cool failure output at RTRM J6-7 to J6-6 and RTRM J6-8 to J6-6. Heat and cool LED's blink at ZSM. Check at RTRM connector P8, between P8-1 & P8-2. Check at RTRM connector P8. ECA LED 4 Flashes. Check at ECA connector P1 between P10-1 & P10-2. ECA 8 flashes. ECA 6 flashes. Check at ECA OAH-1 and OAH-2 by measuring current draw. Check at ECA ECA 3 flashes. RAH-1 and RAH-2 by measuring current draw. *NONE* Check resistance at ECA P and P1 50 to 200 Ohms. *NONE* Check at terminals 2 and 3 on ZSM *NONE* Check at terminals 2 and 5 on ZSM. Cool Failure Output at RTRM J6-8 to J6-6 LED blinks at ZSM. 140 RT-SVX34U-EN Diagnostics Table 80. Component failure mode (continued) COMPONENT FAILURE RESPONSE NORMAL RANGE DIAGNOSTIC HSP and CSP for CV or SZ VAV Cannot control at ZSM, unit are both lost. using RTRM Default Mode. If a sensor is used at RTRM J6-1 and J6-2, 100 to 900 Ohms approx. Use Cool Failure Output at RTRM J6-8 to J6-6 ZSM Test Procedures. "COOL" LED Blinks at ZSM. If RTRM senses a zone temp input and then it is lost, (ZTEMP) Zone Temperature Sensor CV, SZ VAV, or VAV during Unoccupied mode. No Heating or Cooling ZSM "Fan" selection switch operates IDM during Unoccupied Mode. TC01, TCO2, TC03 High Temp Heat goes off, IDM runs Limit continuously. -40 TO 150 F, 346K to 2.1K CV Cool Failure Output at RTRM J6-8 to J66 "COOL" LED Blinks at ZSM Normally Closed, Open 135 F, Heat Failure Output at RTRM J6-7 to J6-6 Reset 105 F. "HEAT" LED Blinks at ZSM. (LPC1) Low Pressure Control Compressor CPR1 will not operate. Open 25 PSIG, Close 41 PSIG. Possible Cool Failure at RTRM J1-8 to Ground, 0 VAC. "COOL" LED Blinks at ZSM. (LPC2) Low Pressure Control Compressor CPR2 will not Dual Circuits Only operate. Open 25 PSIG, Close 41 PSIG. Possible Cool Failure at RTRM J3-2 to Ground, 0 VAC. "COOL" LED blinks at ZSM. (CCB1) Compressor CPR1 will not operate. Normally Closed. range varies Cool Failure Output at RTRM J6-8 to J6-6 by unit. "COOL" LED blinks at ZSM. (CCB2 or CCB3) Compressor Compressor CPR2 or CPR3 will Normally Closed. range varies Cool Failure Output at RTRM J6-8 to J6-6 Overload not operate. by unit. "COOL" LED blinks at ZSM. (HPC1) High Pressure Control Compressor CPR1 will not operate. Open 650 psig, Close 550 psig Cool Failure Output at RTRM J6-8 to J6-6 "COOL" LED blinks at ZSM. (HPC2) High Pressure Control Compressor CPR2 not operate. or CPR3 will Open 650 psig, Close 550 psig Cool Failure Output at RTRM J6-8 to J6-6 "COOL" LED blinks at ZSM. (WTL1) Winding Temperature Compressor CPR1 will not Limit operate. Normally Closed Cool Failure Output at RTRM J6-8 to J6-6 "COOL" LED blinks at ZSM. (WTL2 or WTL3) Winding Temperature Limit Compressor CPR2 not operate. or CPR3 will Normally Closed Cool Failure Output at RTRM J6-8 to J6-6 "COOL" LED blinks at ZSM. (CC1) Compressor Contactor Compressor CPR1 will not 24 VAC coil operate. Varies by unit Cool Failure Output at RTRM J6-8 to J6-6 "COOL" LED blinks at ZSM. (CC2 or CC3) Compressor Contactor 24 VAC coil Compressor CPR2 not operate. or CPR3 will Varies by unit Cool Failure Output at RTRM J6-8 to J6-6 "COOL" LED blinks at ZSM. (CFS) Clogged Filter Switch This input is for "indication" only and does not effect the normal operation of the unit. "Normal operation = 0 VAC measured between terminals J5-1 and Ground. SERVICE LED ON 2-30 Vdc present at RTRM J6-6 and J6-10. (FFS) Supply Fan Proving Switch Unit will not operate in any mode. 0.5" W.C. Normally Open Service Failure Output at RTRM J6-6 to J610 "SERVICE" LED blinks at ZSM. (SPT) Static Pressure Transducer VAV Fan speed command remains 0.25 - 4 Vdc between J8 and at 0%. J9 on VAV Condensate Overflow Switch Closed - Unit will not operate N/A Traq - CFM Setpoint and airflow sensor 1. In the event a required Traq control input is out of range the Traq Minimum Position Request will be disabled and a static value of 10% will be utilized for minimum position at all times. 2. If BAS is in "remote control" and sending a valid OA Minimum Position Setpoint 0 to 20000CFM that setpoint will be used for OA Minimum Position, however a diagnostic indication will continue to be set via the BAS and the 2- blink code will be initiated on the RTRM to indicate a problem. Heat and Cool Failure Output at RTRM J6-7 to J6-6 & RTRM J6-8 to J6-6 "HEAT" and "COOL" LED's blink at ZSM. Check to make sure the float position is not in a tripped condition and verify an "open" between wires connecting to RTOM J6-1, J6-2. A diagnostic will be set via BAS communication and the 2-blink code will be initiated on the RTRM to indicate a problem. Traq - w/DCV loss of CO2 sensor or CO2 setpoint(s) In the event of the loss of a required control parameter for DCV when paired with Traq control the system will revert to using on the Design 0 to 2500 Minimum OA CFM Setpoint and continue Traq control functionality without DCV. The proper failure code will be set on the RTEM and an indication of the failure will be set via the BAS Communication packet. RT-SVX34U-EN 141 Diagnostics Table 80. Component failure mode (continued) COMPONENT FAILURE RESPONSE NORMAL RANGE Traq - RTVM Communications Failure Traq - RTEM Communications Failure In the event of the loss communications with the RTVM in a system previously configured for Traq control a N/A static OA Minimum Position value of 10% will be utilized at all times. In the event of the loss communications with the RTEM in a system previously configured for Traq control the RTEM will revert to the Local Design OA Minimum Position potentiometer on the RTEM as a fail safe built into the RTEM. The damper will remain at that N/A position until communications is re-established to the RTEM or the power is disconnected. Traq control will be disabled since it requires transmission of the Traq OA Minimum Position Request to the RTEM via Modbus link. Note: *NONE* = No LED indication DIAGNOSTIC A diagnostic will be set via BAS communication and the 2-blink code will be initiated on the RTRM to indicate a problem. The proper diagnostic will be set via BAS communication and the 2-blink code will be initiated on the RTRM to indicate a problem. TR-200 VFD Programming Parameters Table 81. Supply and exhaust fan VFD programming parameters for model TR-200 Menu Parameter 1-21 Description Motor Power Setting Description Set Based on Motor Nameplate Set only for applications using 3hp Hi-Efficiency motors. Set to 2.2 kW/3 hp. Load & Motor 1-22 1-24 Motor Voltage Motor Current Set Based on Motor Nameplate Set only for 200/230v 60hz & 380/415 50hz applications Set Based on Motor Nameplate Sets the motor FLA 1-25 Motor RPM Set Based on Motor Nameplate Sets the motor RPM Limits and Warnings 4-18 Current Limit 100% Rated Current Limits the maximum current to motor programmed parameters listed in the previous table have been set before replacing the drive. Note: Model TR-200--Check to make sure that parameter 1-23 is set to 60 Hz. To check parameter 1-23 press the [Main Menu] button (press [Back] button if the main menu does not display), use the [] button to scroll down to Load & Motor, press OK, use the [] button to select 1-2, press OK, and finally use the [] button until parameter 1-23 is displayed. Parameter 1-23 can then be modified by pressing OK button and using [] and [] buttons. When the desired selection has been made, press the OK button. Should replacing the a VFD become necessary, the replacement is not configured with all of Trane's operating parameters. The VFD must be programmed before attempting to operate the unit. To verify and/or program a VFD, use the following steps: 1. Remove the mode input (RTRM J6-2 and J6-4) or turn the NSB panel to OFF so that the fan will not attempt to start during programming. Units shipped with an optional variable frequency drive (VFD) are preset and run tested at the factory. If a problem with a VFD occurs, ensure that the 142 RT-SVX34U-EN WARNING Hazardous Voltage w/Capacitors! Failure to disconnect power and discharge capacitors before servicing could result in death or serious injury. Disconnect all electric power, including remote disconnects and discharge all motor start/run capacitors before servicing. Follow proper lockout/tagout procedures to ensure the power cannot be inadvertently energized. For variable frequency drives or other energy storing components provided by Trane or others, refer to the appropriate manufacturer's literature for allowable waiting periods for discharge of capacitors. Verify with a CAT III or IV voltmeter rated per NFPA 70E that all capacitors have discharged. HIGH VOLTAGE IS PRESENT AT TERMINAL BLOCK 1TB1 OR UNIT DISCONNECT SWITCH 1S14. 2. To modify TR-200 parameters: a. Press Main Menu button (press [Back] button if the main menu does not display) b. Use the [] and [] buttons to find the parameter menu group (first part of parameter number) c. Press [OK] d. Use [] and [] buttons to select the correct parameter sub-group (first digit of second part of parameter number) e. Press [OK] f. Use [] and [] buttons to select the specific parameter g. Press [OK] h. To move to a different digit within a parameter setting, use the [] buttons (Highlighted area indicates digit selected for change) i. Use [] and [] buttons to adjust the digit Diagnostics j. Press [Cancel] button to disregard change, or press [OK] to accept change and enter the new setting 3. Repeat step two for each menu selection setting in Table 81, p. 142. 4. To reset TR-200 programming parameters back to the factory defaults: a. Go to parameter 14-22 Operation Mode b. Press [OK] c. Select "Initialization" d. Press [OK] e. Cut off the mains supply and wait until the display turns off. f. Reconnect the mains supply - the frequency converter is now reset. g. Ensure parameter 14-22 Operation Mode has reverted back to "Normal Operation". Notes: · Steps 4 resets the drive to the default factory settings. The program parameters listed in Table 81, p. 142 will need to be verified or changed as described in item 2. · Some of the parameters listed in the tables are motor specific. Due to various motors and efficiencies available, use only the values stamped on the specific motor nameplate. Do not use the Unit nameplate values. · A backup copy of the current setup may be saved to the LCP before changing parameters or resetting the drive. See LCP Copy in the VFD Operating Instructions for details. 5. After verifying that the VFD(s) are operating properly, put the unit into normal operation. RT-SVX34U-EN 143 Unit Wiring Diagram Numbers Table 82. Wiring diagrams - TC/TE units - standard efficiency (excluding 4050T CV units) Type of Airflow Schematic Type Voltage Power 208-575 Diagram Number 1213-3781 Description All Units - Standard Efficiency 208-575 2313-1279 All Units - Cooling Only - Standard Efficiency Constant Volume, Variable Air Volume, Single Zone Variable Air Volume Heat Power and Controls Refrigeration Controls (RTRM, Sensors) 208-230 380-575 208-575 1213-3027 36kW and 54kW Electric Heat 1213-3028 36kW and 54kW Electric Heat 1213-3029 72kW/90kW/108kW Electric Heat 2313-1263 27.5-35 ton Units 2313-1264 40 ton Units 2313-1265 50 ton Units Control Modules 208-575 1213-3658 All Units without Statitrac 1213-3660 All Units with Statitrac 1213-3064 27.5-35 ton, 36kW-54kW Electric Heat 2313-0781 40 ton, 54kW Electric Heat 208-230 2313-0783 50 ton, 54kW Electric Heat 2313-0797 27.5-35 ton, Cooling Only 2313-0798 40 ton, Cooling Only 2313-0799 50 ton, Cooling Only Control Box Connection Print 1213-3065 27.5-35 ton, 36kW-54kW Electric Heat 2313-0782 40 ton, 54kW Electric Heat 2313-0784 50 ton, 54kW Electric Heat Constant Volume 1213-3066 27.5-35 ton, 72kW-90kW Electric Heat 380-575 2313-0786 40 ton, 72kW-108kW Electric Heat 2313-0787 50 ton, 72kW-108kW Electric Heat 2313-0800 27.5-35 ton, Cooling Only 2313-1201 40 ton, Cooling Only 2313-1202 50 ton, Cooling Only 1213-3736 27.5-35 ton, 36kW-54kW 1213-3737 27.5-35 ton, 72kW-90kW Raceway Devices Connection Print 208-575 2313-1283 40 ton, 54kW-72kW 2313-1284 40 ton, 90kW-108kW 2313-1285 50 ton, 54kW-72kW 2313-1286 50 ton, 90kW-108kW 144 RT-SVX34U-EN Unit Wiring Diagram Numbers Table 82. Wiring diagrams - TC/TE units - standard efficiency (excluding 4050T CV units) (continued) Type of Airflow Schematic Type Voltage Control Modules 208-575 Diagram Number 1213-3659 Description All Units without Statitrac 1213-3661 All Units with Statitrac 1213-3067 27.5-35 ton, 36kW-54kW Electric Heat 1213-3792 40 ton, 54kW Electric Heat 208-230 1213-3069 50 ton, 54kW Electric Heat 2313-1203 27.5-35 ton, Cooling Only 1213-3799 40 ton, Cooling Only 2313-1205 50 ton, Cooling Only Control Box Connection Print 1213-3070 27.5-35 ton, 36kW-54kW Electric Heat 1213-3793 40 ton, 54kW Electric Heat 1213-3072 50 ton, 54kW Electric Heat Variable Air Volume 1213-3073 27.5-35 ton, 72kW-90kW Electric Heat 380-575 1213-3794 40 ton, 72kW-108kW Electric Heat 1213-3075 50 ton, 72kW-108kW Electric Heat 2313-1206 27.5-35 ton, Cooling Only 1213-3800 40 ton, Cooling Only 2313-1208 50 ton, Cooling Only 1213-3738 27.5-35 ton, 36kW-54kW 1213-3741 27.5-35 ton, 72kW-90kW Raceway Devices Connection Print 208-575 1213-3789 40 ton, 54kW-72kW 1213-3790 40 ton, 90kW-108kW 1213-3740 50 ton, 54kW-72kW 1213-3743 50 ton, 90kW-108kW RT-SVX34U-EN 145 Unit Wiring Diagram Numbers Table 82. Wiring diagrams - TC/TE units - standard efficiency (excluding 4050T CV units) (continued) Type of Airflow Schematic Type Voltage Control Modules 208-575 Diagram Number 1213-3659 Description All Units without Statitrac 1213-3661 All Units with Statitrac 1213-3076 27.5-35 ton, 36kW/54kW Electric Heat 1213-3795 40 ton, 54kW Electric Heat 208-230 1213-3078 50 ton, 54kW Electric Heat 2313-1242 27.5-35 ton, Cooling Only 1213-3801 40 ton, Cooling Only 2313-1244 50 ton, Cooling Only Single Zone Variable Air Volume Control Box Connection Print 380-575 1213-3079 27.5-35 ton, 36kW/54kW Electric Heat 1213-3796 40 ton, 54kW Electric Heat 1213-3081 50 ton, 54kW Electric Heat 1213-3082 27.5-35 ton, 72kW/90kW Electric Heat 1213-3797 40 ton, 72kW-108kW Electric Heat 1213-3084 50 ton, 72kW-108kW Electric Heat 2313-1245 27.5-35 ton, Cooling Only 1213-3802 40 ton, Cooling Only 2313-1247 50 ton, Cooling Only 1213-3724 27.5-35 ton, 36kW/54kW Electric Heat 1213-3727 27.5-35 ton, 72kW/90kW Electric Heat/Cooling Only Raceway Devices Connection Print 208-575 1213-3785 40 ton, 54kW/72kW Electric Heat 1213-3786 40 ton, 90kW/108kW Electric Heat/Cooling Only 1213-3726 50 ton, 54kW/72kW Electric Heat 1213-3729 50 ton, 90kW/108kW Electric Heat/Cooling Only 146 RT-SVX34U-EN Unit Wiring Diagram Numbers Table 83. Wiring diagrams - YC units - standard efficiency (excluding 4050T CV units) Type of Airflow Schematic Type Voltage Power 208-575 Diagram Number 1213-3781 Description All Units - Standard Efficiency 2313-1272 Low Heat Gas Units Constant Volume, Variable Air Volume, Single Zone Variable Air Volume Heat Power and Controls Refrigeration Controls (RTRM, Sensors) 208-575 208-575 2313-1273 2313-1274 2313-1275 2313-1263 2313-1264 2313-1265 High Heat Gas Units Low Heat Modulating Gas Units High Heat Modulating Gas Units 27.5-35 ton Units 40 ton Units 50 ton Units Control Modules 208-575 1213-3658 1213-3660 All Units without Statitrac All Units with Statitrac 2313-1209 27.5-35 ton, 2 Stage Gas Heat 2313-1210 40 ton, 2 Stage Gas Heat 208-230 2313-1211 2313-1215 50 ton, 2 Stage Gas Heat 27.5-35 ton, Modulating Gas Heat 2313-1216 40 ton, Modulating Gas Heat Control Box Connection Print 2313-1217 2313-1212 50 ton, Modulating Gas Heat 27.5-35 ton, 2 Stage Gas Heat Constant Volume 380-575 2313-1213 2313-1214 2313-1218 40 ton, 2 Stage Gas Heat 50 ton, 2 Stage Gas Heat 27.5-35 ton, Modulating Gas Heat 2313-1219 40 ton, Modulating Gas Heat 2313-1220 50 ton, Modulating Gas Heat 1213-3716 27.5-35 ton, 2 Stage Gas Heat 2313-1294 40 ton, 2 Stage Gas Heat Raceway Devices Connection Print 208-575 2313-1295 1213-3720 50 ton, 2 Stage Gas Heat 27.5-35 ton, Modulating Gas Heat 2313-1300 40 ton, Modulating Gas Heat 2313-1301 50 ton, Modulating Gas Heat RT-SVX34U-EN 147 Unit Wiring Diagram Numbers Table 83. Wiring diagrams - YC units - standard efficiency (excluding 4050T CV units) (continued) Type of Airflow Schematic Type Voltage Control Modules 208-575 Diagram Number 1213-3659 1213-3661 Description All Units without Statitrac All Units with Statitrac 2313-1221 27.5-35 ton, 2 Stage Gas Heat 1213-3804 40 ton, 2 Stage Gas Heat 208-230 2313-1223 2313-1227 50 ton, 2 Stage Gas Heat 27.5-35 ton, Modulating Gas Heat 1213-3806 40 ton, Modulating Gas Heat Control Box Connection Print 2313-1229 2313-1224 50 ton, Modulating Gas Heat 27.5-35 ton, 2 Stage Gas Heat Variable Air Volume 380-575 1213-3805 2313-1226 2313-1230 40 ton, 2 Stage Gas Heat 50 ton, 2 Stage Gas Heat 27.5-35 ton, Modulating Gas Heat 1213-4058 40 ton, Modulating Gas Heat 2313-1232 50 ton, Modulating Gas Heat 1213-3717 27.5-35 ton, 2 Stage Gas Heat 1213-3783 40 ton, 2 Stage Gas Heat Raceway Devices Connection Print 208-575 1213-3719 1213-3721 50 ton, 2 Stage Gas Heat 27.5-35 ton, Modulating Gas Heat 1213-3784 40 ton, Modulating Gas Heat 1213-3723 50 ton, Modulating Gas Heat Control Modules 208-575 1213-3659 1213-3661 All Units without Statitrac All Units with Statitrac 2313-1248 27.5-35 ton, 2 Stage Gas Heat 1213-3807 40 ton, 2 Stage Gas Heat 208-230 2313-1250 2313-1254 50 ton, 2 Stage Gas Heat 27.5-35 ton, Modulating Gas Heat 1213-4056 40 ton, Modulating Gas Heat Control Box Connection Print 2313-1256 2313-1251 50 ton, Modulating Gas Heat 27.5-35 ton, 2 Stage Gas Heat Single Zone Variable Air Volume 380-575 1213-4055 2313-1253 2313-1257 40 ton, 2 Stage Gas Heat 50 ton, 2 Stage Gas Heat 27.5-35 ton, Modulating Gas Heat 1213-4057 40 ton, Modulating Gas Heat 2313-1259 50 ton, Modulating Gas Heat 1213-3730 27.5-35 ton, 2 Stage Gas Heat 1213-3787 40 ton, 2 Stage Gas Heat Raceway Devices Connection Print 208-575 1213-3732 1213-3733 50 ton, 2 Stage Gas Heat 27.5-35 ton, Modulating Gas Heat 1213-3788 40 ton, Modulating Gas Heat 1213-3735 50 ton, Modulating Gas Heat 148 RT-SVX34U-EN Unit Wiring Diagram Numbers Table 84. Wiring diagrams - TC/TE units - high efficiency and 40-50T standard efficiency CV Type of Airflow Schematic Type Voltage Diagram Number Power 208-575 1213-0200 Description All Units - High Efficiency 208-575 1213-0336 All Units - Cooling Only Constant Volume, Variable Air Volume, Single Zone Variable Air Volume Heat Power and Controls Refrigeration Controls Control Modules 208-230 380-575 208-575 208-575 1213-3030 1213-3031 1213-3032 1213-0201 1213-0203 1213-0205 36kW and 54kW Electric Heat 36kW and 54kW Electric Heat 72kW/90kW/108kW Electric Heat 27.5-50 Ton Units All Units without Statitrac All Units with Statitrac 1213-0208 27.5-35T, 40T and 50T - Cooling Only 208-230 1213-3045 27.5-35T, 36kW-54kW Electric Heat 1213-4060 40T and 50T, 54kW Electric Heat Constant Volume Control Box Connection Print 380-575 1213-0209 1213-3046 1213-3047 27.5-35T, 40T and 50T - Cooling Only 27.5-35T, 36kW-54kW Electric Heat 27.5-35T, 72kW-90kW Electric Heat 1213-4061 40T and 50T, 54kW Electric Heat 1213-4062 40T and 50T, 72kW-108kW Electric Heat 1213-3745 27.5-35T, 36kW/54kW Electric Heat/Cooling Only Raceway Devices Connection Print 208-575 1213-3746 1213-3747 27.5-35T, 72kW/90kW Electric Heat 40T and 50T, 54kW/72kW Electric Heat/Cooling Only 1213-3748 40T and 50T, 90kW-108kW Electric Heat Variable Air Volume Control Modules Control Box Connection Print 208-575 208-230 380-575 1213-0204 1213-0206 1213-0212 1213-3051 1213-4063 1213-0213 1213-3052 1213-3053 1213-4064 1213-4065 All Units without Statitrac All Units with Statitrac 27.5-35T, 40T and 50T - Cooling Only 27.5-35T, 36kW-54kW Electric Heat 40T and 50T, 54kW Electric Heat 27.5-35T, 40T and 50T - Cooling Only 27.5-35T, 36kW-54kW Electric Heat 27.5-35T, 72kW-90kW Electric Heat 40T and 50T, 54kW Electric Heat 40T and 50T, 72kW-108kW Electric Heat 1213-3749 27.5-35T, 36kW/54kW Electric Heat/Cooling Only Raceway Devices Connection Print 208-575 1213-3750 1213-3751 72kW/90kW Electric Heat 40T and 50T, 54kW/72kW Electric Heat/Cooling Only 1213-3752 40T and 50T, 90kW-108kW Electric Heat RT-SVX34U-EN 149 Unit Wiring Diagram Numbers Table 84. Wiring diagrams - TC/TE units - high efficiency and 40-50T standard efficiency CV (continued) Type of Airflow Schematic Type Voltage Control Modules 208-575 Diagram Number 1213-0204 1213-0206 Description All Units without Statitrac All Units with Statitrac 1213-0210 27.5-35T, 40T and 50T - Cooling Only 208-230 1213-3048 27.5-35T, 36kW-54kW Electric Heat 1213-3057 40T and 50T, 54kW Electric Heat Single Zone Variable Air Volume Control Box Connection Print 380-575 1213-0211 1213-3049 1213-3050 27.5-35T, 40T and 50T - Cooling Only 27.5-35T, 36kW-54kW Electric Heat 27.5-35T, 72kW-90kW Electric Heat 1213-3058 40T and 50T, 54kW Electric Heat 1213-3059 40T and 50T, 72kW-108kW Electric Heat 1213-3757 27.5-35T, 36kW/54kW Electric Heat/Cooling Only Raceway Devices Connection Print 208-575 1213-3758 1213-3759 72kW/90kW Electric Heat 40T and 50T, 54kW/72kW Electric Heat/Cooling Only 1213-3760 40T and 50T, 90kW-108kW Electric Heat Table 85. Wiring diagrams - YC units - high efficiency and 40-50T standard efficiency CV Type of Airflow Schematic Type Voltage Diagram Number Power 208-575 1213-0200 Description All Units - High Efficiency 1213-0329 Low Heat Gas Units Constant Volume, Variable Heat Power and Air Volume, Single Zone Controls Variable Air Volume Refrigeration Controls Control Modules 208-575 208-575 208-575 1213-0330 1213-0331 1213-0332 1213-0201 1213-0203 1213-0205 High Heat Gas Units Low Heat Modulating Gas Units High Heat Modulating Gas Units 27.5-50 Ton Units All Units without Statitrac All Units with Statitrac Constant Volume Control Box Connection Print 208-230 380-575 1213-4067 1213-4069 1213-4068 1213-4070 27.5-35T, 40T and 50T, 2 Stage Gas Heat 27.5-35T, 40T and 50T, Modulating Gas Heat 27.5-35T, 40T and 50T, 2 Stage Gas Heat 27.5-35T, 40T and 50T, Modulating Gas Heat Raceway Devices Connection Print 208-575 1213-3753 1213-3755 27.5-35 TON, 40T and 50T, 2 Stage Gas Heat 27.5-35T, 40T and 50T, Modulating Gas Heat Variable Air Volume Control Modules Control Box Connection Print 208-575 208-230 380-575 1213-0204 1213-0206 1213-4099 1213-4101 1213-4100 1213-4102 All Units without Statitrac All Units with Statitrac 27.5-35T, 40T and 50T, 2 Stage Gas Heat 27.5-35T, 40T and 50T, Modulating Gas Heat 27.5-35T, 40T and 50T, 2 Stage Gas Heat 27.5-35T, 40T and 50T, Modulating Gas Heat Raceway Devices Connection Print 208-575 1213-3754 1213-3756 27.5-35 TON, 40T and 50T, 2 Stage Gas Heat 27.5-35T, 40T and 50T, Modulating Gas Heat 150 RT-SVX34U-EN Unit Wiring Diagram Numbers Table 85. Wiring diagrams - YC units - high efficiency and 40-50T standard efficiency CV (continued) Type of Airflow Schematic Type Voltage Control Modules 208-575 Diagram Number 1213-0204 1213-0206 Description All Units without Statitrac All Units with Statitrac Single Zone Variable Air Volume Control Box Connection Print 208-230 380-575 1213-0259 1213-0261 1213-0260 1213-0262 27.5-35T, 40T and 50T, 2 Stage Gas Heat 27.5-35T, 40T and 50T, Modulating Gas Heat 27.5-35T, 40T and 50T, 2 Stage Gas Heat 27.5-35T, 40T and 50T, Modulating Gas Heat Raceway Devices Connection Print 208-575 1213-3761 1213-3762 27.5-35 TON, 40T and 50T, 2 Stage Gas Heat 27.5-35T, 40T and 50T, Modulating Gas Heat RT-SVX34U-EN 151 Warranty and Liability Clause COMMERCIAL EQUIPMENT - 20 TONS AND LARGER AND RELATED ACCESSORIES PRODUCTS COVERED - This warranty* is extended by Trane Inc. and applies only to commercial equipment rated 20 Tons and larger and related accessories. The Company warrants for a period of 12 months from initial startup or 18 months from date of shipment, whichever is less, that the Company products covered by this order (1) are free from defects in material and workmanship and (2) have the capacities and ratings set forth in the Company's catalogs and bulletins, provided that no warranty is made against corrosion, erosion or deterioration. The Company's obligations and liabilities under this warranty are limited to furnishing f.o.b. factory or warehouse at Company designated shipping point, freight allowed to Buyer's city (or port of export for shipment outside the conterminous United States) replacement equipment (or at the option of the Company parts therefore) for all Company products not conforming to this warranty and which have been returned to the manufacturer. The Company shall not be obligated to pay for the cost of lost refrigerant. No liability whatever shall attach to the Company until said products have been paid for and then said liability shall be limited to the purchase price of the equipment shown to be defective. The Company makes certain further warranty protection available on an optional extra-cost basis. Any further warranty must be in writing, signed by an officer of the Company. The warranty and liability set forth herein are in lieu of all other warranties and liabilities, whether in contract or in negligence, express or implied, in law or in fact, including implied warranties of merchantability and fitness for particular use. In no event shall the Company be liable for any incidental or consequential damages. THE WARRANTY AND LIABILITY SET FORTH HEREIN ARE IN LIEU OF ALL OTHER WARRANTIES AND LIABILITIES, WHETHER IN CONTRACT OR IN NEGLIGENCE, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, IN LAW OR IN FACT, INCLUDING IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR PARTICULAR USE, IN NO EVENT SHALL WARRANTOR BE LIABLE FOR ANY INCIDENTAL OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES. Manager - Product Service Trane Clarksville, Tn 37040-1008 PW-215-2688 *A 10 year limited warranty is provided on optional Full Modulation Gas Heat Exchanger. *Optional Extended Warranties are available for compressors and heat exchangers of Combination Gas-Electric Air Conditioning Units. *A 5 year limited warranty is provided for optional "AMCA 1A Ultra Low Leak" airfoil blade economizer assemblies and the "AMCA 1A Ultra Low Leak" economizer actuator. 152 RT-SVX34U-EN Notes RT-SVX34U-EN 153 Notes 154 RT-SVX34U-EN Notes RT-SVX34U-EN 155 Trane - by Trane Technologies (NYSE: TT), a global innovator - creates comfortable, energy efficient indoor environments for commercial and residential applications. For more information, please visit trane.com or tranetechnologies.com. Trane has a policy of continuous product and product data improvements and reserves the right to change design and specifications without notice. We are committed to using environmentally conscious print practices. RT-SVX34U-EN 21 Jun 2021 Supersedes RT-SVX34T-EN (February 2021) ©2021 TranePTC Arbortext Publishing Engine PDFlib PDI 9.0.6 (C /Win64)